1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.92"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
58 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
59 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
60 . provided in the xfpt library.
61 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
63 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
65 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
67 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
68 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
70 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
71 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
73 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
74 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
75 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
85 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
86 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
90 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
91 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
92 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
94 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
95 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
98 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
99 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
100 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
104 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
116 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
117 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
118 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
119 . --- ID that ties them together.
122 &<indexterm role="concept">&
123 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
125 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
131 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
132 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
134 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
140 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
144 &<indexterm role="option">&
145 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
147 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
153 &<indexterm role="variable">&
154 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
156 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
162 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
168 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
170 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
174 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
175 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
179 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
180 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
181 <revhistory><revision>
183 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
187 </year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
192 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
193 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
194 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
195 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
196 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
198 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
201 <indexterm role="variable">
202 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
203 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
205 <indexterm role="concept">
206 <primary>address</primary>
207 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
208 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
210 <indexterm role="concept">
211 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
212 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
214 <indexterm role="concept">
215 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
216 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
218 <indexterm role="concept">
219 <primary>CR character</primary>
220 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
222 <indexterm role="concept">
223 <primary>CRL</primary>
224 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
226 <indexterm role="concept">
227 <primary>delivery</primary>
228 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
229 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
231 <indexterm role="concept">
232 <primary>dialup</primary>
233 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
235 <indexterm role="concept">
236 <primary>exiscan</primary>
237 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
239 <indexterm role="concept">
240 <primary>failover</primary>
241 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
243 <indexterm role="concept">
244 <primary>fallover</primary>
245 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
247 <indexterm role="concept">
248 <primary>filter</primary>
249 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
250 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
252 <indexterm role="concept">
253 <primary>ident</primary>
254 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
256 <indexterm role="concept">
257 <primary>LF character</primary>
258 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
260 <indexterm role="concept">
261 <primary>maximum</primary>
262 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
264 <indexterm role="concept">
265 <primary>monitor</primary>
266 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
268 <indexterm role="concept">
269 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
270 <see>entry for xxx</see>
272 <indexterm role="concept">
273 <primary>NUL</primary>
274 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
276 <indexterm role="concept">
277 <primary>passwd file</primary>
278 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
280 <indexterm role="concept">
281 <primary>process id</primary>
282 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
284 <indexterm role="concept">
285 <primary>RBL</primary>
286 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
288 <indexterm role="concept">
289 <primary>redirection</primary>
290 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
292 <indexterm role="concept">
293 <primary>return path</primary>
294 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
296 <indexterm role="concept">
297 <primary>scanning</primary>
298 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
300 <indexterm role="concept">
301 <primary>SSL</primary>
302 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
304 <indexterm role="concept">
305 <primary>string</primary>
306 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
307 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
309 <indexterm role="concept">
310 <primary>top bit</primary>
311 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
313 <indexterm role="concept">
314 <primary>variables</primary>
315 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
317 <indexterm role="concept">
318 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
319 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
326 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
327 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
328 . chapter "Introduction"
329 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
331 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
332 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
333 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
334 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
336 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
337 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
338 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
339 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
340 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
341 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
342 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
344 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
345 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
346 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
348 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
349 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
350 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
352 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
353 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
354 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
355 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
356 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
358 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
359 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
360 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
361 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
362 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
364 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
365 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
366 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
367 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
371 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
372 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
374 .cindex "documentation"
375 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
376 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
377 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
378 capable of showing a change indicator.
380 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
381 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
382 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
383 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
384 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
385 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
386 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
389 .cindex "books about Exim"
390 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
391 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
392 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
393 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
395 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
396 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
397 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
398 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
400 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
401 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
402 Debian-specific features in the file
403 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
404 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
407 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
408 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
410 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
411 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
412 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
413 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
414 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
416 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
417 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
418 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
419 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
421 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
422 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
424 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
425 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
426 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
430 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
431 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
432 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
433 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
434 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
440 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
441 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
442 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
446 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
449 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
450 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
451 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
455 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
456 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
457 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
458 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
459 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
460 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
461 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
476 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
477 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
478 .row &'exim-cvs@exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
493 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
494 .cindex "bug reports"
495 .cindex "reporting bugs"
496 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
497 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
498 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
499 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
503 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
505 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
506 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
507 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
508 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
510 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
512 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
513 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
515 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
516 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
517 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
519 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
520 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
521 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
522 here are top-level directories.
524 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
534 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
536 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
537 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
538 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
539 most portable to old systems.
541 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
542 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
543 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
544 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
545 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
546 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
547 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
548 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
549 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
550 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
551 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
553 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
554 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
555 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
556 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
558 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
560 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
561 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
562 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
564 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
565 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
566 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
568 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
569 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
570 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
571 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
573 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
574 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
575 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
576 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
578 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
579 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
582 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
584 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
585 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
586 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
587 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
588 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
589 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
590 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
592 .cindex "domainless addresses"
593 .cindex "address" "without domain"
594 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
595 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
596 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
597 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
600 .cindex "transport" "external"
601 .cindex "external transports"
602 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
603 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
604 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
605 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
606 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
607 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
609 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
610 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
611 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
614 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
615 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
616 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
617 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
618 a number of common scanners are provided.
622 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
623 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
624 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
625 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
626 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
627 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
630 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
631 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
632 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
633 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
634 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
635 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
636 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
637 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
638 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
639 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
640 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
641 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
643 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
644 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
645 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
646 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
650 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
651 .cindex "terminology definitions"
652 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
653 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
654 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
655 below) by a blank line.
657 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
658 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
659 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
660 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
661 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
662 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
663 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
664 rise to further bounce messages.
666 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
667 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
668 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
671 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
672 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
673 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
676 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
677 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
678 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
680 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
681 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
682 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
683 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
684 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
685 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
686 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
687 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
689 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
690 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
691 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
692 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
693 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
694 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
697 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
698 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
699 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
700 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
701 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
703 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
704 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
705 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
706 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
707 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
708 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
710 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
711 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
714 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
715 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
716 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
717 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
718 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
720 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
721 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
722 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
723 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
724 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
726 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
727 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
728 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
729 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
730 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
731 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
738 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
739 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
741 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
742 .cindex "incorporated code"
743 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
746 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
749 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
750 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
751 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
752 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
753 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
754 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
756 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
757 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
758 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
759 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
760 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
761 following statements:
764 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
766 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
767 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
768 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
770 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
771 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
772 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
773 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
774 restrictions applied to it).
777 .cindex "SPA authentication"
778 .cindex "Samba project"
779 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
780 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
781 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
782 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
786 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
787 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
788 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
789 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
790 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
791 conditions expressed therein.
794 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
796 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
797 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
801 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
802 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
804 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
805 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
806 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
809 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
810 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
811 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
812 details, please contact
814 Office of Technology Transfer
815 Carnegie Mellon University
817 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
818 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
819 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
822 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
825 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
826 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
828 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
829 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
830 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
831 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
832 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
833 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
834 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
839 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
842 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
843 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
844 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
845 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
848 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
849 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
853 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
854 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
855 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
856 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
857 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
858 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
859 software without specific, written prior permission.
861 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
862 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
863 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
864 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
865 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
866 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
871 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
872 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
873 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
874 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
875 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
879 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
880 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
881 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
888 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
889 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
891 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
892 "Receiving and delivering mail"
895 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
896 .cindex "design philosophy"
897 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
898 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
899 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
900 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
901 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
902 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
905 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
906 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
907 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
908 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
909 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
910 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
911 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
914 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
915 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
916 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
917 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
918 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
919 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
920 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
921 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
922 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
925 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
926 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
928 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
929 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
930 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
931 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
933 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
934 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
935 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
936 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
937 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
939 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
940 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
941 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
943 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
944 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
945 runs at the start of every delivery process.
950 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
951 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
952 .cindex "Sieve filter"
953 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
954 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
955 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
956 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
957 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
958 of filtering are available:
961 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
964 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
965 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
968 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
972 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
973 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
974 .cindex "format" "of message id"
975 .cindex "id of message"
980 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
981 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
982 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
983 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
984 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
985 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
986 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
987 not always case-sensitive.
989 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
990 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
991 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
992 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
993 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
994 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
998 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
999 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
1000 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
1001 way of representing the date and time of day).
1003 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
1004 received the message.
1006 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
1008 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1009 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1010 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
1011 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1012 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
1015 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
1016 (1/100) of a second.
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1027 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1028 .cindex "receiving mail"
1029 .cindex "message" "reception"
1030 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1031 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1032 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1033 there are several possibilities:
1036 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1037 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1038 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1041 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1042 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1043 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1044 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1045 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1047 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1048 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1049 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1050 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1051 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1053 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1054 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1055 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1056 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1060 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1061 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1062 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1063 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1064 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1065 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1066 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1067 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1068 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1069 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1070 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1071 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1072 users to change sender addresses.
1074 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1075 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1076 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1077 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1078 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1079 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1080 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1082 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1083 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1084 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1085 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1086 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1087 message is received.
1093 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1094 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1095 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1096 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1097 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1098 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1099 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1100 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1102 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1103 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1104 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1105 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1106 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1107 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1108 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1109 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1110 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1111 affect file system performance.
1113 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1114 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1115 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1116 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1117 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1119 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1120 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1121 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1122 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1123 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1124 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1125 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1126 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1127 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1128 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1129 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1130 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1134 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1135 .cindex "message" "life of"
1136 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1137 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1138 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1139 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1140 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1141 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1142 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1144 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1145 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1146 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1147 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1148 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1151 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1152 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1153 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1154 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1155 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1157 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1158 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1159 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1160 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1161 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1162 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1163 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1164 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1165 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1166 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1169 .cindex "journal file"
1170 .cindex "file" "journal"
1171 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1172 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1173 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1174 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1175 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1176 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1177 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1178 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1180 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1181 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1182 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1183 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1184 deliveries caused by crashes.
1188 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1189 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1190 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1191 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1192 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1193 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1194 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1195 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1196 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1198 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1199 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1200 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1201 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1202 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1203 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1204 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1205 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1206 the driver's features in general.
1208 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1209 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1210 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1211 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1214 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1215 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1216 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1217 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1218 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1219 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1221 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1222 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1223 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1224 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1225 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1226 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1228 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1229 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1230 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1233 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1234 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1235 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1236 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1237 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1238 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1239 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1240 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1241 configured to fail the address.
1243 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1244 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1245 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1246 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1247 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1248 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1250 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1251 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1252 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1253 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1254 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1255 the address is bounced.
1259 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1260 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1261 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1262 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1263 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1264 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1265 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1266 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1268 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1269 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1270 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1271 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1272 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1273 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1274 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1275 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1280 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1281 .cindex "router" "running details"
1282 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1283 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1284 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1285 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1286 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1287 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1291 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1292 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1293 original address ceases
1294 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1295 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1296 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1297 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1298 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1301 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1302 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1303 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1304 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1305 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1307 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1308 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1309 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1310 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1311 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1313 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1314 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1315 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1316 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1317 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1319 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1320 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1321 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1323 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1324 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1325 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1326 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1328 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1329 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1332 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1333 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1334 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1335 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1336 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1338 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1339 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1340 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1341 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1342 facility for this purpose.
1345 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1346 .cindex "case of local parts"
1347 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1348 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1349 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1350 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1351 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1352 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1353 routed addresses are shown.
1357 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1358 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1359 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1360 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1361 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1362 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1365 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1366 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1367 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1368 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1369 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1370 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1371 of any other conditions.
1373 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1374 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1375 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1377 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1378 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1379 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1380 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1381 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1383 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1384 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1385 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1386 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1387 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1389 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1390 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1391 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1393 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1394 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1396 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1397 of domains that it defines.
1399 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1400 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1401 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1402 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1403 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1404 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1405 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1406 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1407 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1408 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1409 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1411 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1412 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1414 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1415 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1416 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1417 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1418 remaining preconditions.
1420 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1421 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1422 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1423 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1424 could lead to confusion.
1426 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1427 set of addresses that it defines.
1429 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1430 specified files is tested.
1432 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1433 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1434 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1435 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1439 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1440 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1441 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1442 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1443 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1444 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1445 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1449 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1450 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1451 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1454 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1455 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1456 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1457 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1458 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1460 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1461 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1463 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1464 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1465 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1466 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1467 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1468 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1471 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1472 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1473 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1474 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1475 processed entirely independently of each other.
1477 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1478 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1479 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1480 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1481 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1482 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1483 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1484 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1485 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1487 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1488 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1489 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1490 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1491 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1492 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1493 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1494 addresses to the same domain.
1496 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1497 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1498 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1499 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1500 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1501 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1502 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1503 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1505 .cindex "queue runner"
1506 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1507 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1508 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1509 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1510 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1511 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1512 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1513 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1514 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1517 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1518 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1519 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1520 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1521 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1523 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1524 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1525 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1526 messages to other addresses.
1528 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1529 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1530 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1533 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1534 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1535 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1541 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1542 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1543 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1544 .cindex "queue runner"
1545 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1546 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1547 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1548 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1549 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1550 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1551 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1552 passed its retry time.
1553 You can run several queue runners at once.
1555 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1556 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1557 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1558 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1559 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1564 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1566 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1567 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1568 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1569 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1570 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1571 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1572 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1575 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1576 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1577 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1579 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1580 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1581 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1582 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1583 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1588 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1589 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1590 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1591 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1592 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1593 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1594 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1595 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1596 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1597 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1598 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1600 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1601 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1602 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1605 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1606 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1607 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1608 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1609 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1610 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1611 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1616 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1617 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1618 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1619 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1620 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1621 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1622 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1623 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1630 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1632 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1633 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1635 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1636 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1637 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1638 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1641 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1642 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1644 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1645 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1646 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1647 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1651 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1652 following subdirectories are created:
1655 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1656 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1657 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1658 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1659 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1660 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1661 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1664 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1665 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1666 that may be useful to some sites.
1669 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1670 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1671 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1672 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1673 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1674 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1676 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1677 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1678 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1679 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1680 overridden if necessary.
1681 .cindex compiler requirements
1682 .cindex compiler version
1683 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1686 .section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
1687 .cindex "PCRE library"
1688 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1689 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need to
1690 install the PCRE package or the PCRE development package for your operating
1691 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1692 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1693 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE_LIBS
1694 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1695 or set PCRE_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1696 If your operating system has no
1697 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1698 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1699 More information on PCRE is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1701 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1702 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1703 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1704 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1705 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1706 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1707 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1709 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1710 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1711 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1712 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1713 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1714 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1715 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1716 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1718 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1719 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1720 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1721 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1722 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1723 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1724 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1725 Berkeley DB library.
1727 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1728 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1732 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1733 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1735 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1736 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1737 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1738 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1739 filename is used unmodified.
1741 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1742 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1743 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1744 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1746 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1747 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1748 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1750 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1751 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1752 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 4.&'x'&.
1753 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All versions of
1754 Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1755 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1756 page with far newer versions listed.
1757 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1758 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1759 suited to Exim's usage model.
1761 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1762 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1763 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1764 operates on a single file.
1768 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1769 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1770 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1771 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1772 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1776 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1777 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1779 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1780 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1781 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1782 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1783 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1784 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1786 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1787 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1788 in one of these lines:
1793 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1794 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1795 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1796 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1799 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1800 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1802 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1803 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1807 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1808 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1809 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1810 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1811 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1812 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1813 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1814 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1815 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1816 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1817 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1818 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1820 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1821 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1822 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1823 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1824 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1825 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1827 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1828 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1829 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1830 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1831 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1832 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1835 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1836 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1837 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1838 facilities, you need to set
1840 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1842 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1843 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1846 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1847 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1848 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1849 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1850 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1851 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1852 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1854 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1855 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1856 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1857 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1858 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1863 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1864 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1866 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1867 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1868 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1869 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1870 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1871 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1872 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1874 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1875 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1876 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1877 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1878 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1882 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1886 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1887 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1888 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1889 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1890 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1891 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1892 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1893 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1894 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1895 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1898 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1899 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1902 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1905 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1908 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1911 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1912 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1914 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1915 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1918 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1920 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1921 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1925 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1927 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1928 library and include files. For example:
1932 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1933 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1935 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
1936 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1940 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
1943 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1944 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1945 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1950 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1952 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1953 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1954 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
1955 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
1956 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1957 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1958 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1959 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1960 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1961 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1962 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1963 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1966 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1967 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1968 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1970 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
1971 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
1973 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1975 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1976 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1977 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
1978 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
1979 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
1980 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1984 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1985 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1986 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1987 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1988 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1989 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1992 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1993 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1994 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1995 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1996 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
1998 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2003 .section "Dynamically loaded lookup module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2004 .cindex "lookup modules"
2005 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2006 .cindex ".so building"
2007 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2008 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2010 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2011 library dependencies without requiring all users to install all of those
2013 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2015 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2016 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2017 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2018 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2019 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2020 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2022 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2023 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2024 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2033 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2034 .cindex "build directory"
2035 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2036 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2037 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2038 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2039 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2040 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2041 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2043 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2044 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2045 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2046 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2047 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2048 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2049 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2050 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2052 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2053 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2054 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2058 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2059 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2060 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2061 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2062 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2063 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2064 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2068 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2069 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2070 given in addition to the short output.
2074 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2075 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2076 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2077 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2078 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2079 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2080 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2083 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2084 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2086 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2087 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2088 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2089 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2091 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2092 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2093 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2094 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2095 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2096 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2097 and are often not needed.
2099 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2100 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2101 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2102 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2103 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2104 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2105 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2106 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2107 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2110 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2111 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2112 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2113 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2117 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2118 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2119 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2120 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2121 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2122 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2123 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2124 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2125 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2126 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2127 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2128 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2129 containing the lines
2134 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2135 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2137 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2138 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2139 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2142 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2143 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2144 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2145 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2146 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2147 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2148 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2149 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2150 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2151 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2157 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2158 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2159 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2160 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2161 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2162 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2163 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2164 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2167 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2168 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2169 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2170 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2171 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2172 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2173 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2174 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2175 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2176 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2177 syntax. For instance:
2180 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2182 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2183 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2184 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2187 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2188 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2189 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2193 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2194 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2196 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2197 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2198 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2199 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2200 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2201 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2204 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2205 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2207 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2208 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2211 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2212 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2214 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2215 definition of all three of these variables into your
2216 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2219 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2220 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2221 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2222 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2224 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2225 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2226 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2227 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2228 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2231 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2232 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2233 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2234 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2235 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2238 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2240 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2241 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2242 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2243 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2244 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2245 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2249 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2250 .cindex "building Eximon"
2251 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2252 where the files that are involved are
2254 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2255 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2256 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2257 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2258 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2259 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2261 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2262 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2263 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2264 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2265 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2266 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2267 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2271 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2272 .cindex "installing Exim"
2273 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2274 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2275 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2276 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2277 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2278 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2279 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2280 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2281 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2282 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2283 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2284 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2286 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2287 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2288 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2289 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2290 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2291 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2292 alternative files, no default is installed.
2294 .cindex "system aliases file"
2295 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2296 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2297 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2298 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2299 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2300 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2301 and outputs a comment to the user.
2303 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2304 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2305 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2306 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2307 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2309 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2310 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2311 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2312 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2313 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2316 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2317 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2320 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2322 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2323 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2324 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2325 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2326 but this usage is deprecated.
2328 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2329 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2330 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2331 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2332 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2333 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2335 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2336 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2337 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2338 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2339 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2340 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2341 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2343 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2344 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2345 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2348 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2350 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2351 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2352 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2353 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2356 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2358 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2359 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2362 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2363 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2365 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2369 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2371 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2373 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2374 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2375 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2377 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2382 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2383 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2384 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2385 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2386 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2389 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2390 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2391 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2395 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2396 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2397 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2398 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2399 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2405 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2406 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2407 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2408 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2409 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2413 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2414 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2415 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2416 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2417 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2420 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2422 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2424 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2426 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2427 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2428 user agent. For example:
2430 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2431 From: user@your.domain.example
2432 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2433 Subject: Testing Exim
2435 This is a test message.
2438 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2439 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2440 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2442 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2443 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2444 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2445 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2446 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2447 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2449 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2451 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2452 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2453 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2454 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2455 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2457 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2458 .cindex "lock files"
2459 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2460 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2461 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2462 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2463 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2464 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2465 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2466 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2467 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2468 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2469 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2470 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2472 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2473 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2474 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2475 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2476 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2479 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2480 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2481 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2482 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2486 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2487 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2488 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2489 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2490 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2491 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2492 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2493 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2494 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2495 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2496 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2497 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2498 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2500 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2501 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2502 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2503 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2504 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2505 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2508 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2509 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2510 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2511 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2513 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2514 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2515 favourite user agent.
2517 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2518 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2519 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2520 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2521 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2522 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2526 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2527 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2528 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2529 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2530 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2531 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2532 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2533 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2539 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2540 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2541 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2543 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2545 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2546 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2547 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2548 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2549 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2551 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2553 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2555 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2556 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2557 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2565 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2566 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2567 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2568 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2569 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2570 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2571 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2572 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2573 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2576 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2578 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2579 were present before any other options.
2580 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2582 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2583 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2584 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2587 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2588 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2589 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2593 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2594 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2595 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2598 .cindex "queue runner"
2599 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2600 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2601 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2603 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2604 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2605 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2606 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2607 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2608 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2609 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2610 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2613 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2614 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2615 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2616 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2617 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2618 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2621 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2622 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2623 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2624 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2625 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2626 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2628 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2629 .cindex "envelope sender"
2630 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2631 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2632 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2633 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2634 users to set envelope senders.
2636 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2637 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2638 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
2639 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
2640 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2641 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2642 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2644 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2645 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2646 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2647 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2648 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2649 that are available to trusted users.
2651 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2652 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2653 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2654 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2655 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2657 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2658 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2659 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2660 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2662 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2663 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2664 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2665 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2667 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2668 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2673 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2674 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2675 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2681 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2682 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2683 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2684 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2685 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2686 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2687 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2688 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2690 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2691 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2692 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2693 . creates a man page for the options.
2694 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2697 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2704 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2705 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2706 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2707 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2710 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2711 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2712 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2715 .vitem &%--version%&
2716 .oindex "&%--version%&"
2717 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2724 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2727 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2729 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2730 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2731 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2732 clean; it ignores this option.
2737 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2738 .cindex "queue runner"
2739 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2740 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2741 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2743 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2744 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2745 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2746 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2748 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2749 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2750 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2751 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2753 When a listening daemon
2754 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2755 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2756 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2757 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2758 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2759 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2762 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2763 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2764 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2768 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2769 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2770 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2771 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2772 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2773 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2774 because these are reread each time they are used.
2778 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2779 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2783 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2784 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2785 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2786 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2787 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2788 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2790 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2791 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2792 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2793 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2794 test data. A line history is supported.
2796 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2797 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2798 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2799 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2800 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2801 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2802 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2804 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2805 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2806 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2807 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2809 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2810 defined and macros will be expanded.
2811 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2812 available to admin users.
2814 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2816 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2817 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2818 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2819 of a file. For example:
2821 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2823 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2824 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2825 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2826 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2827 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2828 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2829 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2832 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2834 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2835 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2836 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2837 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2838 system filters are recognized.
2840 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2842 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2843 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2844 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2845 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2846 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2847 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2848 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2849 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2852 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2853 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2854 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2856 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2858 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2859 variables that are used by the user filter.
2861 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2866 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2867 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2868 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2871 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2872 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2873 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2874 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2876 When testing a filter file,
2877 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2878 .cindex "envelope sender"
2879 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2880 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2881 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2882 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2883 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2886 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2888 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2889 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2890 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2893 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2895 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2896 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2897 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2898 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2899 actually being delivered.
2901 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2903 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2904 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2905 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2908 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2910 .cindex affix "filter testing"
2911 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2912 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2915 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2917 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2918 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2919 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2920 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2921 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2922 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2923 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2924 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2925 after a full stop. For example:
2927 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2928 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2930 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2931 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2932 conversion to the canonical form is
2933 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2935 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2936 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2937 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2938 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2939 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2943 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2944 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2945 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2948 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2949 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2950 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2952 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2953 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2954 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2955 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2956 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2957 session were authenticated.
2959 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2960 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2961 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2963 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2964 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2965 specialized SMTP test program such as
2966 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
2968 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2970 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2971 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2972 updating the callout cache database.
2976 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2977 .cindex "building alias file"
2978 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2979 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2980 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2981 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2982 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2985 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2986 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2987 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2988 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2989 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2990 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2993 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
2995 .oindex "&%-bI:help%&"
2996 .cindex "querying exim information"
2997 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
2998 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
2999 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3000 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3001 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3004 .oindex "&%-bI:dscp%&"
3005 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3006 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3007 recognised DSCP names.
3009 .vitem &%-bI:sieve%&
3010 .oindex "&%-bI:sieve%&"
3011 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3012 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3013 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3014 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3015 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3016 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3017 way to guarantee a correct response.
3021 .cindex "local message reception"
3022 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3023 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3024 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3025 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3026 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3027 if no other conflicting option is present.
3029 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3030 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3031 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3032 suppressing this for special cases.
3034 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3035 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
3037 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3038 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3039 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3042 .cindex "message" "format"
3043 .cindex "format" "message"
3044 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3045 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3046 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3047 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3048 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3050 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3051 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3053 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3054 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3055 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3056 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3057 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3059 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3060 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3061 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3062 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3063 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3065 .vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
3066 .oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
3067 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3068 .cindex "malware scan test"
3069 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3070 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3071 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3072 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3073 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3074 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3075 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3077 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3078 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3079 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3080 This option requires admin privileges.
3082 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3083 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3084 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3088 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3089 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3090 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3091 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3092 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3093 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3094 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3096 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3097 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3098 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3099 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3100 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3102 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3103 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3104 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3105 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3110 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3111 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3112 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3113 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3114 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3115 arguments, for example:
3117 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3119 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3120 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3121 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3122 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3123 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3124 users, the output is as in this example:
3126 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3128 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3129 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3131 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3132 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3133 backward compatibility.)
3134 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3135 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3137 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3138 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3139 name will not be output.
3141 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3142 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3143 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3144 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3145 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3146 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3147 written directly into the spool directory.
3149 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3151 exim -bP +local_domains
3153 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3154 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3156 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3157 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3158 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3159 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3160 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3161 that driver are output. For example:
3163 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3165 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3166 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3167 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3168 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3169 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3172 .cindex "environment"
3173 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3174 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3177 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3178 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3179 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3180 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3181 The output format is one item per line.
3182 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3183 the exit status will be nonzero.
3187 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3188 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3189 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3190 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3191 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3192 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3193 to allow any user to see the queue.
3195 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3197 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3198 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3201 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3202 .cindex "size" "of message"
3203 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3204 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3205 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3206 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3207 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3208 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3209 before the sender address.
3211 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3212 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3213 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3215 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3216 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3217 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3218 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3219 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3225 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3226 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3227 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3233 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3234 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3235 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3236 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3241 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3242 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3243 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3244 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3248 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3252 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3257 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3258 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3259 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3260 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3265 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3266 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3267 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3268 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3269 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3271 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3272 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3274 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3275 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3276 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3277 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3278 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3279 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3280 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3281 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3282 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3284 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3285 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3290 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3291 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3292 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3293 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3294 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3295 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3296 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3300 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3301 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3302 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3303 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3304 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3305 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3306 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3307 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3308 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3310 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3311 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3312 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3314 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3315 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3316 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3317 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3319 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3320 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3321 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3323 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3324 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3325 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3326 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3327 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3329 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3330 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3334 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3335 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3336 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3337 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3338 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3339 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3340 messages to the MTA.
3343 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3344 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3345 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3346 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3347 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3348 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3349 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3353 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3354 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3355 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3356 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3357 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3358 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3359 the listening daemon.
3363 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3364 .cindex "address" "testing"
3365 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3366 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3367 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3368 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3369 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3371 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3372 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3374 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3375 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3378 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3379 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3380 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3381 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3382 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3385 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3386 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3387 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3388 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3390 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3391 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3392 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3393 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3396 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3397 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3399 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3400 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3401 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3402 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3403 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3404 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3409 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3410 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3411 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3412 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3413 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3414 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3416 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3417 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3418 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3419 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3420 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3421 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3422 dynamic testing facilities.
3426 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3427 .cindex "address" "verification"
3428 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3429 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3430 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3431 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3432 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3433 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3435 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3436 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3437 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3439 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3440 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3442 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3443 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3446 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3447 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3448 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3449 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3450 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3452 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3453 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3454 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3455 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3456 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3457 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3460 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3461 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3462 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3465 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3466 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3467 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3468 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3470 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3471 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3472 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3473 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3477 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3478 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3485 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3486 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3487 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3488 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3490 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3491 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3492 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3493 each port only when the first connection is received.
3495 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3496 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3498 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3500 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3501 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3502 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3503 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3504 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3505 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3506 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3507 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3508 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3510 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3511 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3512 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3513 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3514 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3515 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3516 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3517 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3518 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3520 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3521 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3522 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3523 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3524 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3525 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3526 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3528 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3529 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3530 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3531 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3532 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3533 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3534 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3536 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3537 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3538 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3541 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3542 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3543 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3544 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3545 specified by this option.
3548 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3550 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3551 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3552 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3553 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3554 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3555 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3557 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3558 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3559 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3560 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3561 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3562 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3563 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3565 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3566 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3567 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3573 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3574 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3577 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3579 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3580 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3583 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3585 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3586 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3587 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3588 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3589 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3590 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3591 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3594 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3595 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3596 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3597 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3598 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3599 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3600 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3603 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3604 &`auth `& authenticators
3605 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3606 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3607 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3608 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3609 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3610 &`filter `& filter handling
3611 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3612 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3613 &`ident `& ident lookup
3614 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3615 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3616 &`load `& system load checks
3617 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3618 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3619 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3620 &`memory `& memory handling
3621 &`noutf8 `& modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing
3622 &`pid `& modifier: add pid to debug output lines
3623 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3624 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3625 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3626 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3627 &`retry `& retry handling
3628 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3629 &`route `& address routing
3630 &`timestamp `& modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines
3632 &`transport `& transports
3633 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3634 &`verify `& address verification logic
3635 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3637 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3638 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3639 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3640 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3641 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3642 turn everything off.
3644 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3645 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3646 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3647 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3648 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3651 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3652 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3653 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3654 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3655 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3658 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3659 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3662 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3663 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3664 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3665 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3666 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3667 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3669 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3670 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3672 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3674 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3675 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3676 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3677 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3680 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3681 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3682 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3683 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3687 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3688 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3689 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3690 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3691 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3692 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3693 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3694 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3697 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3698 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3699 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3700 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3701 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3703 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3705 .cindex "sender" "name"
3706 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3707 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3708 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3709 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3710 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3711 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3713 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3715 .cindex "sender" "address"
3716 .cindex "address" "sender"
3717 .cindex "trusted users"
3718 .cindex "envelope sender"
3719 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3720 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3721 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3722 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3725 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3726 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3727 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3728 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3731 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3732 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3733 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3734 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3735 examples of shell commands:
3737 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3738 exim -f "" user@domain
3740 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3741 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3744 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3745 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3746 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3747 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3750 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3751 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3752 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3753 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3754 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3755 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3759 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3760 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3762 control = suppress_local_fixups
3764 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3765 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3768 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3771 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3773 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3774 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3775 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3780 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3781 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3782 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3783 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3784 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3785 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3787 .vitem &%-L%&&~<&'tag'&>
3789 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3790 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3791 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3792 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3793 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3794 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3796 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3798 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3800 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3801 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3802 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3803 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3804 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3805 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3806 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3809 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3810 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3811 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3812 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3813 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3814 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3816 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3817 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3818 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3819 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3821 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3823 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3824 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3825 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3826 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3827 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3828 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3829 can be used only by an admin user.
3831 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3832 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3834 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3835 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3836 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3837 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3838 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3839 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3840 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3841 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3845 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3846 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3847 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3851 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3852 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3853 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3855 .vitem &%-MCG%&&~<&'queue&~name'&>
3857 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3858 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3859 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3863 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3864 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3865 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3869 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3870 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3871 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3873 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3875 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3876 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3877 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3878 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3879 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3880 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3884 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3885 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3886 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3891 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3892 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3893 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3895 .vitem &%-MCt%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3897 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3898 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3899 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
3900 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
3902 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3904 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3905 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3906 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
3907 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3908 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3909 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3910 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3911 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3912 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3913 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3914 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3915 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3916 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3918 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3920 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3921 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3922 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3923 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3924 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3925 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3926 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3927 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3929 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3931 .cindex "freezing messages"
3932 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3933 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3934 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3935 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3936 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3937 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3940 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3942 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3943 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3944 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3945 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3946 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3947 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3948 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3949 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3952 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3954 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3955 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3956 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3957 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3958 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3960 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3962 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3963 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3964 .cindex "removing recipients"
3965 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3966 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3967 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3968 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3969 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3970 can be used only by an admin user.
3972 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3974 .cindex "removing messages"
3975 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3976 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3977 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3978 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3979 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3980 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3981 placed in the queue.
3986 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
3987 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
3988 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
3992 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3994 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3995 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3996 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3997 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3998 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3999 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4000 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4001 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4002 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4004 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4006 .cindex "thawing messages"
4007 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4008 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4009 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4010 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4011 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4012 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4015 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4017 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4018 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4019 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4020 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4022 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4024 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4025 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4026 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4027 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4028 only by an admin user.
4030 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4032 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4033 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4034 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4035 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4036 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4038 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
4040 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4041 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4042 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4043 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4047 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
4048 treats it that way too.
4052 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4053 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4054 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4055 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4056 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4057 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4058 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4061 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4062 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4063 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4064 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4065 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4066 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4067 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4072 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4073 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4074 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4075 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4077 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
4079 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4082 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
4084 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4085 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4086 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4089 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
4091 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4092 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4093 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4094 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4095 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4096 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4100 .cindex "background delivery"
4101 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4102 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4103 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4104 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4105 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4106 processes to finish.
4108 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4109 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4110 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4111 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4113 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4114 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4115 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4116 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4120 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4121 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4122 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4123 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4124 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4125 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4127 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4128 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4131 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4132 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4134 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4135 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4136 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4137 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4142 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4147 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4148 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4149 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4150 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4151 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4152 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4153 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4154 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4155 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4156 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4161 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4162 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4163 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4164 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4165 configuration file is in effect.
4167 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4168 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4169 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4170 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4171 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4172 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4173 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4174 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4175 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4180 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4181 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4182 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4185 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4187 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4188 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4189 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4190 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4194 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4195 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4196 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4197 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4198 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4202 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4203 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4204 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4205 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4206 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4210 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4211 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4216 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4217 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4222 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4223 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4224 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4225 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4226 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4227 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4230 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
4231 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4233 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
4235 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4236 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4237 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4238 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4239 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4240 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4242 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4243 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4245 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4247 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4248 followed by a colon and the port number:
4250 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4252 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4253 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4254 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4255 whichever one is last.
4257 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
4259 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4260 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4261 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4262 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4263 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4264 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4266 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
4268 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4269 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4270 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4271 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4272 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4273 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4275 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
4277 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4278 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4279 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4280 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4281 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4282 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4283 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4284 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4286 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4288 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4289 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4290 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4291 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4292 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4294 .vitem &%-oMm%&&~<&'message&~reference'&>
4296 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4297 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4298 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4299 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4300 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4301 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4302 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4304 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4305 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4306 is sending the bounce.
4308 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4310 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4311 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4312 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4313 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4314 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4315 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4316 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4317 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4318 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4319 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4321 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4323 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4324 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4325 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4326 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4327 uses the name it is given.
4329 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4331 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4332 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4333 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4334 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4335 used, when there is no default.
4339 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4340 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4341 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4342 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4346 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4347 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4348 whatever that means.
4350 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4352 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4353 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4354 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4355 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4356 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4357 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4358 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4360 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4362 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4363 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4364 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4365 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4366 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4368 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4370 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4371 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4372 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4373 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4374 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4375 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4379 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4381 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4383 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4384 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4385 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4386 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4387 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4388 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4389 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4390 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4394 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4395 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4396 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4397 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4402 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4403 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4404 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4405 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4408 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4410 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4412 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4414 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4415 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4416 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4417 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4418 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4419 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4423 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4424 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4425 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4426 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4427 and &%-S%& options).
4429 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4430 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4431 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4432 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4433 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4434 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4435 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4438 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4439 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4440 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4441 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4442 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4445 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4446 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4447 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4448 this to be repeated periodically.
4450 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4451 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4452 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4453 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4455 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4456 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4457 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4459 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4460 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4461 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4462 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4466 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4467 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4468 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4469 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4470 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4471 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4474 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4475 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4476 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4477 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4478 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4479 delivered down a single SMTP
4480 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4481 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4482 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4483 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4484 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4487 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4489 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4490 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4491 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4492 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4493 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4495 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4497 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4498 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4499 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4500 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4501 their retry times are tried.
4503 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4505 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4506 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4509 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4511 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4512 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4513 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4516 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4519 .cindex "named queues"
4520 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4521 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4522 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4523 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4524 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4525 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4527 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4528 will specify a queue to operate on.
4531 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4533 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4536 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4537 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4538 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4539 starting message id. For example:
4541 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4543 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4544 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4545 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4547 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4549 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4550 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4551 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4552 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4553 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4554 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4556 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4557 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4558 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4559 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4560 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4561 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4562 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4563 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4564 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4566 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4568 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4569 process every 30 minutes.
4571 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4572 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4574 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4576 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4579 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4581 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4583 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4585 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4586 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4587 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4588 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4589 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4590 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4591 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4593 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4594 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4595 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4596 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4597 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4598 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4600 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4601 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4603 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4605 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4606 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4607 applied to each queue run.
4609 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4610 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4611 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4612 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4613 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4614 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4615 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4616 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4617 address will be skipped.
4619 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4620 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4621 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4624 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4625 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4626 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4627 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4628 an arbitrary command instead.
4632 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4634 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4636 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4637 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4638 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4639 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4640 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4641 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4643 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4645 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4646 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4647 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4651 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4652 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4653 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4654 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4655 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4656 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4657 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4658 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4659 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4661 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4662 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4663 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4664 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4665 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4666 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4667 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4668 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4669 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4670 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4671 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4673 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4674 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4675 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4676 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4677 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4678 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4680 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4681 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4682 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4683 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4684 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4685 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4686 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4687 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4688 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4692 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4693 compatibility with Sendmail.
4695 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4696 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4697 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4698 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4699 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4700 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4701 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4702 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4707 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4708 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4709 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4710 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4711 set. Exim ignores this option.
4715 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4716 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4717 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4718 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4719 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4720 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4725 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4726 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4727 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4730 .vitem &%-X%&&~<&'logfile'&>
4732 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4733 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4735 .vitem &%-z%&&~<&'log-line'&>
4737 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4738 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4739 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4747 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4748 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4749 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4750 . creates a man page for the options.
4751 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4754 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4765 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4766 "The runtime configuration file"
4768 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4769 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4770 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4771 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4772 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4773 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4774 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4775 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4776 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4779 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4780 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4781 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4782 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4783 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4784 actually alter the string.
4786 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4787 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4788 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4789 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4790 existing file in the list.
4793 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4794 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4795 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4796 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4797 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4798 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4799 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4800 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4801 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4802 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4804 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4805 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4806 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4807 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4808 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4810 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4811 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4812 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4813 compromise the Exim user account.
4815 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4816 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4817 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4818 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4819 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4820 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4825 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4826 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4827 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4828 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4829 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4830 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4831 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4832 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4833 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4834 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4835 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4837 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4838 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4839 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4840 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4841 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4842 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4843 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4844 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4845 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4848 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4849 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4850 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4851 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4852 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4854 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4855 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4856 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4857 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4858 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4859 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4861 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4862 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4863 necessarily be discarded.
4864 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4865 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4866 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4867 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4868 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4869 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4871 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4872 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4873 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4874 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4875 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4876 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4877 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4879 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4880 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4881 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4885 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4886 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4887 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4888 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4889 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4890 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4891 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
4892 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
4895 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4898 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4899 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4900 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4902 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4903 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4904 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4906 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4907 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4908 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4910 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4911 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4912 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4913 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4916 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4917 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4918 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4920 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4921 want to use this feature, you must set
4923 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4925 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4926 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4929 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4930 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4931 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4932 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4934 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4935 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4936 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4937 and does not introduce a comment.
4939 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4940 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4941 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4942 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4943 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4945 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4946 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4947 change settings as required.
4949 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4950 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4951 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4952 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4953 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4958 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4959 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4960 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4961 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4962 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4963 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
4966 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
4967 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
4969 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
4970 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4971 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
4972 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
4973 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
4976 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4977 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4978 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4979 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4981 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4982 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4985 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4988 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4989 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4994 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4995 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4996 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4997 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4998 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4999 definition, and must be of the form
5001 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5003 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5004 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5005 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5006 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5007 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5009 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5010 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5011 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5013 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5014 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5015 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5016 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5017 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5018 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5019 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5022 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5023 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5025 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5026 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5027 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5028 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5029 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5030 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5033 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5034 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5035 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5040 MAC == updated value
5042 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5043 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5044 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5045 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5049 MAC == MAC and something added
5051 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5052 from a number of other files.
5054 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5055 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5056 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5057 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5058 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5063 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5064 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5065 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5066 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5068 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5069 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5071 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5073 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5075 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5076 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5077 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5080 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5081 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5082 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5083 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5084 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5087 The following classes of macros are defined:
5089 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5090 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5091 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5092 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5093 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5094 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5095 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5096 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5097 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5098 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5099 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5100 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5103 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5106 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5107 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5108 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5109 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5110 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5111 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5112 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5114 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5115 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5116 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5120 message_size_limit = 50M
5122 message_size_limit = 100M
5125 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5126 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5127 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5128 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5129 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5131 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5132 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5133 in this line"& will always be true.
5135 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5136 to clarify complicated nestings.
5140 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5141 .cindex "common option syntax"
5142 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5143 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5144 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5145 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5146 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5147 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5148 space) and then the value. For example:
5150 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5152 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5153 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5154 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5155 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5156 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5157 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5158 word &"hide"&. For example:
5160 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5162 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5164 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5166 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5167 all instances of the same driver.
5169 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5170 that are found in option settings.
5173 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5174 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5175 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5176 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5177 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5178 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5179 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5180 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5181 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5182 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5183 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5184 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5189 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5194 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5199 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5200 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5201 .cindex "format" "integer"
5202 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5203 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5204 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5205 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5208 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5209 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5210 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5212 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5213 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5214 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5218 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5219 .cindex "integer format"
5220 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5221 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5222 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5223 Such options are always output in octal.
5226 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5227 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5228 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5229 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5230 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5234 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5235 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5236 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5237 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5238 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5248 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5249 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5250 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5254 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5255 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5256 .cindex "format" "string"
5257 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5258 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5259 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5260 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5261 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5262 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5263 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5264 therefore equivalent:
5266 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5267 trusted_users = uucp:\
5268 # This comment line is ignored
5271 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5272 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5273 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5274 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5275 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5278 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5279 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5280 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5282 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5283 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5287 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5288 character, that character replaces the pair.
5290 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5291 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5292 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5293 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5294 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5295 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5298 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5299 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5300 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5301 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5302 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5303 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5304 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5305 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5306 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5307 within a quoted configuration string.
5310 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5311 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5312 .cindex "format" "user name"
5313 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5314 .cindex "format" "group name"
5315 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5316 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5317 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5318 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5321 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5322 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5323 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5324 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5325 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5326 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5327 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5328 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5329 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5330 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5331 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5333 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5334 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5335 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5336 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5337 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5338 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5341 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5343 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5345 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5346 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
5347 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
5348 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5350 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5351 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5352 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5353 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5354 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5355 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5356 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5357 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5359 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5361 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5362 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5363 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5365 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5366 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5367 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5368 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5369 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5370 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5371 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5372 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5373 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5375 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5377 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5378 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5379 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5380 the value in quotes. For example:
5382 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5384 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5385 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5386 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5387 enclosing an empty list item.
5391 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5392 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5393 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5394 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5396 senders = user@domain :
5398 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5399 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5400 items, the second of which is empty:
5402 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5404 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5405 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5406 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5407 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5411 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5412 is at the end of the list.
5417 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5418 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5419 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5420 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5421 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5422 a sequence of lines like this:
5424 <&'instance name'&>:
5429 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5430 followed by three options settings:
5435 transport = local_delivery
5437 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5438 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5439 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5440 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5441 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5442 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5444 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5445 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5447 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5448 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5449 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5450 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5451 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5454 .cindex "generic options"
5455 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5456 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5457 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5458 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5459 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5460 .cindex "private options"
5461 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5462 they all have default values.
5464 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5465 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5466 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5468 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5469 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5470 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5471 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5472 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5473 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5474 configuration lines:
5479 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5480 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5481 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5482 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5488 command_timeout = 10s
5490 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5491 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5494 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5495 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5496 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5504 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5505 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5507 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5508 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5509 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5510 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5511 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5512 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5513 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5514 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5515 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5516 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5517 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5521 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5522 All macros should be defined before any options.
5524 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5526 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5528 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5529 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5530 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5531 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5533 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5534 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5535 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5538 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5539 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5540 in the file, after the macros.
5541 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5543 # primary_hostname =
5545 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5546 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5547 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5548 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5550 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5552 domainlist local_domains = @
5553 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5554 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5556 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5557 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5558 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5559 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5561 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5562 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5565 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5566 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5567 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5568 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5569 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5570 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5572 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5573 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5574 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5575 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5576 domain is permitted.
5578 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5579 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5580 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5581 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5582 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5583 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5585 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5586 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5587 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5589 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5591 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5592 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5594 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5595 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5596 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5597 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5598 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5599 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5600 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5601 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5602 contents of a message to be checked.
5604 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5606 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5607 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5609 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5610 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5611 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5612 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5614 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5616 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5617 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5618 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5620 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5621 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5622 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5623 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5624 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5625 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5626 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5628 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5630 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5631 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5633 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5634 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5635 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5636 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5637 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5638 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5639 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5640 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5641 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5642 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5643 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5644 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5645 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5646 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5647 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5648 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5650 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5651 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5652 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5653 which should be used in preference to 587.
5654 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5656 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5658 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5661 # qualify_recipient =
5663 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5664 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5665 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5666 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5667 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5668 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5670 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5671 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5672 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5673 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5675 # allow_domain_literals
5677 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5678 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5679 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5680 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5681 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5682 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5684 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5688 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5689 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5690 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5691 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5692 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5693 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5694 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5695 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5697 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5698 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5703 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5704 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5705 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5706 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5707 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5708 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5711 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5712 1413 (hence their names):
5715 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5717 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5718 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5719 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5720 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5721 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5722 information, you can change this.
5724 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5725 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5730 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5731 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5732 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5733 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5735 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5736 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5738 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5739 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5741 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5744 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5745 +tls_certificate_verified
5748 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5750 # percent_hack_domains =
5752 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5753 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5754 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5756 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5757 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5758 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5759 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5760 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5761 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5762 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5763 always bounce messages.
5765 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5766 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5768 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5769 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5770 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5771 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5772 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5774 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5775 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5776 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5777 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5778 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5781 # split_spool_directory = true
5784 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5785 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5786 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5787 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5788 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5789 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5790 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5792 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5795 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5796 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5797 that are not 8-bit clean.
5799 # accept_8bitmime = false
5802 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5803 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5804 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5805 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5806 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the $%timezone%$ runtime
5807 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5809 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5810 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5814 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5815 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5816 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5817 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5818 It starts with the line
5822 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5823 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5824 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5826 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5827 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5828 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5829 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5830 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5831 result of the ACL processing.
5835 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5840 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5841 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5842 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5843 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5844 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5845 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5847 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5848 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5849 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5852 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5853 domains = +local_domains
5854 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5856 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5857 domains = !+local_domains
5858 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5860 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5861 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5862 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5863 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5864 in Internet mail addresses.
5866 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5867 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5868 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5869 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5870 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5871 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5872 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5873 policy of being as safe as possible.
5875 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5876 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5877 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5878 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5879 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5880 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5882 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5883 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5884 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5885 have to modify this rule.
5887 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5888 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5889 common convention of local parts constructed as
5890 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5891 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5892 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5893 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5894 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5895 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5897 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5898 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5899 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5900 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5901 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5902 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5903 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5905 accept local_parts = postmaster
5906 domains = +local_domains
5908 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5909 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5910 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5911 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5912 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5914 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5915 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5916 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5918 require verify = sender
5920 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5921 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5922 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5923 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5924 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5925 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5926 discusses the details of address verification.
5928 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5929 control = submission
5931 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5932 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5933 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5934 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5935 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5936 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5937 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5938 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5939 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5941 accept authenticated = *
5942 control = submission
5944 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5945 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5946 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5947 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5948 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5949 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5951 require message = relay not permitted
5952 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
5954 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5955 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5957 require verify = recipient
5959 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5960 fails, the address is rejected.
5962 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5963 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5965 # dnslists = black.list.example
5967 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5968 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5969 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5970 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5972 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5973 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5974 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5977 # require verify = csa
5979 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5980 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5985 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5986 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5990 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5991 of this ACL are commented out:
5994 # message = This message contains a virus \
5997 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5998 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5999 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6000 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6002 # warn spam = nobody
6003 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6004 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6005 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6006 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6008 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6009 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6010 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6011 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6012 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6013 whatever the spam score.
6017 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6020 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6021 .cindex "default" "routers"
6022 .cindex "routers" "default"
6023 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6028 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6029 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6030 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6031 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6032 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6035 # driver = ipliteral
6036 # domains = !+local_domains
6037 # transport = remote_smtp
6039 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6040 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6041 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6042 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6043 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6045 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6046 macro has been defined, per
6048 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6057 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6058 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6059 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6060 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6064 driver = manualroute
6065 domains = ! +local_domains
6066 transport = smarthost_smtp
6067 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6068 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6071 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6072 specified by the line
6074 domains = ! +local_domains
6076 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6077 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6078 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6079 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6080 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6081 passed on to the following routers.
6083 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6084 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6085 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6086 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6088 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6089 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6090 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6091 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6092 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6093 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6094 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6099 domains = ! +local_domains
6100 transport = remote_smtp
6101 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6104 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6106 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6107 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6108 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6109 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6110 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6112 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6113 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6114 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6115 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6116 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6117 the address fails and is bounced.
6119 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6120 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6121 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6122 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6123 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6124 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6125 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6132 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6134 file_transport = address_file
6135 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6137 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6138 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6139 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6140 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6141 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6144 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6145 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6146 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6147 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6152 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6153 # local_part_suffix_optional
6154 file = $home/.forward
6159 file_transport = address_file
6160 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6161 reply_transport = address_reply
6163 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6164 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6165 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6166 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6167 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6170 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6171 # local_part_suffix_optional
6173 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6174 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6175 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6176 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6177 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6178 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6179 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6181 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6182 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6183 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6184 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6186 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6187 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6188 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6189 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6190 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6191 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6192 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6194 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6195 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6196 There are two reasons for doing this:
6199 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6200 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6203 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6204 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6205 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6206 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6210 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6211 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6212 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6213 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6215 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6216 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6217 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6219 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6221 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6227 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6228 # local_part_suffix_optional
6229 transport = local_delivery
6231 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6232 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6233 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6234 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6235 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6238 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6239 .cindex "default" "transports"
6240 .cindex "transports" "default"
6241 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6242 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6243 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6247 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6251 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6253 dnssec_request_domains = *
6260 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6261 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6262 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6263 with over-long lines. The built-in macro _HAVE_DANE guards configuration
6264 to try to use DNSSEC for all queries and to use DANE for delivery;
6265 see section &<<SECDANE>>& for more details.
6267 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6268 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6269 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6270 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6272 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6273 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6274 usual federated system.
6279 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6283 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6284 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6285 hosts_require_tls = *
6286 tls_verify_hosts = *
6287 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this won't matter, but if you
6288 # have to comment it out then this will at least log whether you succeed
6290 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6292 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6293 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6294 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6295 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6296 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6297 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6299 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6300 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6303 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6310 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6311 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6312 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6313 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6314 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6315 then no other options are defined.
6316 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6317 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6318 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6319 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6320 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6321 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6322 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6323 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6324 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6325 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6326 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6328 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6330 All other options are defaulted.
6334 file = /var/mail/$local_part
6341 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6342 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
6343 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6344 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6345 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6346 show how this can be done.
6348 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6349 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6350 similarly-named options above.
6356 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6357 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6358 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6359 be returned to the sender.
6367 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6368 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6369 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6374 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6379 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6380 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6381 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6382 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6383 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6384 introduced by the line
6388 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6391 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6393 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6394 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6395 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6396 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6397 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6399 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6400 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6401 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6404 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6405 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6409 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6410 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6414 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6415 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6416 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6418 begin authenticators
6420 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6421 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6422 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6423 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6424 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6425 to support most MUA software.
6427 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6430 # driver = plaintext
6431 # server_set_id = $auth2
6432 # server_prompts = :
6433 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6434 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6436 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6439 # driver = plaintext
6440 # server_set_id = $auth1
6441 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6442 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6443 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6446 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6447 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6448 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6449 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6450 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6451 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6452 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6453 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6455 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6456 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6457 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6458 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6460 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6461 usercode and password are in different positions.
6462 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6464 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6469 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6471 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6473 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6475 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6476 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6477 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6478 regular expressions is discussed in
6479 online Perl manpages, in
6480 many Perl reference books, and also in
6481 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6482 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6483 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6484 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6485 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6487 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6488 are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
6489 description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
6490 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
6491 the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6494 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6495 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6496 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6497 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6499 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6501 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6502 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6503 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6504 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6505 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6506 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6509 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6510 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6511 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6512 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6513 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6514 match anywhere in the subject string.
6516 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6517 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6519 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6521 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6524 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6526 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6527 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6532 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6534 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6535 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6536 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6537 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6538 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6539 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6542 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6543 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6544 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6545 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6546 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6547 The key for the lookup is specified as part of the string expansion.
6549 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6550 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6551 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6552 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6553 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6554 The key for the lookup is given by the context in which the list is expanded.
6557 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6558 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6559 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6560 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6561 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6562 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6564 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6565 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6566 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6567 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6568 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6570 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6571 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6573 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6574 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6575 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6576 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6577 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6579 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6580 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6582 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6583 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6585 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6586 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6587 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6592 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6593 matches the list item.
6595 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6596 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6598 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6600 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6601 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6602 causes a second lookup to occur.
6604 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6605 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6606 lookup is permitted.
6609 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6610 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6611 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6612 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6615 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6616 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6617 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6619 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6620 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6621 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6622 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6625 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6626 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6627 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6632 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6633 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6634 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6639 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6640 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6641 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6642 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6645 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6646 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6647 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6648 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6649 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6650 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6651 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6652 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6653 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6655 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6656 &url(http://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6657 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6658 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6660 . --- 2018-09-07: corpit.ru http:-only
6661 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6662 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6663 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6664 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6666 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6667 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6668 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6669 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6670 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6671 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6672 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6674 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6675 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6676 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6677 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6678 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6679 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6680 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6682 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6683 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6685 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6686 &(dbmjz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6687 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6688 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6689 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6690 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6691 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6693 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6694 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6695 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6697 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6698 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6699 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6700 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6701 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6702 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6703 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6704 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6705 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6706 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6708 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6709 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6710 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6711 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6712 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6713 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6714 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6715 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6716 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6718 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6719 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6720 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6721 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6722 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6723 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6724 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6726 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6727 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6728 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6729 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6731 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6732 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6733 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6734 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6735 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6737 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6738 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6739 lookup types support only literal keys.
6741 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6742 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6743 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6746 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6747 IPv4. Such addresses being searched for are converted to IPv4.
6752 .cindex json "lookup type"
6753 .cindex JSON expansions
6754 &(json)&: The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6755 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6756 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6757 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6758 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6759 of the JSON structure.
6760 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6761 nunbered array element is selected.
6762 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6763 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6764 or array; for the latter two a string-representation os the JSON
6766 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6769 .cindex "linear search"
6770 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6771 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6772 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6773 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6774 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6775 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6776 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6777 in the file is used.
6779 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6780 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6781 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6782 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6783 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6788 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6789 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6790 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6791 wildcarding of any kind.
6793 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6794 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6795 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6796 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6797 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6798 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6799 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6800 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6801 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6804 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6805 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6806 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6807 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6808 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6809 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6810 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6811 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6814 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6815 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6816 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6817 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6818 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6819 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6820 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6821 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6822 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6824 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6825 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6826 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6827 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6829 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6830 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6833 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6835 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6836 *fish data for anythingfish
6839 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6840 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6842 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6844 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6845 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6846 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6848 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6850 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6851 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6852 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6854 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6857 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6858 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6859 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6860 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6861 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6863 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6864 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6865 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6866 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6867 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6870 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6871 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6872 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6875 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6877 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6880 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6881 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6882 be followed by optional colons.
6884 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6885 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6886 lookup types support only literal keys.
6889 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
6890 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
6891 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method.
6892 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
6896 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
6897 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6898 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6899 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6900 many of them are given in later sections.
6903 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6904 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6905 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6906 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6907 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6909 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6910 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6911 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6913 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6914 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6915 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6916 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6917 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6918 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6919 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6921 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6922 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6923 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6924 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6926 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6927 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6928 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6929 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6931 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6932 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6933 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6934 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6936 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6937 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6938 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6939 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6940 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6941 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6942 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6943 password value. For example:
6945 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6948 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6949 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6950 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6951 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6954 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
6955 .cindex lookup Redis
6956 &(redis)&: The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
6957 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6960 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6961 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6962 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a filename followed by an SQL statement
6963 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6966 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6967 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6969 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6970 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6971 . --- still http:-only, 2018-09-07
6972 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6973 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6974 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6975 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6976 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6977 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6978 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6980 require condition = \
6981 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6983 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6984 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6985 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6986 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6991 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6992 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6993 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6994 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6995 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6996 options such as a list of local domains.
6998 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6999 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7000 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7001 or may give up altogether.
7005 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7006 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7007 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7008 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7009 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7010 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7011 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7012 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7014 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7015 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7016 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7018 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7019 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7020 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7022 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7023 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7024 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7025 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7026 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7027 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7028 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7029 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7030 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7031 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7033 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7035 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7036 looks up these keys, in this order:
7042 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7043 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7044 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7045 Exim move on to try the next key.
7049 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7050 .cindex "partial matching"
7051 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7052 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7053 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7054 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7055 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7056 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7057 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7058 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7059 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7060 a key in a DBM file is
7062 *.dates.fict.example
7064 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7065 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7066 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7069 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7070 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7071 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7073 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7074 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7075 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7076 partial matching keys
7077 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7078 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7079 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7081 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7082 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7083 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7084 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7085 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7086 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7089 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7090 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7091 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7092 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7093 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7094 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7096 2250.dates.fict.example
7097 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7098 *.dates.fict.example
7101 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7104 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7105 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7106 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7107 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7108 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7109 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7111 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7113 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7114 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7115 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7116 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7118 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7120 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7121 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7123 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7124 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7125 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7128 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7130 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7131 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7133 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7134 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7135 for &"*"& on its own.
7137 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7141 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7142 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7143 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7144 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7145 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7146 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7147 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7149 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7150 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7151 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7152 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7153 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7158 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7159 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7160 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7161 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7162 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7163 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7164 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7166 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7167 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7168 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7169 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7170 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7171 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7173 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7174 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7180 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7181 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7182 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7183 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7184 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7185 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7189 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7190 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7192 [name="$local_part"]
7194 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7195 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7196 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7197 of the following form is provided:
7199 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7201 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
7203 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7205 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7206 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7207 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7212 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7213 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7214 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7215 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7216 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7217 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7218 an expansion string could contain:
7220 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7222 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7223 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7224 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7225 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7227 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7228 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7229 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7231 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7232 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7233 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7234 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7235 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7237 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7239 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7240 white space is ignored.
7241 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7242 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7243 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7245 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7246 When the type is PTR,
7247 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7248 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7250 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7252 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7253 altered and nothing is added.
7255 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7256 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7257 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7258 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7259 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7260 The field separator can be modified as above.
7262 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7263 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7264 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7265 unless a field separator is specified.
7266 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7268 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7270 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7271 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7272 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7274 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7275 white space is ignored.
7277 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7278 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7279 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7280 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7283 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7286 .section "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" "SECTdnsdb_mod"
7287 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7288 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7289 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7290 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7291 each followed by a comma,
7292 that may appear before the record type.
7294 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7295 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7296 a defer-option modifier.
7297 The possible keywords are
7298 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7299 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7300 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7301 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7302 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7303 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7304 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7306 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7307 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7309 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7310 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7312 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7313 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7314 The possible keywords are
7315 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7316 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7318 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7319 is not labelled as authenticated data
7320 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7321 The default is &"never"&.
7323 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7325 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7326 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7327 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7328 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7330 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7332 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7333 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7334 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7336 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7337 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7339 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7340 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7341 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7344 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
7345 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7346 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7347 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7348 the pseudo-type MXH:
7350 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7352 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7355 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7356 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7357 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7358 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7359 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7360 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7361 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7362 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7364 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7365 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7367 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7368 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7369 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7371 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7372 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7373 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7374 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7375 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7378 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7379 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7380 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7381 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7382 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7383 result of a successful lookup such as:
7385 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7387 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7388 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7389 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7391 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7392 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7393 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7394 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7396 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7400 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
7401 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7402 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7403 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7404 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7406 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7407 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7408 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7410 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7411 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7412 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7413 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7415 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7416 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7417 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7422 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7423 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7424 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7425 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7426 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7427 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7428 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7429 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7430 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7431 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7432 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7433 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7435 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7436 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7437 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7438 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7439 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7441 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7442 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7444 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7445 the way they handle the results of a query:
7448 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7451 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7452 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7454 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7455 from all of them are returned.
7459 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7460 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7461 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7462 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7465 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
7466 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7467 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7468 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7470 data = ${lookup ldap \
7471 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7472 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7474 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7475 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7476 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7477 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7479 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7480 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7481 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7483 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7484 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7485 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7486 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7487 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7488 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7489 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7490 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7494 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
7495 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7496 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7497 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7498 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7499 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7501 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7502 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7510 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7511 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7515 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7517 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7521 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7523 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7525 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7527 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7528 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7529 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7533 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7534 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7535 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7537 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7541 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7543 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7545 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7547 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7548 authentication below.
7551 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
7552 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7553 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7554 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7555 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7558 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7560 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7561 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7562 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7563 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7564 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7565 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7566 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7567 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7568 failures, and timeouts.
7570 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7571 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7572 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7573 doubled. For example
7575 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7577 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7578 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7579 the local host) is used.
7581 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7582 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7583 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7584 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7587 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7588 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7589 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7590 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7592 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7594 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7595 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7597 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7599 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7600 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7601 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7602 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7603 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7604 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7605 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7608 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7609 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7610 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7613 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7616 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7620 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7621 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7625 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
7626 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7627 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7628 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7629 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7630 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7631 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7632 them. The following names are recognized:
7634 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
7635 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
7636 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
7637 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
7638 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
7639 &`SERVERS `& set alternate server list for this query only
7640 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
7641 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
7643 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7644 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7645 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7646 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7648 .cindex LDAP timeout
7649 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7650 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7651 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7652 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7653 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7654 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7655 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7656 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7657 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7658 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7660 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7661 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7663 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7664 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7665 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7666 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7667 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7668 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7669 alternate list (colon-separated).
7671 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7672 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7675 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7676 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7679 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7680 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7681 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7682 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7684 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7685 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7686 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7688 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7689 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7690 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7691 quoting has two advantages:
7694 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7695 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7697 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7700 For example, a setting such as
7702 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7704 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7706 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7707 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7708 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7709 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7713 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7714 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7719 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7720 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7721 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7722 as a sequence of values, for example
7724 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7726 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7727 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7728 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7729 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7730 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7733 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7734 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7735 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7736 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7738 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7739 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7740 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7741 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7742 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7743 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7744 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7745 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7746 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7748 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7749 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7750 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7751 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7752 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7755 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7758 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7761 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7762 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
7764 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7765 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7767 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7768 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
7771 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7772 results of LDAP lookups.
7773 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7774 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
7775 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
7776 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
7777 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
7778 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
7783 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7784 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7785 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7786 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7787 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7788 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7789 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7790 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7792 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7794 might return the string
7796 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7797 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7799 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7801 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7807 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7808 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7809 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7813 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7814 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7815 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7816 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7817 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7818 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7819 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7820 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7821 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7822 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7823 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7824 .cindex lookup Redis
7825 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
7827 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7830 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7833 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7834 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7836 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7841 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7843 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7844 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7845 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7849 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7850 with a newline between the data for each row.
7853 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" "SECID72"
7854 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7855 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7856 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7857 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7858 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7859 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7860 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7861 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7862 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7863 .cindex lookup Redis
7864 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
7865 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
7866 or &%redis_servers%&
7867 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7869 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
7870 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7871 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
7873 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7874 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7875 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7876 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7878 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7880 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7881 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7882 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7884 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7885 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7887 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7888 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7889 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7890 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7891 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7892 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7894 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
7895 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
7896 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7898 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
7899 host, database number, and password.
7901 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
7902 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
7903 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
7905 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
7907 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
7910 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7911 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7912 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7913 itself are escaped with backslashes.
7915 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
7916 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
7918 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7919 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7920 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7921 done by starting the query with
7923 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7925 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7927 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7928 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7929 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7932 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7934 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7935 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7936 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7938 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7939 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7940 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7943 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7947 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7949 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
7951 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7952 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7953 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7955 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
7959 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7960 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7961 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7962 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
7963 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
7964 the default value is &"exim"&.
7965 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7967 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
7968 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7970 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7971 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7973 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7976 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7977 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7979 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7980 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7981 is zero because no rows are affected.
7984 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7985 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7986 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7987 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7988 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7991 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7993 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7994 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7995 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7997 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7998 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8001 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
8002 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8003 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8004 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8005 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8006 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
8007 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
8008 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
8009 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
8011 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8012 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8014 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8016 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
8017 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8019 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8020 quote, which it doubles.
8022 .cindex timeout SQLite
8023 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8024 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8025 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8026 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8027 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8028 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8029 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8032 .section "More about Redis" "SECTredis"
8033 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8034 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8035 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8038 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8039 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8042 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8043 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8044 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8045 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8048 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8049 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8050 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8057 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8058 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8060 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8061 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8062 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8063 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8064 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8065 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8066 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8067 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8068 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8070 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8071 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8072 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8073 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8075 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8076 support all the complexity available in
8077 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8081 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8082 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8083 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8085 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8086 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8089 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8090 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8091 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8092 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8093 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8096 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8097 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8098 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8100 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8101 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8102 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8103 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8104 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8106 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8107 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8109 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8110 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8111 senders based on the receiving domain.
8116 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
8117 .cindex "list" "negation"
8118 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8119 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8120 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8121 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8122 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8123 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8125 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8126 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8127 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8128 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8129 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8131 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8133 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8134 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8135 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8137 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8139 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8140 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8141 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8143 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8144 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8149 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
8150 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8151 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8152 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8153 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8154 filenames are not allowed,
8155 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8156 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8160 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8161 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8163 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8164 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8165 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8167 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8171 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8172 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8173 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8174 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8176 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8177 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8179 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8181 and the file contains the lines
8186 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8187 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8191 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
8192 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8193 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8194 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8195 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8196 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8197 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8198 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8200 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8201 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8202 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8203 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8208 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
8209 .cindex "named lists"
8210 .cindex "list" "named"
8211 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8212 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8213 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8214 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8215 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8216 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8217 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8219 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8221 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8222 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8223 configured with the line
8225 domains = +local_domains
8227 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8228 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8232 domains = ! +local_domains
8233 transport = remote_smtp
8236 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8237 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8238 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8239 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8241 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8242 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8244 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8246 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8247 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8248 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8250 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8251 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8252 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8254 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8255 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8257 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8258 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8259 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8261 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8263 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8264 referenced lists if you can.
8266 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8267 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8268 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8270 domains = +local_domains
8272 on several of your routers
8273 or in several ACL statements,
8274 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8275 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8276 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8277 the same each time they are referenced.
8279 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8280 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8281 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8282 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8286 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
8287 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8288 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8289 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8290 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8293 ALIST = host1 : host2
8294 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8296 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8298 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8300 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8303 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8304 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8306 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8308 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8312 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
8313 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8314 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8315 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8316 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8317 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8318 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8319 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8320 message. For example:
8322 domainlist special_domains = \
8323 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8325 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8326 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8327 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8328 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8329 same list each time.
8331 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8332 cache the result anyway. For example:
8334 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8336 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8337 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8341 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8342 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8343 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8344 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8345 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8348 .cindex "primary host name"
8349 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8350 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8351 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8352 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8353 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8354 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8355 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8356 differ only in their names.
8358 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8359 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8360 .cindex "domain literal"
8361 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8362 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8363 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8364 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8365 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8366 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
8369 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8370 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8371 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8372 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8373 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8374 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8375 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8376 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8377 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8378 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8379 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8381 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8382 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8383 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8384 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8385 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8387 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8388 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8389 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8390 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8391 on a router). For example:
8393 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8395 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8396 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8398 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8399 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8400 contain negative items.
8402 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8403 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8404 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8406 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8407 an.other.domain : ...
8409 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8410 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8412 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8413 an.other.domain ? ...
8416 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8417 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8418 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8419 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8420 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8421 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8422 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8423 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8424 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8428 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8429 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8430 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8431 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8432 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8433 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8434 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8435 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8436 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8438 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8439 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8440 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8441 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8442 expression by expansion, of course).
8444 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8445 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8446 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8447 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8448 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8449 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8451 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8453 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8454 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
8455 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8456 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8457 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
8458 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8459 other statements in the same ACL.
8462 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8463 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8465 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8467 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8468 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8471 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8472 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8473 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8474 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8475 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8476 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8479 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8480 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8481 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8482 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8484 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8485 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8487 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8488 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8489 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8490 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8491 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8493 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8494 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8495 between the pattern and the domain.
8498 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8500 domainlist funny_domains = \
8503 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8504 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8505 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8506 nis;domains.byname : \
8507 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8509 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8510 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8511 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8512 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8513 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8518 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8519 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8520 .cindex "list" "host list"
8521 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8522 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8523 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8524 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8525 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8526 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8527 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8530 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
8531 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8532 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8533 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8534 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8535 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8538 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8539 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8540 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8544 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
8545 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8546 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8547 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8548 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8549 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8550 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8553 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8554 inspecting its IP address:
8557 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8558 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8559 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8560 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8561 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8562 with the IP address of the subject host.
8564 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8565 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8566 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8567 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8568 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8571 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8572 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8573 domain name, as just described.
8576 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8577 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8578 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8579 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8580 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8581 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8582 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8583 that can never match a client host.
8586 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8587 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8588 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8589 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8591 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8595 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8596 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
8597 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8598 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
8599 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8600 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8601 significant end of the address.
8603 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8604 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8605 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8606 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8610 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8611 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8614 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8616 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8617 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
8619 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
8620 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
8623 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
8625 could make use of a file containing
8630 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
8631 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
8632 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
8634 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
8637 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
8643 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
8644 "SECThoslispatsikey"
8645 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
8646 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
8647 address, the pattern takes this form:
8649 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8653 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
8655 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
8656 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
8657 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
8658 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
8659 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
8660 returned by the lookup is not used.
8662 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
8663 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
8664 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
8665 patterns of this form:
8667 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
8671 net24-dbm;/networks.db
8673 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
8674 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
8675 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
8676 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
8677 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
8679 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
8680 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
8681 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
8682 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
8683 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
8684 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
8685 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
8686 converted using colons and not dots.
8688 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
8689 addresses are always used.
8690 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
8693 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
8694 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
8695 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
8698 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
8699 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
8700 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
8701 case the IP address is used on its own.
8705 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
8706 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
8707 .cindex "unknown host name"
8708 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8709 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
8710 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
8711 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
8712 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
8715 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
8716 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
8717 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
8718 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
8719 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
8720 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
8721 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
8723 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
8724 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
8726 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
8727 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
8728 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
8729 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
8730 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
8731 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
8732 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
8733 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
8734 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
8736 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
8737 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8739 .cindex "host" "alias for"
8740 .cindex "alias for host"
8741 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
8742 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
8745 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8746 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
8747 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
8748 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
8749 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
8752 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
8753 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
8754 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
8755 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
8756 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
8757 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8758 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8763 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8764 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8765 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8766 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8767 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8769 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8771 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8772 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8773 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8780 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8781 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8782 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8783 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8784 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8785 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8787 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8788 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8790 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8791 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8792 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
8793 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
8794 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
8795 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
8796 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
8797 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
8798 not recognized in an indirected file).
8801 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8802 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8804 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8806 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8807 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8810 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8811 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8814 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8817 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8818 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8819 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8822 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8823 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8826 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8828 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8830 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
8831 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
8832 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
8835 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
8836 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
8837 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
8839 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8841 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
8842 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
8843 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
8844 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
8845 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8846 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
8847 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8850 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8851 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8853 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8854 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8856 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8857 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
8858 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
8863 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8865 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8866 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8867 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8868 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8869 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8870 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
8871 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8872 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8873 host lists such as whitelists.
8877 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8878 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8879 .cindex "unknown host name"
8880 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8881 If a pattern is of the form
8883 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8887 dbm;/host/accept/list
8889 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8890 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8893 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8894 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8895 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8896 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8897 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8898 lookup, both using the same file.
8902 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8903 If a pattern is of the form
8905 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8907 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8908 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8909 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8911 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8912 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8914 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8915 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8916 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8919 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8920 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
8921 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8923 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8924 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8925 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8926 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8927 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8928 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8934 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8935 .cindex "list" "address list"
8936 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8937 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8938 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8939 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8940 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8941 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8942 using this option setting:
8946 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8947 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8948 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8949 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8951 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8954 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8956 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8957 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8958 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8959 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8960 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8961 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8962 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8964 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8965 *@+hostile_domains:\
8966 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8967 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8969 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8970 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8971 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8972 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8973 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8975 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8976 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8977 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8978 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8979 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8981 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8984 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8985 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8989 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8990 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8991 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8992 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8993 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8994 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8995 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8997 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8998 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9000 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9001 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9004 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9005 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9006 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9009 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9010 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9011 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9013 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9014 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9015 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9016 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9018 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9019 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9021 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9022 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9023 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9024 default. For example, with this lookup:
9026 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9028 the file could contains lines like this:
9030 user1@domain1.example
9033 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9036 nimrod@jaeger.example
9040 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9041 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9043 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9045 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9046 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9048 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9049 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9050 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9054 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9055 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9060 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9061 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9062 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9063 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9064 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9065 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9066 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9067 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9068 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9070 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9071 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9072 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9073 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9074 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9077 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9079 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9081 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9083 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9085 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9086 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9087 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9088 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9089 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9090 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9092 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9095 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9098 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9099 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9100 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9101 might have entries like
9103 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9104 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9107 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9108 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9109 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9110 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9112 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9113 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9114 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9117 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9118 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9119 can only return a single list of local parts.
9122 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9123 in these two examples:
9126 senders = *@+my_list
9128 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9129 example it is a named domain list.
9134 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
9135 .cindex "case of local parts"
9136 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9137 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9138 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9139 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9140 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9141 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9142 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9143 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9146 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9147 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9148 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9149 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9150 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9151 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9152 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9155 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9156 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9157 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9158 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9159 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9160 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9161 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9162 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9166 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9167 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9168 .cindex "local part" "list"
9169 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9170 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9171 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9172 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9173 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9174 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9175 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9176 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9178 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9179 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9180 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9181 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9182 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9183 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9184 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9186 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9191 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9192 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9194 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9195 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9196 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9197 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9199 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9200 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9201 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9202 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9203 escape character, as described in the following section.
9205 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9206 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9207 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9208 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9209 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9214 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9215 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9216 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9217 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9218 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9219 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9220 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9221 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9223 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9224 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9225 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9226 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9228 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9230 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9231 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9236 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9237 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9238 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9239 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9240 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9241 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9242 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9245 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9246 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9247 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9250 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9251 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9252 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9254 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9255 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9256 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9257 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9258 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9259 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9260 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9263 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9264 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9265 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9268 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9269 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9270 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9271 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9273 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9275 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9276 Exim message identifier. For example:
9278 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9280 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9281 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9284 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9285 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9286 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9287 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9288 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9289 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9290 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9291 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9292 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9293 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9294 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9295 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9301 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9302 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9303 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9304 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9305 white space is significant.
9308 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9309 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9310 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9315 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9316 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9317 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9318 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9319 given, the expansion fails.
9321 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9322 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9323 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9324 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9328 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9329 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9330 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9331 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9332 string easier to understand.
9334 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9335 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9336 expansion item below.
9339 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9340 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9341 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9342 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9343 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9344 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9345 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9346 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9347 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9348 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9349 the result of the expansion.
9350 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9351 the expansion result is an empty string.
9352 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9355 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9356 .cindex authentication "results header"
9357 .cindex headers "authentication-results:"
9358 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9359 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9360 &'Authentication-Results"'&
9362 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9363 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9364 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9373 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9375 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9377 This is safe even if no authentication results are available.
9380 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9381 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9382 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9383 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9384 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9385 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9386 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9387 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9391 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9392 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9397 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9401 If the field is found,
9402 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9403 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9404 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9405 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9407 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9408 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9411 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9413 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9414 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9416 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9417 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9418 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9419 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9420 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9421 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9422 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9423 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9425 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9426 take an optional modifier of "int"
9427 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9428 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9429 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9431 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9432 newline-separated by default,
9433 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9434 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9435 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9437 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9438 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9439 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9440 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9441 if so the element tags are omitted.
9443 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9445 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9446 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9448 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9449 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9453 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9454 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9455 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9457 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
9458 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
9459 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9460 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9461 must have the following type:
9463 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9465 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9466 function should return one of the following values:
9468 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9469 into the expanded string that is being built.
9471 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9472 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9474 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9475 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9477 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9479 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9480 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9481 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9484 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9485 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9486 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9487 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9489 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9490 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9491 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9493 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9494 appear, for example:
9496 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9498 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9499 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9501 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9503 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9506 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9507 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9510 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9511 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9512 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9513 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9514 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9515 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9516 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9517 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9519 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9522 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9523 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9524 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9525 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9526 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9527 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9528 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9529 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9530 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9532 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9533 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9534 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9537 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9538 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9540 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9541 appear, for example:
9543 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9545 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9546 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9548 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9549 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9550 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9551 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9552 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9553 .cindex JSON expansions
9554 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9555 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9556 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9557 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9559 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9562 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9563 the spaces are optional.
9564 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9565 For the &"json"& variant,
9566 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9569 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9570 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9572 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9574 The results of matching are handled as above.
9577 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9578 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9579 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9580 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9581 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9582 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9583 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9584 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9585 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
9586 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
9587 <&'string3'&> as before.
9589 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
9590 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
9591 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
9592 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
9593 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
9594 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
9595 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
9596 provided. For example:
9598 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9602 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
9604 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
9605 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
9608 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9609 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9610 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
9611 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9612 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
9613 .cindex JSON expansions
9614 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9615 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9617 Field selection and result handling is as above;
9618 there is no choice of field separator.
9619 For the &"json"& variant,
9620 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9623 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9624 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9628 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
9629 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
9630 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
9632 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9633 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9635 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
9636 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
9637 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
9638 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
9639 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
9641 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
9643 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
9644 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9647 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9648 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9649 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9650 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
9651 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
9652 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
9654 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
9655 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
9656 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
9657 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9659 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9661 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
9662 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
9663 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
9664 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
9665 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
9667 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
9669 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
9670 letters appear. For example:
9672 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
9673 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
9674 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
9677 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9678 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9679 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9680 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
9681 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9682 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9683 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
9684 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9685 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
9686 .vindex "&$header_$&"
9687 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
9688 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
9689 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
9690 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
9691 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
9692 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
9693 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
9697 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
9698 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
9699 lines) may be present.
9701 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
9702 the data in the header line is interpreted.
9705 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
9706 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
9707 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
9710 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
9711 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
9712 are multiple headers with a given name.
9713 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
9714 list-processing facilities can be used.
9715 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
9716 the content is &"raw"&.
9719 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
9720 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
9721 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
9722 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
9723 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
9724 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
9725 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
9726 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
9729 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
9730 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
9731 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
9732 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
9733 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
9734 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
9737 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
9738 command of the following form:
9740 headers charset "UTF-8"
9742 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
9743 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
9744 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
9745 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
9746 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
9749 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
9750 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
9751 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
9752 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
9754 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
9755 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
9756 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
9757 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
9758 router or transport are not accessible.
9760 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
9761 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
9762 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
9763 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
9764 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
9765 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
9766 point they are added.
9767 When any of the above ACLs ar
9768 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
9770 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
9771 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
9772 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
9773 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
9774 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
9775 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
9776 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
9779 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
9780 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
9781 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
9782 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
9783 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
9784 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
9785 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
9786 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
9789 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
9790 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
9792 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
9793 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
9794 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
9795 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
9796 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
9797 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
9798 present. For example:
9800 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
9802 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
9805 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
9807 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
9808 an Exim configuration:
9810 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
9812 In a router or a transport you could then have:
9815 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
9816 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
9817 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
9819 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
9820 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
9821 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
9822 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
9823 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
9824 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
9827 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9828 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
9829 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
9830 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
9831 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
9832 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
9834 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
9836 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
9837 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
9838 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
9839 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
9840 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
9842 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
9843 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
9844 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
9846 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
9850 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
9855 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
9856 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
9857 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
9858 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
9859 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
9860 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
9864 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9865 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9866 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9867 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
9868 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
9869 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
9870 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
9873 ${length_<n>:<string>}
9875 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
9876 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
9877 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
9878 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
9881 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
9882 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9883 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
9884 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
9885 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
9886 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9887 apart from an optional leading minus,
9888 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
9890 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9891 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9893 The first field of the list is numbered one.
9894 If the number is negative, the fields are
9895 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
9896 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
9897 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
9899 If the modulus of the
9900 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
9901 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
9905 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
9909 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
9911 yields &"result: 42"&.
9913 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
9914 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9916 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
9919 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
9920 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9921 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
9922 described in the next item.
9924 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
9925 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9926 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
9927 .cindex "file" "lookups"
9928 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
9929 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
9930 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
9931 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
9932 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
9934 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
9935 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
9936 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
9937 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
9938 out by the system administrator.
9941 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
9942 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
9943 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
9944 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
9945 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
9946 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
9947 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
9948 original lookup fails.
9950 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
9951 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
9952 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
9953 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
9954 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
9955 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
9956 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
9957 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
9959 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
9960 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
9961 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
9962 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
9964 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
9965 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
9966 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
9967 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
9969 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
9971 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
9973 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
9974 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
9976 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
9981 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
9982 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
9984 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
9985 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
9987 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
9988 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
9989 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
9990 setting is not included in the output. For example:
9992 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
9994 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
9995 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
9996 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
9998 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9999 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10000 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10001 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10002 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10003 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10004 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10006 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10008 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10009 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10010 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10011 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10014 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10016 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10020 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10021 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10022 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10023 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10024 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10025 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10026 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10027 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10029 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10030 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
10031 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
10032 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
10033 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10036 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10037 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10038 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10040 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10041 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10044 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10045 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10046 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10047 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10048 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10049 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10050 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10051 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10053 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10054 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10055 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10056 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10057 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10058 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10059 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10060 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10061 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10062 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10064 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10065 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10066 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10067 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10069 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10070 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10071 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10072 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10073 is the expansion of the third argument.
10075 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10076 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10077 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10079 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10080 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10081 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10082 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10083 The filename and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
10084 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10085 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10086 newlines are left in the string.
10087 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10088 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10089 the string expansion fails.
10091 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10092 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10096 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10097 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10098 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10099 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10100 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10101 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10102 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10105 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10106 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10108 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10109 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10110 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10111 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10112 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10115 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10117 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10118 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10119 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10120 unless it is an empty string; and no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10121 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10122 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10123 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10125 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10128 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10129 and must be present if the argument is given.
10130 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10131 Two option types is currently recognised: shutdown and tls.
10132 The first defines whether (the default)
10133 or not a shutdown is done on the connection after sending the request.
10134 Example, to not do so (preferred, eg. by some webservers):
10136 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10138 The second, tls, controls the use of TLS on the connection. Example:
10140 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:tls=yes}}
10142 The default is to not use TLS.
10143 If it is enabled, a shutdown as descripbed above is never done.
10145 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10146 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10147 turns them into spaces:
10149 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10151 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10152 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10153 addition, the following errors can occur:
10156 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10158 Failure to connect the socket;
10160 Failure to write the request string;
10162 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10165 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10166 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10167 errors occurs. For example:
10169 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10172 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10173 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10174 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10175 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10176 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10178 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10179 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10182 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10183 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10184 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10185 .vindex "&$value$&"
10187 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10188 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10189 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10190 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10191 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10192 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10193 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10194 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10195 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
10196 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10198 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10200 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10203 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10205 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10206 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
10209 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10210 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10211 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10213 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10214 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10215 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10216 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10217 The command and its arguments are first expanded as one string. The string is
10218 split apart into individual arguments by spaces, and then the command is run
10219 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10220 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10221 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10223 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10224 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10225 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10226 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10227 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10228 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10229 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10230 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10231 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10234 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10235 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10236 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10237 .vindex "&$value$&"
10238 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10239 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10240 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10241 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10242 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10245 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10246 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10247 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10248 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10250 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10251 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10252 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10255 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10256 log_message = Output of id: $value
10258 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10259 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10261 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10264 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10265 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10266 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10268 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10269 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10273 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10274 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10277 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10278 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10279 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10280 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10282 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10283 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10286 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10287 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10288 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10289 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10290 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10291 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10292 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10293 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10295 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10297 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10298 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10299 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10301 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10303 yields &"defabc"&, and
10305 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10307 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10308 the regular expression from string expansion.
10310 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10311 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10314 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10315 .cindex sorting "a list"
10316 .cindex list sorting
10317 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10318 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10319 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10320 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10321 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10322 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10323 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10324 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10325 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10326 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10327 to give values for comparison.
10329 The item result is a sorted list,
10330 with the original list separator,
10331 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10335 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10337 sorts a list of numbers, and
10339 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10341 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10344 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10345 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10346 .cindex "substring extraction"
10347 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10348 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10349 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10350 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10351 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10353 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10355 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10356 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10359 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10360 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10361 length required. For example
10363 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10365 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10366 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10367 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10368 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10370 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10371 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10372 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10374 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10376 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10377 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10378 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10380 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10382 yields an empty string, but
10384 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10388 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10389 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10390 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10391 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10394 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10396 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10398 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10402 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10403 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10404 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10405 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10406 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10407 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10408 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10409 replacement list. For example
10411 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10413 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10414 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10415 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10418 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10424 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10425 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10426 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10427 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10428 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10429 following operations can be performed:
10432 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10433 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10434 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10435 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10436 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10437 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10439 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10442 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10443 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10444 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10445 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10446 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10447 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10448 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10449 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10450 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10452 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10453 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10454 character. For example:
10456 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10458 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10459 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10460 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10461 separator explicitly:
10463 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10466 Compare the &*address*& (singular)
10467 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10468 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
10471 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10472 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10473 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10474 email address separator. For the example header line:
10476 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10478 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10479 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10480 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10481 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10482 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10483 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10484 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10486 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10487 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10489 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10490 Last:user@example.com
10491 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10493 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10497 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10498 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10499 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10500 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10501 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10502 Only lowercase letters are used.
10504 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10505 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10506 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10507 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10508 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10510 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10511 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10512 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10513 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10514 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10515 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10516 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10517 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10518 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
10520 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
10521 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
10522 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10523 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
10524 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
10525 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
10528 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10529 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
10530 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
10531 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
10532 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
10533 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
10535 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10536 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
10539 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10540 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
10541 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
10542 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
10543 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
10546 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10547 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
10548 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
10549 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
10550 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10553 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10554 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
10555 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
10556 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
10557 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
10558 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
10559 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
10561 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10562 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
10563 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
10564 If the string contains and characters with the most significant bit set,
10565 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
10566 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
10569 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10570 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
10571 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
10572 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
10573 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
10574 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
10575 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
10576 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
10577 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
10578 C programming language):
10580 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
10581 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
10582 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
10583 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
10584 .irow "" "and (&&)"
10586 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
10588 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
10589 space is permitted before or after operators.
10591 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
10592 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
10593 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
10594 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
10595 times, which often do have leading zeros.
10597 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
10599 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
10600 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
10603 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
10604 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
10605 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
10606 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
10607 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
10608 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
10609 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
10610 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
10611 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
10612 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
10613 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
10616 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
10618 deny message = Too many bad recipients
10621 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
10624 {$recipients_count} \
10625 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
10629 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
10630 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
10633 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10634 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
10635 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
10638 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
10640 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
10641 and then re-expands what it has found.
10644 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10646 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
10647 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
10648 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
10649 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
10650 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
10651 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
10652 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
10653 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
10654 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
10656 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
10657 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
10658 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
10659 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
10660 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
10661 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
10662 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
10665 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10666 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10667 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10668 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
10669 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
10670 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10672 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10674 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
10675 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
10679 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
10680 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
10681 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
10682 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
10683 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
10684 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
10688 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10689 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
10690 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
10691 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
10692 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
10693 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
10694 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
10697 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10698 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
10699 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10700 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
10701 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
10702 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10703 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10705 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10706 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
10707 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
10708 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
10709 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
10710 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
10711 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
10712 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
10713 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
10716 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10717 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
10718 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
10719 .cindex "lower casing"
10720 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
10721 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
10722 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
10726 Case is defined per the system C locale.
10728 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10729 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10730 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10731 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
10732 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
10733 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
10735 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
10737 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
10738 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
10739 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
10740 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10743 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10744 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
10745 .cindex "list" "item count"
10746 .cindex "list" "count of items"
10747 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
10748 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
10751 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
10752 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
10753 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
10754 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
10755 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
10756 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
10757 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
10758 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
10759 matching list is returned.
10762 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10763 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
10764 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
10765 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
10766 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
10768 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10771 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
10772 .cindex "masked IP address"
10773 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
10774 .cindex "CIDR notation"
10775 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
10776 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
10777 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
10778 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
10779 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
10780 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
10781 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
10783 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
10785 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
10786 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
10787 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
10788 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
10790 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
10794 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
10796 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
10799 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10801 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
10802 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10803 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
10804 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
10805 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
10807 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10808 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10811 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10812 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10813 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10814 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
10815 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
10816 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
10818 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
10820 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
10823 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10824 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
10825 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
10826 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
10827 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
10828 is an empty string or
10829 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
10830 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
10831 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
10832 respectively For example,
10840 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
10841 variable or a message header.
10843 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10844 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
10845 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
10846 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
10847 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
10848 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
10849 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
10851 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
10852 will likely use the quoting form.
10853 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
10856 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10857 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
10858 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
10859 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
10860 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
10862 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
10868 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
10869 yields an unchanged string.
10872 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
10873 .cindex "random number"
10874 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
10875 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
10876 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
10877 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
10878 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
10879 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
10880 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
10881 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
10885 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
10886 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
10887 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
10888 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
10889 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
10890 for DNS. For example,
10892 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
10893 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
10898 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
10902 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10903 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10904 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
10905 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
10906 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
10907 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
10908 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
10909 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
10910 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
10913 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
10915 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
10916 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
10920 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10921 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
10922 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
10923 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
10924 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
10925 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
10926 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
10927 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
10929 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
10930 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
10931 to use this operator as well.
10935 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10936 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
10937 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
10938 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
10939 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
10940 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
10941 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
10944 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10945 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
10946 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
10947 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10948 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
10949 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
10950 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10952 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10953 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10956 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10957 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
10958 .cindex certificate fingerprint
10959 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
10960 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
10961 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
10963 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10965 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
10966 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
10969 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
10970 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10971 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
10972 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
10973 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
10974 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
10976 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
10978 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
10979 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
10980 with 256 being the default.
10982 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
10983 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
10984 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
10985 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
10988 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10989 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
10990 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
10991 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
10992 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
10993 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
10994 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
10995 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
10996 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
10997 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
10998 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
10999 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11000 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11002 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11003 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11004 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11006 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11007 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11008 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11012 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11013 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11014 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11015 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11016 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11017 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11018 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11021 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11022 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11023 .cindex "substring extraction"
11024 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11025 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11026 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11027 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11029 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11031 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11032 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11033 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11035 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11036 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11037 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11038 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11041 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11042 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11043 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11044 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11045 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11046 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11049 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11050 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11051 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11052 .cindex "upper casing"
11053 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11054 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11055 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11056 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11058 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11059 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11060 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11061 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11062 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11063 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11064 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11065 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11066 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11067 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11068 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11069 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11070 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11071 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11073 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11075 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11076 literal question mark).
11078 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11079 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11080 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11081 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11082 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11083 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11085 .cindex internationalisation
11086 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11087 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11088 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11089 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11090 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11091 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11099 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11100 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11101 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11102 while expanding strings:
11105 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11106 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11107 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11108 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11111 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11112 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11113 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11114 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11120 &`>= `& greater or equal
11122 &`<= `& less or equal
11126 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11128 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11129 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11130 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11131 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11132 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11135 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11136 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11137 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11140 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11141 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11142 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11143 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11144 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11145 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11146 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11147 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11148 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11149 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11150 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11151 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11152 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11153 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11155 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11156 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11157 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11158 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11159 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11160 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11162 An empty string is treated as false.
11163 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11164 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11165 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11167 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11168 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11171 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11175 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11176 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11177 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11178 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11179 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11180 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11181 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11182 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11184 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11186 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11187 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11188 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11189 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11190 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11191 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11192 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11193 included in the binary.
11195 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11196 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11197 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11198 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11199 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11200 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11201 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11202 string in LDAP form is:
11204 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11206 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11207 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11209 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11211 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11216 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11217 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11218 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11219 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11220 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11221 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11225 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11226 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11227 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11228 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11229 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11230 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11233 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11234 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11235 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11236 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11237 whatever its length.
11240 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11241 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11242 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11243 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11245 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11246 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11247 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11248 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11249 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11250 support &[crypt16()]&.
11252 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11253 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11254 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11255 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11256 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11258 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11259 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11260 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11262 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11263 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11264 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11265 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11266 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11268 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11269 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11270 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11271 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11272 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11273 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11275 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11277 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11278 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11280 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11281 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11282 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11283 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11284 exists in the message. For example,
11286 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11288 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11289 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11291 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11292 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11293 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11294 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11295 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11296 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11297 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11298 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11299 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11300 case is defined per the system C locale.
11302 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11303 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11304 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11305 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11306 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11307 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11308 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11309 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11311 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11312 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11313 .cindex "first delivery"
11314 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11315 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11316 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11317 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11320 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11321 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11322 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11323 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11324 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11326 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11327 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11328 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11329 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11330 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11331 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11333 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11334 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11335 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11337 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11338 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11339 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11341 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11342 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11343 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
11344 list separator is changed to a comma:
11346 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11348 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
11349 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11351 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11354 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11355 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11356 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11357 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11358 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11359 .cindex JSON expansions
11360 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11361 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11362 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11363 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11364 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11366 The array separator is not changeable.
11367 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11368 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11373 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11374 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11375 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11376 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11377 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11378 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11379 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11380 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11381 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11383 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11385 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11386 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11387 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11388 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11389 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11390 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11391 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11392 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11393 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11395 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11397 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11398 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11399 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11400 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11401 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11402 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11404 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11406 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11407 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11409 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11410 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11411 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11412 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11415 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11416 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11417 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11418 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11419 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11420 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11421 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11422 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11423 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11424 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11425 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11427 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11428 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11429 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11430 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11431 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11433 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11434 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11436 This is no longer the case.
11438 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11439 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11441 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11443 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11445 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11446 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11447 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11448 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11449 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11450 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11451 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
11452 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
11453 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
11454 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
11455 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
11456 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
11457 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
11461 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11462 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11463 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11464 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11465 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
11466 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
11467 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11468 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
11469 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
11471 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11473 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11474 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11475 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11476 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11477 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
11478 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
11479 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11480 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
11481 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
11483 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11486 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11487 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
11488 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
11489 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
11490 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
11491 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
11492 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
11493 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
11494 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
11495 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
11496 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
11499 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
11501 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
11502 backslashes is also required.
11504 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
11505 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
11506 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
11507 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
11508 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
11509 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
11510 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
11511 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
11513 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
11514 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
11515 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
11516 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
11517 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
11518 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
11519 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
11520 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
11522 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11523 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
11524 See &*match_local_part*&.
11526 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11527 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
11528 See &*match_local_part*&.
11530 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11531 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
11532 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
11533 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
11534 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
11535 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
11537 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
11539 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
11542 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
11544 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
11546 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
11547 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
11548 in a single test such as
11549 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11550 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
11551 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
11552 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
11554 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
11556 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
11558 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
11560 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
11561 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
11562 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
11563 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
11564 masks. For example:
11566 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
11568 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
11569 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
11570 address mask, for example:
11572 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
11574 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
11575 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
11577 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
11581 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11582 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11584 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
11586 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11587 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
11588 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
11589 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
11590 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
11591 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
11592 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
11593 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
11596 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
11598 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
11599 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
11600 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
11601 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
11603 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
11605 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
11606 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
11607 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
11608 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
11611 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
11612 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
11614 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
11615 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
11616 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
11617 matched using &%match_ip%&.
11619 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
11620 .cindex "PAM authentication"
11621 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
11622 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
11623 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
11624 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
11625 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
11626 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
11627 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
11628 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
11629 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
11633 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
11634 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
11636 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
11637 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
11638 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
11639 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
11640 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
11641 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
11642 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
11644 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
11645 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
11646 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
11647 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
11648 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
11650 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
11652 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
11654 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
11656 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
11657 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
11658 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
11659 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
11662 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11663 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
11665 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
11666 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
11667 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
11668 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
11669 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
11670 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
11672 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11673 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11674 building Exim. For example:
11676 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
11678 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11679 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11680 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
11681 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
11683 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
11684 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
11685 configuration, you might have this:
11687 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
11689 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
11691 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
11693 .vitem &*queue_running*&
11694 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
11695 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
11696 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
11697 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
11698 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
11701 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
11703 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
11704 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
11705 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
11706 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
11707 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
11710 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
11711 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
11712 this library, you need to set
11714 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
11716 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
11717 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
11719 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
11721 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
11722 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
11723 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
11725 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
11726 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
11727 the authentication is successful. For example:
11729 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
11733 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
11734 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
11735 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
11737 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
11738 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
11739 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
11740 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
11741 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
11742 by a process that is not running as root.
11744 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
11745 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
11746 building Exim. For example:
11748 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
11750 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
11751 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
11752 from the Cyrus SASL library.
11754 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
11755 two are mandatory. For example:
11757 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
11759 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
11760 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
11761 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
11766 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
11767 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
11768 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
11769 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
11770 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
11771 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
11772 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
11776 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11777 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
11778 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
11779 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11780 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
11783 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
11785 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
11786 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
11787 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
11789 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
11790 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
11791 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
11792 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
11793 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
11794 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
11795 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
11796 parsed but not evaluated.
11798 .ecindex IIDexpcond
11803 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
11804 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
11805 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
11806 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
11807 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
11810 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
11811 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
11812 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
11813 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
11814 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
11815 In the expansion condition case
11816 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
11817 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
11818 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
11819 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
11820 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
11821 matching condition.
11823 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
11824 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11825 any arguments are copied to these variables,
11826 any unused variables being made empty.
11828 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
11829 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
11830 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
11831 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
11832 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
11833 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
11834 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
11835 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
11836 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
11837 during subsequent delivery.
11839 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
11840 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
11841 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
11842 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
11843 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
11844 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
11845 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
11846 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
11849 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
11850 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
11851 this variable has the number of arguments.
11853 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
11854 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
11855 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
11856 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
11857 be preserved by coding like this:
11859 warn !verify = sender
11860 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
11862 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
11863 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
11866 .vitem &$address_data$&
11867 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11868 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
11869 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
11870 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
11871 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
11872 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
11875 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
11876 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
11877 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
11878 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
11879 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
11880 from the child's routing.
11882 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11883 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
11884 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
11887 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
11888 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
11889 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
11891 .vitem &$address_file$&
11892 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
11893 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
11894 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
11895 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
11896 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
11898 /home/r2d2/savemail
11900 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
11901 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
11902 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
11903 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
11904 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
11905 to the relevant file.
11907 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
11908 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
11909 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
11910 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
11912 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
11913 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
11914 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
11915 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
11917 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
11918 .cindex "authentication" "id"
11919 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
11920 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
11921 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
11922 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
11923 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
11924 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
11925 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
11927 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
11928 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
11929 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
11930 command line option.
11931 This second case also sets up information used by the
11932 &$authresults$& expansion item.
11934 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11935 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
11936 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
11937 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
11938 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
11939 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
11940 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
11941 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
11942 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
11946 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
11947 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
11948 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
11949 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
11950 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
11951 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
11952 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
11953 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
11954 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
11955 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
11956 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
11958 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11959 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
11960 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
11961 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
11962 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
11965 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
11966 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
11967 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
11968 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
11969 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
11970 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
11971 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
11972 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
11973 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
11974 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
11975 an undefined mechanism.
11977 .vitem &$av_failed$&
11978 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
11979 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
11980 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
11981 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
11982 the ACL malware condition.
11984 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
11985 .cindex "message body" "line count"
11986 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
11987 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
11988 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11989 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
11991 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
11992 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
11993 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
11994 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
11995 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
11996 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
11997 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
11999 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12000 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12001 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12002 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12003 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12005 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12006 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12007 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12008 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12009 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12011 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12012 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12013 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12014 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12015 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12016 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12017 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12019 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12020 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12021 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12022 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12023 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12024 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12025 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12027 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12028 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12029 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12030 address that was connected to.
12032 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12033 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12034 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12035 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12036 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12038 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12039 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12040 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12041 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12042 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12043 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12045 .vitem &$config_file$&
12046 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12047 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12049 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12050 Results of DKIM verification.
12051 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12053 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12054 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12055 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12056 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12057 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12059 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12060 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12061 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12062 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12063 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12064 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12065 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12066 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12067 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12068 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12069 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12070 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12071 &$dkim_key_length$&
12072 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12073 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12075 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12076 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12077 When a message has been received this variable contains
12078 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12079 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12081 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12082 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12083 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12085 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12086 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12087 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12088 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12089 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12090 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12091 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12092 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12093 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12096 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12097 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12098 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12099 case for &$domain$&.
12101 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12102 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12103 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12104 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12106 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12107 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12108 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12109 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12110 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12111 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12113 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12114 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12115 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12117 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12120 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12121 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12122 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12123 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12124 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12125 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12126 the &(smtp)& transport.
12129 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12130 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12131 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12132 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12135 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12136 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12137 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12138 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12139 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12140 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12143 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12144 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12145 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12146 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12150 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12151 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12152 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
12153 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
12154 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
12155 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12156 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12159 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
12160 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
12161 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
12164 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12165 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12166 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12168 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12169 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12170 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12172 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12173 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12174 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12176 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12177 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12178 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12179 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12180 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12181 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12183 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12184 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12185 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12186 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12187 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12188 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12190 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12191 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12192 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12193 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12194 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12198 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12199 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12200 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12201 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12202 by a setting on the transport itself.
12204 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12205 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12206 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12210 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12211 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12212 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12213 to local and remote transports.
12215 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12216 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12217 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12218 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12219 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12220 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12221 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12224 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12225 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12226 client is connected.
12229 .vitem &$host_address$&
12230 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12231 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12232 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12233 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12235 .vitem &$host_data$&
12236 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12237 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12238 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12239 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12241 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12242 message = $host_data
12244 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12245 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12246 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12247 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12248 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12249 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12250 variables is set to &"1"&.
12253 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12254 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12257 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12258 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12259 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12262 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12263 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12264 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12265 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12266 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12267 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12268 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12269 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12270 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12271 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12273 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12274 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12275 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12278 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12279 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12280 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12282 .vitem &$host_port$&
12283 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12284 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12285 for an outbound connection.
12287 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12288 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12289 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12290 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12291 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12292 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12295 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12296 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12297 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12298 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12299 a unique name for the file.
12301 .vitem &$interface_address$&
12302 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12303 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
12305 .vitem &$interface_port$&
12306 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12307 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
12311 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12312 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12313 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12317 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12318 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12319 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12322 .vitem &$load_average$&
12323 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12324 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12325 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12326 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12328 .vitem &$local_part$&
12329 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12330 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12331 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12332 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12333 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12335 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12336 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12337 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12338 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12341 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12342 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12343 .cindex affix variables
12344 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
12345 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
12346 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
12347 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
12349 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12350 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12351 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12354 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12355 local part of the recipient address.
12357 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12358 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12359 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12361 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12364 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12365 abc\:xyz@test.example
12367 the value of &$local_part$& is
12371 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12372 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12375 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12377 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12378 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12379 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12381 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12382 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12383 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
12384 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
12385 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
12386 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
12387 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
12389 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
12390 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
12391 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
12392 variable expands to nothing.
12394 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
12395 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
12396 .cindex affix variables
12397 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12398 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12399 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12401 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
12402 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
12403 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
12404 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
12405 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
12407 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
12408 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
12409 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
12410 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
12412 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
12413 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
12414 See &$local_user_uid$&.
12416 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
12417 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
12418 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
12419 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
12420 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
12421 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
12422 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
12423 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
12425 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
12426 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
12427 This contains the expanded value of the
12428 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
12431 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
12432 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12433 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
12434 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
12435 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
12436 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
12438 .vitem &$log_space$&
12439 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12440 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
12441 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
12442 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
12443 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
12444 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
12447 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
12448 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
12449 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
12450 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
12451 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
12452 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
12453 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
12454 and &"yes"& if it was.
12455 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
12456 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
12457 as authenticated data.
12459 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
12460 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
12461 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
12462 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
12463 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
12464 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
12465 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
12468 .vitem &$malware_name$&
12469 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
12470 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
12471 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
12472 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
12474 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
12475 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
12476 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
12477 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
12478 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
12479 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
12481 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12483 .vitem &$message_age$&
12484 .cindex "message" "age of"
12485 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
12486 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
12487 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
12490 .vitem &$message_body$&
12491 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12492 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12493 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12494 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
12495 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
12496 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
12497 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
12498 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
12499 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
12501 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
12502 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
12503 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
12504 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
12505 zeros are always converted into spaces.
12507 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
12508 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
12509 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
12510 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
12511 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
12512 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
12515 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
12516 .cindex "body of message" "size"
12517 .cindex "message body" "size"
12518 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
12519 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
12520 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
12521 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
12522 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12524 If the spool file is wireformat
12525 (see the &%spool_files_wireformat%& main option)
12526 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
12528 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
12529 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
12530 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12531 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
12532 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
12533 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
12534 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
12535 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
12537 .vitem &$message_headers$&
12538 .vindex &$message_headers$&
12539 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
12540 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
12541 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
12542 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
12544 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
12545 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
12546 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
12547 contents of header lines is done.
12549 .vitem &$message_id$&
12550 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
12552 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
12553 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
12554 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
12555 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
12556 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
12557 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
12558 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
12559 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
12560 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
12561 from the body is not counted.
12563 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
12564 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
12565 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
12566 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
12567 header and the body).
12569 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
12571 deny message = Too many lines in message header
12573 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
12575 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
12576 message has not yet been received.
12578 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
12580 .vitem &$message_size$&
12581 .cindex "size" "of message"
12582 .cindex "message" "size"
12583 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
12584 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
12585 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
12586 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
12587 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
12588 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
12589 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
12590 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
12591 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
12593 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
12594 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
12595 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
12596 value may not, of course, be truthful.
12598 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
12599 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
12600 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
12601 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
12603 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
12604 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
12605 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
12607 .vitem &$original_domain$&
12608 .vindex "&$domain$&"
12609 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
12610 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12611 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
12612 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
12613 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
12614 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
12615 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
12616 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
12618 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12619 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12620 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12622 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
12623 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
12624 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
12625 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
12626 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
12627 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
12628 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
12629 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
12630 the original address.
12632 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
12633 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
12634 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
12635 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
12636 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
12638 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
12639 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
12640 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
12642 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
12643 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
12644 .cindex "sender" "gid"
12645 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12646 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
12647 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
12648 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
12649 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
12650 normally the gid of the Exim user.
12652 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
12653 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
12654 .cindex "sender" "uid"
12655 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12656 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
12657 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
12658 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
12659 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
12662 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
12663 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
12664 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
12665 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12667 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
12668 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
12669 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
12670 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
12673 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
12675 This variable contains the current process id.
12677 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
12678 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12679 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12680 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
12681 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
12682 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
12683 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
12684 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
12685 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
12686 variable"& error if encountered.
12688 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
12689 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
12690 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
12691 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
12692 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
12693 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
12694 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
12697 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
12698 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
12699 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
12700 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
12702 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
12704 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
12706 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
12707 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
12708 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
12709 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
12711 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
12712 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12713 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12714 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12716 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
12717 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12718 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12719 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12721 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
12722 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
12723 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
12724 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
12726 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
12727 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12728 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
12730 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
12731 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
12732 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
12733 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
12735 .vitem &$queue_name$&
12736 .vindex &$queue_name$&
12737 .cindex "named queues"
12738 .cindex queues named
12739 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
12741 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
12742 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
12743 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12744 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
12745 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
12747 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
12748 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
12749 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
12750 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12751 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12752 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
12754 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
12755 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
12756 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
12757 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
12758 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
12760 .vitem &$received_count$&
12761 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
12762 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
12763 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
12764 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
12767 .vitem &$received_for$&
12768 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
12769 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
12770 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
12771 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
12772 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
12774 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
12775 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
12776 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
12777 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
12778 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
12779 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
12780 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
12783 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
12784 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
12785 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
12786 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
12787 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
12789 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
12791 .vitem &$received_port$&
12792 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
12793 See &$received_ip_address$&.
12795 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
12796 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
12797 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
12798 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
12799 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
12800 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
12801 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
12802 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
12803 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
12805 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
12806 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
12807 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
12808 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
12809 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
12810 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
12812 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
12813 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
12814 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
12816 .vitem &$received_time$&
12817 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
12818 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
12819 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
12821 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
12822 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
12823 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
12824 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
12825 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
12827 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12828 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
12830 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12831 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12832 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12833 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12835 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
12836 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
12837 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
12838 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
12841 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
12842 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
12845 &"route"&: Routing failed.
12848 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
12849 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
12853 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
12856 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
12859 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
12860 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
12862 .vitem &$recipients$&
12863 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
12864 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
12865 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
12866 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
12867 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
12871 In a system filter file.
12873 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
12874 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
12875 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
12876 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
12878 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
12882 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
12883 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
12884 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
12885 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
12886 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
12887 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
12890 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
12891 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
12892 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
12893 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
12895 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
12896 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
12897 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
12898 these variables contain the
12899 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
12902 .vitem &$reply_address$&
12903 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
12904 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
12905 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
12906 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
12907 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
12908 decoding or character code translation takes place.
12910 .vitem &$return_path$&
12911 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
12912 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
12913 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
12914 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
12915 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
12916 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
12917 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
12918 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
12919 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
12920 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
12923 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
12924 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
12925 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
12927 .vitem &$router_name$&
12928 .cindex "router" "name"
12929 .cindex "name" "of router"
12930 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
12931 During the running of a router this variable contains its name.
12934 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
12935 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
12936 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
12937 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
12938 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
12939 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
12940 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
12943 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
12944 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
12945 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
12946 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
12947 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
12948 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
12949 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
12950 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
12952 .vitem &$sender_address$&
12953 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
12954 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
12955 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
12956 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
12957 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
12959 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
12960 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12961 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
12962 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12963 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
12964 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
12965 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
12966 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
12968 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
12969 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
12970 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
12972 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
12973 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
12974 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
12976 .vitem &$sender_data$&
12977 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
12978 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
12979 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
12980 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
12983 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
12984 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
12986 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
12987 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
12988 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
12989 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
12991 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
12992 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
12993 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
12994 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
12995 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
12996 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
12997 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
12998 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
12999 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13000 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13001 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13002 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13003 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13005 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13006 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13007 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13008 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13009 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13011 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
13012 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
13013 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13014 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13015 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13016 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13018 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13019 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13020 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13021 this variable contains that
13022 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13024 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13025 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13026 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13027 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13028 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13029 &$authenticated_id$&.
13031 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13032 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13033 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13034 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13035 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13036 resolver library states that both
13037 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13038 other times, this variable is false.
13040 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13041 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13042 library, by setting:
13047 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13048 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13050 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13051 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13053 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13054 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13055 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13056 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13059 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
13060 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13061 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13062 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13063 other means, this variable is empty.
13065 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13066 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13067 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13068 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13069 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13070 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13071 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13073 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13074 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13075 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13076 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13078 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13079 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13080 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13083 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13084 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13085 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13086 following are true:
13089 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13091 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13092 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13093 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13095 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13096 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13097 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13099 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13100 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13101 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13103 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13104 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13105 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13106 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13108 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13110 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13111 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13115 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13116 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13117 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13118 number that was used on the remote host.
13120 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13121 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13122 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13123 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13124 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13127 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13128 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13129 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13130 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13132 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13133 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13134 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13135 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13136 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13137 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13138 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13139 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13140 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13141 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13142 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13145 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13146 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13147 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13148 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13149 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13151 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13152 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13153 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13154 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13155 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13157 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13158 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13159 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13160 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13161 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13162 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13163 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13165 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13166 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13167 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13168 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13169 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13171 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13172 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13173 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13174 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13175 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13176 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13178 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
13179 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
13180 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13181 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13182 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13187 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13188 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13189 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13190 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13192 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
13193 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13194 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
13195 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13196 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13197 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13198 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13200 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13201 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13202 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13203 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13204 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13207 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13208 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13209 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13210 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13211 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13212 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13213 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13214 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13215 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13216 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13217 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13219 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13220 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13221 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13222 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13223 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13224 message is junk mail.
13226 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
13227 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13228 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13229 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13231 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13232 &$spf_received$& &&&
13234 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13235 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13236 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13237 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13239 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13240 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13241 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13243 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13244 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13245 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13246 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13247 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13248 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13250 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13251 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13252 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13253 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13254 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13255 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13256 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13257 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13259 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13261 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13264 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13265 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13266 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13267 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13268 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13269 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13271 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13272 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13273 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13274 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13275 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13276 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13277 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13278 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13280 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13281 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13284 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13285 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13286 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13287 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13288 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13289 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13291 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13292 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13293 .cindex certificate variables
13294 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13295 inbound connection when the message was received.
13296 It is only useful as the argument of a
13297 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13298 or a &%def%& condition.
13300 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13301 when a list of more than one
13302 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13304 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13305 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13306 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13307 inbound connection when the message was received.
13308 It is only useful as the argument of a
13309 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13310 or a &%def%& condition.
13311 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13312 which is not the leaf.
13314 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13315 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13316 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13317 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13318 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13319 or a &%def%& condition.
13321 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13322 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13323 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13324 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13325 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13326 or a &%def%& condition.
13327 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13328 which is not the leaf.
13330 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13331 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13332 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13333 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13335 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13336 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13339 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13340 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13341 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13342 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13343 and &"0"& otherwise.
13345 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13346 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13347 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13348 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13349 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13350 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13351 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13352 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13353 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
13355 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
13356 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
13357 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
13360 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
13361 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
13362 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13365 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
13366 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
13368 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
13369 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
13370 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
13371 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
13374 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
13375 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
13376 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
13379 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
13380 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
13381 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13383 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
13384 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
13385 When a message is received from a remote client connection
13386 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
13388 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
13389 1 No response to request
13390 2 Response not verified
13391 3 Verification failed
13392 4 Verification succeeded
13395 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
13396 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
13397 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
13398 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
13399 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
13401 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
13402 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
13403 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
13404 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
13405 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13406 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
13407 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13408 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13409 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13410 which is not the leaf.
13412 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
13413 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13416 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
13417 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
13418 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13419 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
13420 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
13421 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
13422 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13423 which is not the leaf.
13425 .vitem &$tls_in_sni$&
13426 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
13427 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
13428 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13429 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
13430 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
13431 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
13432 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
13433 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
13434 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
13435 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
13437 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
13438 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13441 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
13442 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
13443 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
13445 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
13448 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13449 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
13450 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
13452 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
13453 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
13454 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
13455 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
13457 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
13458 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
13459 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13461 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
13462 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
13463 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13465 .vitem &$tod_full$&
13466 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
13467 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
13468 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
13469 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
13470 values for those that are behind (west).
13473 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13474 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
13475 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
13477 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
13478 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
13479 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
13480 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
13483 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
13484 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13485 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
13488 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
13489 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
13490 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
13491 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
13493 .vitem &$transport_name$&
13494 .cindex "transport" "name"
13495 .cindex "name" "of transport"
13496 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
13497 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
13500 .vindex "&$value$&"
13501 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
13502 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
13503 &*reduce*& expansion.
13505 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
13506 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
13507 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
13508 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
13511 .vitem &$version_number$&
13512 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
13513 The version number of Exim.
13515 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
13516 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
13517 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13518 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13520 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
13521 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
13522 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
13523 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
13529 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13532 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
13533 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
13534 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
13535 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
13536 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
13537 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
13542 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
13545 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
13546 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
13547 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
13548 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
13549 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
13550 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
13551 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
13552 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
13553 a newly created Perl interpreter.
13555 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
13556 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
13557 should usually be something like
13559 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
13561 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
13562 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
13563 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
13564 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
13565 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
13566 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
13567 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
13568 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
13572 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
13573 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
13574 a startup when Exim is entered.
13576 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
13577 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
13580 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
13581 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
13584 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
13585 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
13586 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
13587 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
13588 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
13589 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
13593 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
13594 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
13595 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
13596 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
13600 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
13601 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
13603 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
13604 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
13605 with an error message of the form
13607 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
13609 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
13610 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
13611 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
13612 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
13613 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
13614 that was passed to &%die%&.
13617 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
13618 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
13619 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
13622 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
13624 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
13625 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
13626 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
13628 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
13629 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
13630 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
13631 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
13633 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
13634 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
13635 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
13636 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
13637 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
13638 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
13639 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
13642 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
13643 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
13644 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
13645 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
13646 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
13647 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
13648 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
13649 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
13650 avoided, but the output is lost.
13652 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
13653 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
13654 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
13655 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
13656 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
13657 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
13658 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
13660 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
13662 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
13663 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
13664 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
13665 as the first subroutine argument.
13669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13672 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
13673 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
13674 "Starting the daemon"
13675 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
13676 .cindex "interface" "listening"
13677 .cindex "network interface"
13678 .cindex "interface" "network"
13679 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
13680 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
13681 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
13682 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13683 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
13684 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
13685 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
13686 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
13687 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
13688 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
13689 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
13692 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
13693 and ports to listen on.
13695 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
13696 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
13697 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
13698 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
13699 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
13700 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
13701 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
13702 as an error situation.
13704 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
13705 for the outgoing connection.
13709 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
13710 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
13711 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
13712 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
13713 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
13715 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
13716 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
13717 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
13718 chapter describes how they operate.
13720 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
13721 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13725 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
13726 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
13727 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
13731 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
13733 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
13735 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
13736 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
13739 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
13740 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
13741 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
13742 colons. For example:
13744 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
13747 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
13749 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
13750 in &%local_interfaces%&:
13753 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
13754 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
13756 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
13757 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
13760 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
13761 with a colon separator, for example:
13763 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
13764 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
13768 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
13769 default setting contains just one port:
13771 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13773 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
13774 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
13775 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
13776 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
13777 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
13781 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
13782 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
13783 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
13784 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
13785 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
13786 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13788 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13790 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
13792 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13794 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
13798 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
13799 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
13800 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
13801 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
13802 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
13803 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
13806 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
13807 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
13808 If there are any items that do not
13809 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
13810 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
13811 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
13812 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
13816 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
13819 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
13821 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
13822 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
13823 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
13827 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
13828 .cindex "submissions protocol"
13829 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
13830 .cindex "smtps protocol"
13831 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
13832 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
13833 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
13834 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
13835 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
13836 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
13837 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
13838 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
13839 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
13842 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
13843 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
13844 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
13846 The common use of this option is expected to be
13848 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
13851 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
13852 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
13854 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
13855 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
13856 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
13857 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
13858 connections via the daemon.)
13863 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
13864 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
13865 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
13866 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
13867 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
13868 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
13869 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
13870 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
13872 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
13874 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
13875 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
13876 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
13877 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
13878 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
13879 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
13881 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
13883 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
13884 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
13885 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
13886 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
13887 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
13889 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
13890 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13891 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
13892 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
13893 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
13894 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
13895 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
13896 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13897 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13898 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
13899 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13900 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13902 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
13903 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
13904 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
13905 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
13906 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
13910 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
13911 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
13913 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
13914 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13916 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
13917 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
13918 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
13919 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
13921 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
13923 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
13925 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
13927 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
13928 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
13930 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
13931 IPv4 loopback address only:
13933 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
13935 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
13937 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
13939 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
13943 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
13944 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
13945 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
13946 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
13949 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
13950 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
13951 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
13952 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
13954 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
13955 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
13956 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
13957 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
13958 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
13959 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
13960 used for listening. Consider this example:
13962 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
13964 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
13966 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13968 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
13969 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
13972 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
13973 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
13974 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
13975 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
13976 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
13977 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
13978 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
13979 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
13983 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
13984 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
13985 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
13986 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
13987 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
13988 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
13994 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13995 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13997 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
13998 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
13999 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14000 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14003 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14004 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14006 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14007 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14008 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14010 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14011 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14012 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14013 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14017 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14018 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14019 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14020 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14021 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14022 listed in more than one group.
14024 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14026 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14027 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14028 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14029 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14030 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14031 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14032 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14033 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14034 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14035 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14036 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14040 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14042 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14043 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14044 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14045 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14046 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14047 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14052 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14054 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14055 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14056 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14057 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14058 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14059 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14060 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14061 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14062 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14063 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14064 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14065 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14070 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14072 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14073 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14074 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14075 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14076 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14077 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14078 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14079 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14080 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14081 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14082 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14083 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14084 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14085 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14086 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14091 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14093 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14094 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14095 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14096 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14101 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14103 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14104 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14105 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14106 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14107 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14108 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14109 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14110 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14111 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14112 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14113 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14114 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14115 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14116 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14117 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14122 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14124 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14125 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14130 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14132 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14133 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14134 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14139 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14141 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14142 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14143 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14144 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14145 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14146 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14147 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14152 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14154 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14155 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14156 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14157 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14158 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14159 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14160 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14161 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14162 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14163 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14164 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14165 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14166 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14167 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14168 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14169 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14171 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14172 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14173 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14174 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14175 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14180 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14182 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14183 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14184 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14185 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14186 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14187 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14188 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14189 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14190 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14191 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14192 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14193 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14194 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14195 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14196 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14197 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14198 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14199 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14200 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14201 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14202 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14203 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14205 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14206 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14207 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14208 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14209 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14210 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14211 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14212 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14213 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14214 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14215 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14216 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14217 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14218 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14219 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14220 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14221 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14222 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14223 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14224 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14229 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14231 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14233 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14235 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14236 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14237 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14242 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14244 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14245 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14246 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14247 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14248 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14249 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14250 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14251 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14252 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14253 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14254 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14255 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14256 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14257 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14258 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14259 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14260 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14265 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14267 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14268 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14269 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14270 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14271 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14272 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14273 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14274 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14279 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14281 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14282 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14283 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14284 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14285 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14286 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14287 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14288 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14294 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14296 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14303 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14304 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14307 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domain for which DKIM ACL is run"
14308 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14309 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14310 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14311 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14312 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14313 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14314 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
14315 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14316 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14317 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14318 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14319 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14320 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14321 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14323 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14324 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
14325 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
14326 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14327 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14328 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
14329 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
14330 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
14331 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
14332 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
14333 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
14334 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
14335 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
14336 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
14337 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14338 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14343 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
14345 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
14346 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
14347 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
14348 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
14349 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
14350 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
14351 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
14352 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
14353 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
14354 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14359 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
14361 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
14362 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
14363 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
14364 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14366 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14367 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14368 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
14369 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
14370 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
14371 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
14372 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
14373 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
14374 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
14375 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
14380 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
14382 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
14383 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
14385 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
14386 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
14387 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
14388 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
14389 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
14394 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
14396 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14397 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
14398 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
14399 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
14400 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
14401 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
14402 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
14403 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
14404 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
14405 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
14406 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
14407 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
14408 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
14409 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
14410 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
14411 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14412 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
14413 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
14414 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
14415 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
14416 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14417 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
14418 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
14419 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
14424 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
14426 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
14427 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
14428 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
14429 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
14430 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
14431 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
14432 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
14433 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
14434 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
14435 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
14436 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
14437 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
14438 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
14439 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
14440 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
14445 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
14446 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
14449 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
14451 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14452 .cindex "log" "selectors"
14453 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
14454 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
14455 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
14456 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
14457 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
14459 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
14460 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
14461 It now defaults to true.
14462 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
14464 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
14467 To log received 8BITMIME status use
14469 log_selector = +8bitmime
14472 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
14473 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
14474 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14475 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
14476 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14479 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14480 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
14481 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
14484 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
14485 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
14486 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
14487 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
14488 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14490 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
14491 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
14492 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
14493 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
14494 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14496 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
14497 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
14498 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
14499 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14501 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
14502 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
14503 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
14504 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
14505 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14507 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
14508 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
14509 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
14510 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
14511 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
14512 This option defines the ACL that,
14513 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
14514 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
14515 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
14516 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14518 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
14519 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
14520 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
14521 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
14522 of a received message.
14523 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
14525 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
14526 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
14527 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
14528 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14530 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
14531 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
14532 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
14533 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14535 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
14536 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
14537 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
14538 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
14539 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14542 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
14543 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
14544 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
14545 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14547 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
14548 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
14549 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
14550 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
14551 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
14553 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
14554 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
14555 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
14556 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
14557 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
14559 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
14560 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
14561 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
14562 ends without a QUIT command being received.
14563 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14565 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
14566 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
14567 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
14570 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
14571 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
14572 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
14573 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14575 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
14576 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
14577 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
14578 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14580 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
14581 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
14582 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
14583 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14585 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
14586 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
14587 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
14588 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
14590 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
14591 .cindex "environment" "set values"
14592 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
14593 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use.
14594 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
14596 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
14597 .cindex "admin user"
14598 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
14599 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
14600 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
14601 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
14602 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
14603 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
14604 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
14606 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
14607 .cindex "domain literal"
14608 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
14609 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
14610 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
14611 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
14613 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
14614 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
14615 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
14616 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
14617 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
14618 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
14619 the local host's IP addresses.
14622 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
14623 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
14624 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
14625 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
14626 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
14627 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
14628 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
14629 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
14630 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
14632 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
14633 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
14634 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
14635 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
14636 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
14637 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
14638 experiment if they wish.
14640 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
14641 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
14642 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
14643 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
14644 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
14645 suitable setting is:
14647 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
14648 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
14650 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
14652 dns_check_names_pattern =
14654 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
14657 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14658 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
14659 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
14660 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
14661 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
14662 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
14663 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
14664 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
14665 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
14666 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
14667 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
14669 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
14670 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
14671 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
14672 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
14673 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
14674 which Exim advertises AUTH.
14676 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
14677 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
14678 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
14679 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
14681 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
14683 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14684 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
14685 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
14686 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
14689 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
14690 .cindex "thawing messages"
14691 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
14692 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
14693 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
14694 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
14695 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
14696 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
14698 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
14699 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
14700 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
14703 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
14704 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
14705 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
14707 sophie:/var/run/sophie
14709 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
14710 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
14713 .option bi_command main string unset
14715 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
14716 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
14717 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
14718 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
14721 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
14722 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
14723 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
14724 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
14725 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
14726 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
14729 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
14730 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
14731 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
14732 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
14734 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
14735 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
14736 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
14737 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
14738 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
14739 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
14740 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
14741 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
14742 point at which the error was detected are returned.
14743 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
14745 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
14746 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
14747 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
14748 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
14749 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
14750 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
14751 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
14752 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
14753 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
14754 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
14756 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
14757 during reception of a message.
14758 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
14760 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
14763 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
14764 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
14765 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
14766 &%bounce_return_body%&.
14769 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
14770 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
14771 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
14772 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
14773 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
14774 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
14775 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
14776 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
14777 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
14779 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
14780 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
14781 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
14782 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
14783 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
14786 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
14787 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
14788 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
14789 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
14790 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
14791 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
14792 connection. A typical setting might be:
14794 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14796 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
14798 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
14800 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
14803 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
14804 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
14805 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
14806 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
14807 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14808 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14811 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
14812 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
14813 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14814 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14817 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
14818 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
14819 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14820 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14823 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
14824 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
14825 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
14826 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
14829 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
14830 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
14831 callout verification. The default value is
14833 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
14835 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
14838 .option check_log_inodes main integer 100
14839 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14842 .option check_log_space main integer 10M
14843 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14845 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
14846 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
14847 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
14848 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
14849 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
14850 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
14851 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
14852 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
14853 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
14854 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
14857 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 100
14858 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
14861 .option check_spool_space main integer 10M
14862 .cindex "checking disk space"
14863 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14864 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14865 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
14866 message is accepted.
14868 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
14869 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
14870 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14871 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14872 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
14873 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
14874 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
14875 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
14878 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
14879 either value is greater than zero, for example:
14881 check_spool_space = 100M
14882 check_spool_inodes = 100
14884 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
14885 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
14888 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
14889 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
14890 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
14892 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
14893 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
14894 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
14895 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
14896 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
14897 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
14899 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
14900 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
14901 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
14903 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
14904 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
14905 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
14907 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
14908 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
14909 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
14910 may wish to deliberately disable them.
14912 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14913 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
14914 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
14915 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
14917 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
14919 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
14920 .cindex "restricting access to features"
14921 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
14922 administrative user.
14923 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
14925 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
14926 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
14927 .cindex memory debugging
14928 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
14929 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
14930 it should normally be left as default.
14932 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
14933 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
14934 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14935 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
14936 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
14937 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
14939 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
14940 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
14941 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
14942 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
14943 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
14944 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
14945 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
14947 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
14948 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
14950 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
14951 .cindex "warning of delay"
14952 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
14953 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
14954 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
14955 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
14956 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
14957 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
14958 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
14959 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
14962 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
14964 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
14965 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
14966 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
14967 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
14971 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
14972 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
14974 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
14976 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
14977 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
14978 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
14980 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
14981 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14982 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
14983 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
14984 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
14985 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
14986 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
14987 not sent. The default is:
14989 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
14990 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
14991 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
14992 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
14995 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
14996 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
14997 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
14998 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15000 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15001 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15002 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15003 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15004 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15005 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15006 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15007 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15009 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15010 .cindex "load average"
15011 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15012 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15013 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15014 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15015 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15018 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15019 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15020 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15021 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15022 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15023 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15024 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15025 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15027 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15028 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15029 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15030 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15031 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15032 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15033 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15034 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15036 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15037 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15038 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15039 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15042 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15043 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15044 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15045 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15046 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15047 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15048 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15051 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15052 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15053 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15054 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15055 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15056 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15059 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15060 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15061 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15062 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15063 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15064 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15065 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15066 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15067 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15068 by a setting such as this:
15070 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15072 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
15073 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15074 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15075 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15076 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15077 options are applied after this global option.
15079 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15080 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15081 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15082 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15083 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15084 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15085 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15086 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15087 value of this option. The default pattern is
15089 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15090 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15092 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15093 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15094 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15095 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15096 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15099 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15100 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15101 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15103 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15104 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15105 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15106 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15108 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15109 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15110 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15111 not do it internally.
15112 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15113 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15115 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15116 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15117 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15120 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15121 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15122 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15123 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15124 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15125 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15127 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15130 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15131 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15132 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15133 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15134 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15135 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15136 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15137 domain matches this list.
15139 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15140 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15141 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15144 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15145 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15146 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15147 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15148 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15149 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15150 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15151 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15152 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15153 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15154 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15155 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15157 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15160 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15161 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15164 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15165 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15166 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15167 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15168 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15169 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15170 match with this expanded domain list.
15172 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15173 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15174 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15175 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15176 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15177 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15179 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15180 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15181 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15183 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15184 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15185 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15186 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15187 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15189 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15190 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15191 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15192 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15193 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15194 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15195 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15196 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15199 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15201 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15202 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15203 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15206 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15207 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15208 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15209 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15211 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15212 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15213 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15214 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15215 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15216 and accepted from, these hosts.
15217 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ENVID options on RCPT TO commands,
15218 and RET and ORCPT options on MAIL FROM commands.
15219 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15220 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15223 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15224 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15225 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15226 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15227 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15228 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15230 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15232 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15233 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15235 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
15236 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
15237 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
15238 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15239 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
15240 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
15241 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
15242 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
15243 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15246 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
15247 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
15248 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
15249 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
15250 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
15251 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
15252 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
15253 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
15254 must be enclosed in double quotes.
15256 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
15257 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
15258 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
15259 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
15260 are examined. For example:
15262 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
15263 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
15264 postmaster@mydomain.example
15266 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15267 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15268 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
15269 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
15270 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
15271 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
15272 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
15275 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
15276 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
15277 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
15279 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
15281 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
15282 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
15283 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
15284 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
15285 overrides the default.
15287 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
15288 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
15289 and warning messages. For example:
15291 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
15293 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
15294 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
15295 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
15296 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
15300 .option event_action main string&!! unset
15302 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
15303 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
15306 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
15307 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
15308 .cindex "Exim group"
15309 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15310 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
15311 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
15312 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
15313 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
15317 .option exim_path main string "see below"
15318 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
15319 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
15320 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
15321 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
15322 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
15324 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
15325 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
15326 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
15327 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
15330 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
15331 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
15332 .cindex "Exim user"
15333 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
15334 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
15335 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
15336 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
15338 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
15339 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
15340 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
15341 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
15344 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
15345 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
15346 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
15347 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
15350 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
15351 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
15353 .option "extract_addresses_remove_arguments" main boolean true &&&
15354 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
15356 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
15357 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
15358 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
15359 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
15360 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
15361 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
15362 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
15363 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
15364 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
15365 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
15369 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
15370 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
15371 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
15372 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
15373 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
15374 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
15375 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
15376 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
15379 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
15380 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
15381 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
15382 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
15386 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
15387 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
15388 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
15389 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
15390 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
15391 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
15392 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
15393 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
15394 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
15395 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
15396 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
15397 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
15398 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
15399 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
15400 logging that you require.
15403 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
15405 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
15406 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
15407 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
15408 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
15409 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
15410 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
15411 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
15412 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
15414 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
15415 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
15416 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
15419 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
15420 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
15421 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
15422 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
15424 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
15428 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
15429 See &%gecos_name%& above.
15432 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
15433 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
15434 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
15435 implementations of TLS.
15438 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
15439 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
15440 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
15443 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
15448 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
15449 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
15450 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
15451 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
15452 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
15453 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
15457 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
15458 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
15459 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
15460 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
15461 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
15462 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
15463 sections are rejected.
15466 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
15467 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
15468 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
15469 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
15470 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
15471 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
15472 zero means &"no limit"&.
15477 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15478 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
15479 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
15480 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
15481 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
15482 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
15483 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
15484 if you want to do semantic checking.
15485 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
15489 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
15490 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
15491 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
15492 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
15493 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
15494 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
15495 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
15497 helo_allow_chars = _
15499 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
15502 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
15503 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15504 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
15505 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
15506 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
15507 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
15508 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
15512 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15513 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
15514 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
15515 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
15516 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
15517 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
15518 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
15519 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
15520 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
15521 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
15522 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
15523 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
15525 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
15526 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
15527 EHLO command either:
15530 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
15532 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
15533 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
15534 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
15535 calling host address, or
15537 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
15540 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
15541 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
15542 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
15544 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
15545 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15546 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
15548 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15549 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
15550 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
15551 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
15552 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
15553 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
15554 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
15555 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
15556 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
15559 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
15560 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
15561 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
15562 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
15563 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
15564 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
15565 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
15566 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
15567 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
15569 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
15570 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
15571 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
15572 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
15573 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
15575 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
15576 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
15577 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
15578 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
15581 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
15582 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
15583 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
15584 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
15585 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
15586 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
15587 default configuration file contains
15591 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
15592 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
15594 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
15595 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
15596 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
15598 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
15599 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
15600 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
15601 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
15602 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
15603 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
15606 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
15607 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
15608 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
15609 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
15610 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
15613 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
15614 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
15615 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
15616 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
15620 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
15621 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
15622 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
15623 as soon as the connection is made.
15624 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
15625 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
15626 connections immediately.
15628 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
15629 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
15630 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
15631 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
15632 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
15635 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
15636 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
15637 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
15638 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
15639 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
15640 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
15641 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
15642 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
15643 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
15645 hosts_connection_nolog = :
15647 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
15651 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
15652 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
15653 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
15654 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
15657 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
15658 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
15659 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
15660 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
15661 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
15663 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
15664 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
15666 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
15667 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
15668 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
15669 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
15670 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
15671 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
15672 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
15675 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
15676 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
15677 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
15678 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
15679 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
15683 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
15684 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
15685 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
15686 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
15687 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
15688 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
15690 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
15691 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
15692 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
15693 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
15694 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
15695 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
15696 for frozen messages. For example,
15698 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
15700 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
15701 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
15702 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
15703 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
15704 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
15705 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
15708 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15709 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15710 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15711 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
15712 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
15713 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
15714 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
15715 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
15716 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
15717 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
15720 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
15721 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
15723 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
15724 .cindex "environment" "values from"
15725 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
15726 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
15727 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
15728 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
15729 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
15730 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
15731 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
15733 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
15734 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
15736 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
15737 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
15738 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
15739 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
15741 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
15742 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
15743 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
15746 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
15747 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
15748 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
15752 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
15753 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
15754 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
15755 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
15759 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
15760 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
15761 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
15762 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
15763 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15764 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15765 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15766 and constrained to be a directory.
15769 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
15770 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
15771 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15772 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
15773 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
15774 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
15775 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
15776 and constrained to be a file.
15779 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
15780 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
15781 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
15782 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
15783 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15784 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
15787 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
15788 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
15789 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
15790 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
15791 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
15792 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
15793 identity to be proven.
15796 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
15797 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
15798 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
15799 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
15800 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
15803 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
15804 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
15805 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
15806 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
15807 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
15811 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
15812 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
15813 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
15814 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
15815 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
15816 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
15820 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
15821 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
15822 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
15823 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
15824 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
15826 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
15827 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
15828 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
15831 .option ldap_version main integer unset
15832 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
15833 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
15834 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
15835 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
15836 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
15837 has been built with LDAP support.
15841 .option local_from_check main boolean true
15842 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
15843 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
15844 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15845 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
15846 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
15847 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
15849 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
15850 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
15851 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
15853 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
15854 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
15855 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
15856 and the default qualify domain.
15858 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
15859 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
15860 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
15861 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
15863 .cindex "envelope sender"
15864 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
15865 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
15866 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
15868 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
15869 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
15870 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15875 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
15876 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
15877 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
15878 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
15879 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
15880 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
15881 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
15884 local_from_prefix = *-
15886 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
15888 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
15890 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
15891 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
15895 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
15896 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
15899 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
15900 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
15901 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
15902 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
15903 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
15904 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
15905 &%local_interfaces%& is
15907 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
15909 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
15911 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
15914 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
15915 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
15916 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
15917 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
15918 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
15919 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
15920 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
15921 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
15925 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
15926 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
15927 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
15928 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
15929 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
15930 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
15931 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
15932 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
15937 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
15938 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
15939 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
15940 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
15941 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
15942 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
15943 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
15944 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
15945 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
15946 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
15947 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
15948 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
15949 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
15950 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
15951 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
15955 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
15956 .cindex "log" "file path for"
15957 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
15958 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
15959 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
15960 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
15961 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
15962 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
15963 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
15964 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
15965 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
15966 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
15967 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
15968 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
15969 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
15972 .option log_selector main string unset
15973 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15974 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
15975 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
15976 minus characters. For example:
15978 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
15980 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
15981 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
15984 .option log_timezone main boolean false
15985 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
15986 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
15987 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
15988 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
15989 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
15990 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
15991 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
15992 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
15993 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
15994 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
15995 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
15996 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
15999 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16000 .cindex "too many open files"
16001 .cindex "open files, too many"
16002 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16003 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16004 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16005 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16006 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16007 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16008 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16009 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16010 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16011 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16012 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16013 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16016 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16017 .cindex "length of login name"
16018 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16019 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16020 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16021 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16022 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16023 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16026 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16027 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16028 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16029 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16030 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16031 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16032 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16033 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16036 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16037 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16038 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16039 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16040 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16041 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16042 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16045 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16046 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16047 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16048 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16049 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16050 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16051 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16052 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16053 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16054 empty string, the option is ignored.
16057 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16058 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16059 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16060 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16061 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16062 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16063 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16064 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16065 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16066 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16067 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16068 colons will become hyphens.
16071 .option message_logs main boolean true
16072 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16073 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16074 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16075 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16076 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16077 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16078 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16079 which is not affected by this option.
16082 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16083 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16084 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16085 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16086 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16087 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16088 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16089 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16090 optionally followed by K or M.
16092 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16093 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16094 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16095 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16096 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16098 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16099 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16100 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16101 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16102 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16103 message that an individual transport can process.
16105 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16106 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16107 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16108 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16109 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16110 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16111 some problems may result.
16113 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16114 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16115 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16118 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16119 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16120 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16122 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16124 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16125 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16126 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16127 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16128 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16131 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16132 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16133 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16134 contains a full description of this facility.
16138 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16139 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16140 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16141 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16142 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16145 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16146 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16147 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16148 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16149 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16152 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16153 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16154 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16155 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16156 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16158 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16159 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16162 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16164 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16165 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16169 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +single_dh_use +no_ticket"
16170 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
16171 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
16172 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
16173 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
16175 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
16176 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
16177 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
16178 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
16179 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
16180 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
16181 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
16183 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
16184 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
16185 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
16186 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
16187 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
16189 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
16191 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
16192 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
16193 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
16194 some now infamous attacks.
16198 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
16199 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
16200 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
16202 # Disable older protocol versions:
16203 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
16206 Possible options may include:
16210 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
16212 &`cipher_server_preference`&
16214 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
16218 &`legacy_server_connect`&
16220 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
16222 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
16224 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
16226 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
16228 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
16232 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
16246 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
16250 &`single_ecdh_use`&
16252 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
16254 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
16256 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
16260 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
16263 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
16264 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
16265 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
16266 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
16267 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
16268 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
16271 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
16272 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
16273 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
16274 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16275 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
16278 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16279 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
16280 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
16281 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
16282 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
16283 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
16284 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
16285 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
16286 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
16287 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
16290 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
16291 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
16292 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
16293 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
16294 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
16295 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
16296 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
16299 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
16301 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16302 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16305 .option perl_startup main string unset
16307 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
16308 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
16310 .option perl_startup main boolean false
16312 This Option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
16315 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
16316 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
16317 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
16318 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
16319 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
16320 PostgreSQL support.
16323 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
16324 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
16325 .cindex "pid file, path for"
16326 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
16327 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
16330 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
16332 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
16334 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
16335 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
16336 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
16339 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16340 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
16341 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16342 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
16343 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
16344 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
16345 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
16346 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
16347 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
16350 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
16351 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
16352 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
16353 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
16354 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
16355 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
16356 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
16357 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
16359 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
16360 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
16361 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
16362 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
16363 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
16364 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
16365 volume of mail. Use with care!
16368 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
16369 .cindex "name" "of local host"
16370 .cindex "host" "name of local"
16371 .cindex "local host" "name of"
16372 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16373 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
16374 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
16375 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
16376 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
16377 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
16379 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
16380 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
16381 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
16382 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
16383 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
16384 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
16387 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
16388 .cindex "printing characters"
16389 .cindex "8-bit characters"
16390 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
16391 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
16392 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
16393 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
16394 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
16397 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
16398 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
16399 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
16400 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
16401 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
16405 .option process_log_path main string unset
16406 .cindex "process log path"
16407 .cindex "log" "process log"
16408 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
16409 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
16410 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
16411 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
16412 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
16413 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
16414 different spool directories.
16417 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
16418 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16422 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
16423 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
16424 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16427 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
16428 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
16429 .cindex "address" "qualification"
16430 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
16431 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
16432 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
16433 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
16434 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
16435 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16437 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
16438 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
16439 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
16440 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
16441 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
16442 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
16443 &%primary_hostname%& value.
16446 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
16447 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
16448 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
16452 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16453 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
16454 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16455 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
16456 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
16457 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
16458 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
16459 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
16462 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
16463 .cindex "restricting access to features"
16465 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
16466 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
16467 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
16468 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
16471 .option queue_only main boolean false
16472 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16473 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
16474 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
16475 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
16476 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
16477 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
16479 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
16480 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
16481 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
16482 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
16485 .option queue_only_file main string unset
16486 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16487 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
16488 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
16489 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
16490 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
16491 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
16492 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
16493 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
16495 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
16497 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
16498 &_/some/file_& exists.
16501 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
16502 .cindex "load average"
16503 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16504 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
16505 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
16506 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
16507 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
16508 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
16509 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16512 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
16513 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
16514 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
16515 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16518 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
16519 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
16520 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
16521 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
16522 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
16523 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
16524 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
16525 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
16526 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
16527 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
16528 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
16529 re-evaluated for each message.
16532 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
16533 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16534 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
16535 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
16536 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
16537 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
16540 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
16541 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
16542 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
16543 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
16544 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
16545 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
16546 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
16547 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
16548 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
16549 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
16550 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
16551 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
16552 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
16556 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
16557 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
16558 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
16559 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
16560 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
16561 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
16562 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
16563 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
16564 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
16566 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
16567 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
16568 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
16569 the daemon's command line.
16571 .cindex queues named
16572 .cindex "named queues"
16573 To set limits for different named queues use
16574 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
16576 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16577 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16578 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
16579 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
16580 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
16581 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
16582 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
16583 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
16584 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
16585 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
16586 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
16587 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
16588 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
16592 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
16593 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
16594 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
16595 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
16596 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
16597 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
16598 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
16600 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
16601 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
16602 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
16603 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
16604 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
16605 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
16606 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
16607 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
16608 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
16611 The default setting is:
16614 received_header_text = Received: \
16615 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
16616 {${if def:sender_ident \
16617 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
16618 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
16619 by $primary_hostname \
16620 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
16621 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
16622 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
16623 ${if def:sender_address \
16624 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
16625 id $message_exim_id\
16626 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
16630 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
16631 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
16632 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
16633 header lines such as the following:
16635 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
16636 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
16637 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
16638 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
16639 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
16640 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
16641 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
16643 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
16644 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
16645 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
16646 message was accepted.
16649 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
16650 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
16651 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
16652 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
16653 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
16654 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
16655 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
16656 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
16659 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16660 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16661 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16662 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16663 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
16664 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
16665 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
16666 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
16667 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
16668 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
16669 option was not set.
16672 .option recipients_max main integer 0
16673 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
16674 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
16675 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
16676 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
16677 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
16678 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
16679 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
16682 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
16683 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
16684 RCPT commands in a single message.
16687 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
16688 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
16689 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
16690 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
16691 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
16692 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
16693 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
16696 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
16697 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
16698 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
16699 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
16700 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
16701 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
16702 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
16703 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
16704 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
16705 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
16706 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
16707 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
16708 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
16709 tagged with its process id.
16711 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
16712 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
16713 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
16714 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
16717 .cindex "number of deliveries"
16718 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
16719 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
16720 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
16721 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
16722 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
16723 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
16724 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
16725 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
16726 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
16727 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
16729 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
16730 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
16731 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
16732 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
16735 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16736 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
16737 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
16738 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
16739 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
16741 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
16743 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
16744 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
16747 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
16748 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
16749 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
16750 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
16751 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
16755 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
16756 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
16757 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
16758 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
16759 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
16760 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
16761 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
16765 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
16766 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
16767 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
16768 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
16769 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
16770 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
16771 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
16772 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
16773 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
16774 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
16777 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
16778 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16781 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
16783 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
16784 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
16785 an item in the list.
16786 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
16789 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
16790 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
16791 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
16792 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
16793 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
16796 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16797 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
16798 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
16799 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
16800 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
16801 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
16802 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
16803 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
16804 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
16805 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
16807 .option set_environment main "string list" empty
16808 .cindex "environment"
16809 This option allows to set individual environment variables that the
16810 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes use. The
16811 default list is empty,
16814 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
16815 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
16816 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
16817 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
16818 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
16819 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
16820 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
16824 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
16825 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
16826 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
16827 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
16828 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
16829 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
16830 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
16831 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
16832 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
16833 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
16834 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
16838 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
16839 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
16840 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16842 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
16843 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
16844 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
16845 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
16846 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
16847 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
16849 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
16850 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
16851 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
16852 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
16855 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
16856 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
16857 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
16858 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
16859 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
16860 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
16861 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
16862 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
16864 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
16865 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
16866 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
16867 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
16868 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
16869 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
16870 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
16871 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
16874 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16875 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
16876 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
16877 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
16881 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16882 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16883 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
16884 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
16885 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
16886 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
16887 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
16888 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
16889 . the option name to split.
16891 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_connection" main integer 1000 &&&
16892 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16893 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
16894 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
16895 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
16896 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
16897 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
16898 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
16899 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
16903 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
16904 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
16905 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
16906 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
16907 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
16908 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
16909 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
16910 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
16911 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
16912 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
16913 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
16915 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
16916 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
16917 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
16918 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
16919 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
16920 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
16924 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
16925 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
16926 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16927 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
16928 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
16929 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
16930 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
16931 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
16932 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
16933 to all messages received in the same connection.
16935 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
16936 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
16937 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
16938 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
16941 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
16943 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_connection" main integer 10 &&&
16944 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
16945 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
16946 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
16947 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
16948 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
16949 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
16950 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
16951 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
16952 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
16953 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
16954 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
16955 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
16958 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
16959 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
16960 .cindex "host" "reserved"
16961 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
16962 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
16963 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
16964 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
16965 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
16966 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
16967 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
16968 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
16971 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
16972 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
16973 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
16974 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
16977 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
16978 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
16979 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
16980 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
16981 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
16982 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
16983 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
16984 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
16985 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
16987 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
16988 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
16989 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
16990 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
16992 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
16993 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
16994 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
16995 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
16996 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
16999 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17000 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17003 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17004 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17005 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17006 &%helo_data%& value.
17008 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17009 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17010 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17011 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17012 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17013 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
17014 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17016 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17017 $version_number $tod_full
17019 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
17020 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17021 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17022 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17023 multiline response).
17026 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17027 .cindex "checking disk space"
17028 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17029 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17030 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17031 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17032 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17033 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17034 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17037 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17038 .cindex "connection backlog"
17039 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17040 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17041 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17042 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17043 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17044 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17045 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17046 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17047 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17048 attacks by SYN flooding.
17051 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17052 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17053 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17054 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17055 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17056 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17057 fewer, but they still exist.
17059 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17060 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17061 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17062 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17063 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17064 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17065 does detect many instances.
17067 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17068 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17069 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17070 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17074 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17075 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17076 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17077 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17078 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17079 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17080 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17081 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17084 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17085 $sender_host_address
17087 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17088 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17089 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17090 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17091 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17095 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17096 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17097 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17098 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
17099 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
17102 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
17103 .cindex "load average"
17104 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
17105 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
17106 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
17107 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
17108 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
17109 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
17113 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
17114 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
17115 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
17116 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
17117 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
17119 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
17121 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
17122 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
17123 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
17124 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
17125 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
17127 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
17128 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
17129 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
17130 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
17131 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
17132 not count towards the limit.
17136 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
17137 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
17138 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
17139 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
17140 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
17143 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
17144 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
17148 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17149 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
17150 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
17151 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
17152 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
17153 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
17156 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
17157 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
17158 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
17159 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
17161 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
17162 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
17163 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
17164 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
17168 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
17170 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
17171 fractional parts are allowed here.
17173 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
17175 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
17176 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
17179 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
17180 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
17182 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
17183 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
17185 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
17186 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
17187 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
17188 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
17191 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
17192 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17195 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
17196 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
17199 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
17200 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
17201 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
17202 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
17203 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
17204 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
17205 the message is abandoned.
17206 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
17208 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
17209 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
17211 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
17212 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
17214 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
17215 expanded before use and may depend on
17216 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
17220 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
17221 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
17222 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
17223 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
17224 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
17227 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17228 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
17229 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
17232 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
17233 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
17234 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
17235 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
17236 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
17237 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
17238 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
17239 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
17240 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
17241 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
17243 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
17244 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
17248 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17249 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "advertising"
17250 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
17251 the availability thereof is advertised in
17252 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17253 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
17256 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
17257 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
17258 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
17259 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
17263 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
17264 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
17265 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
17269 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
17270 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
17271 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
17272 .cindex "directories, multiple"
17273 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
17274 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
17275 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
17276 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
17277 arrival of the message.
17279 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
17280 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
17281 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
17282 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
17283 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
17285 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
17286 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
17287 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
17288 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
17289 automatically deleted.
17291 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
17292 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
17293 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
17294 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
17295 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
17296 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
17297 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
17298 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
17299 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
17302 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
17303 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
17304 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
17305 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
17306 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
17307 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
17308 &$primary_hostname$&.
17310 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
17311 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
17312 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
17313 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
17314 as failures in the configuration file.
17316 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
17317 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
17319 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
17320 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
17321 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
17322 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
17323 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
17324 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
17327 The following variables will not have useful values:
17329 $max_received_linelength
17334 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
17335 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
17336 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
17337 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
17339 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
17340 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
17341 The transmission benefit is maintained.
17343 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
17344 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
17345 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
17346 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
17348 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
17349 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
17350 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
17351 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
17352 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
17353 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
17355 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
17356 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
17357 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
17358 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
17359 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
17360 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
17361 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
17364 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
17365 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
17366 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
17367 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
17368 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
17369 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
17370 domain causes a syntax error.
17371 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
17375 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
17376 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
17377 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
17378 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
17379 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
17380 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
17381 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
17382 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
17383 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
17384 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
17385 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
17386 the LOG_ALERT priority.
17389 .option syslog_facility main string unset
17390 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
17391 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17392 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
17393 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
17394 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17395 details of Exim's logging.
17398 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
17399 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
17400 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
17401 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
17402 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
17403 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
17404 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17408 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
17409 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
17410 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
17411 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
17412 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
17416 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
17417 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
17418 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
17419 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
17420 details of Exim's logging.
17423 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
17424 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
17425 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
17426 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
17427 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
17428 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
17429 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
17430 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
17431 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
17432 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
17433 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
17434 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
17437 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
17438 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
17439 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
17440 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
17441 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
17442 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17445 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
17446 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
17447 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
17448 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
17449 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
17451 .option system_filter_group main string unset
17452 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
17453 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
17454 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
17455 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
17457 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
17458 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
17459 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
17460 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
17461 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
17462 contains the pipe command.
17465 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
17466 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
17467 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
17468 is used in a system filter.
17471 .option system_filter_user main string unset
17472 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
17473 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
17474 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
17475 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
17476 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
17477 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
17478 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
17479 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
17480 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
17482 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
17483 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
17484 transport option overrides.
17487 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
17488 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
17489 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
17490 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
17491 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
17492 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
17493 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
17494 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
17495 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
17496 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
17497 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
17498 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
17502 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
17503 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
17504 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
17505 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
17506 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
17507 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
17508 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
17509 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
17510 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
17511 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
17513 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
17514 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
17515 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
17518 .option timezone main string unset
17519 .cindex "timezone, setting"
17520 .cindex "environment" "values from"
17521 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
17522 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
17523 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
17524 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
17528 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
17529 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
17530 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
17531 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
17532 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
17533 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
17536 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17537 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
17538 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
17539 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
17540 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
17541 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
17542 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
17543 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
17544 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
17545 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
17546 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
17549 .option tls_certificate main string list&!! unset
17550 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
17551 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
17552 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17553 files which contains the server's certificates. Commonly only one file is
17555 The server's private key is also
17556 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
17557 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17559 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
17560 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
17561 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
17562 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
17564 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
17565 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) >to avoid confusion under IPv6.
17567 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
17568 when a list of more than one
17569 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
17571 &*Note*&: OCSP stapling is not usable under OpenSSL
17572 when a list of more than one file is used.
17574 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
17575 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
17576 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
17577 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
17579 If this option is unset or empty a fresh self-signed certificate will be
17580 generated for every connection.
17582 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
17583 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
17584 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
17585 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
17586 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
17588 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
17590 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
17591 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
17592 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
17594 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17597 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
17598 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
17599 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
17600 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
17601 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
17602 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
17604 The value must be at least 1024.
17606 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
17607 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
17608 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
17610 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
17613 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
17614 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
17615 larger prime than requested.
17618 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
17619 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
17620 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
17621 to be used by Exim.
17623 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
17624 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
17625 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
17626 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
17628 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
17629 then it names a file from which DH
17630 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
17631 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
17632 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
17633 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
17634 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
17635 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
17637 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
17640 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
17641 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
17642 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
17643 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
17645 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
17646 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
17648 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
17649 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
17650 in IKE is assigned number 23.
17652 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
17653 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
17654 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
17655 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
17656 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17658 The available standard primes are:
17659 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
17660 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
17661 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
17662 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
17664 The available additional primes are:
17665 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
17667 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
17668 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
17669 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
17670 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
17671 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
17673 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
17674 they're still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
17675 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
17677 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
17678 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
17679 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
17680 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
17681 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
17684 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
17685 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
17686 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
17687 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
17688 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
17689 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
17690 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
17693 .option tls_eccurve main string&!! &`auto`&
17694 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
17695 This option selects a EC curve for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
17696 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS.
17698 After expansion it must contain a valid EC curve parameter, such as
17699 &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-512`&. Consult your OpenSSL manual
17700 for valid selections.
17702 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
17703 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
17704 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
17706 If the option expands to an empty string, no EC curves will be enabled.
17709 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
17710 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
17711 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
17713 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
17714 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
17715 Certificate Authority.
17717 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
17719 For GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
17720 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
17721 The ordering of the two lists must match.
17724 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
17727 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
17728 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
17729 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
17730 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
17734 .option tls_privatekey main string list&!! unset
17735 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
17736 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
17737 files which contains the server's private keys.
17738 If this option is unset, or if
17739 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
17740 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
17741 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
17743 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17746 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
17747 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
17748 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
17749 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
17750 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
17751 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
17755 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
17756 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
17757 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
17758 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
17759 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
17760 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
17761 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
17762 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
17763 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
17764 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
17765 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
17768 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17769 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17770 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17771 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
17774 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
17775 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17776 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17777 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
17779 or the absolute path to
17780 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
17781 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
17783 The "system" value for the option will use a
17784 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
17785 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
17786 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
17789 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
17790 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
17792 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
17794 either by file or directory
17795 are added to those given by the system default location.
17797 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
17798 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
17799 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
17800 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
17801 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
17802 use the explicit directory version.
17804 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
17806 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
17810 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17811 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
17812 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
17813 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
17814 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
17815 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
17816 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
17817 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
17819 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
17820 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
17821 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
17822 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
17823 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
17824 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
17825 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
17827 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
17828 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
17829 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
17830 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
17831 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
17832 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
17833 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
17836 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
17840 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
17841 .cindex "trusted groups"
17842 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
17843 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17844 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
17845 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
17846 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
17847 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
17848 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
17851 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
17852 .cindex "trusted users"
17853 .cindex "user" "trusted"
17854 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
17855 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
17856 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
17857 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
17858 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
17859 Exim user are trusted.
17861 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
17862 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
17863 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
17864 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
17865 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
17866 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
17867 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
17868 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
17869 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
17872 .option unknown_username main string unset
17873 See &%unknown_login%&.
17875 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
17876 .cindex "trusted users"
17877 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
17878 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
17879 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
17880 .cindex "envelope sender"
17881 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
17882 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
17883 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
17884 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
17885 is used) is ignored.
17887 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
17888 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
17890 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
17892 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
17893 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
17894 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
17895 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
17896 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
17897 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
17898 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
17899 followed by a hyphen
17900 by a setting like this:
17902 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
17904 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
17905 restriction, you can use
17907 untrusted_set_sender = *
17909 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
17910 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
17911 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
17912 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
17913 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
17914 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
17915 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
17916 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
17918 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
17919 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
17920 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
17921 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
17925 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
17926 .cindex "&""From""& line"
17927 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
17928 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
17929 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
17930 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
17931 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
17932 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
17933 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
17934 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
17936 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
17937 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
17939 The pattern can be seen by running
17941 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
17943 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
17944 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
17945 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
17946 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
17947 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
17948 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
17951 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
17952 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
17955 .option warn_message_file main string unset
17956 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
17957 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
17958 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
17959 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
17960 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
17961 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
17962 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
17965 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
17966 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
17967 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
17968 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
17969 .ecindex IIDconfima
17970 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
17975 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17976 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17978 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
17979 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
17980 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
17981 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
17982 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
17984 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
17985 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
17986 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
17987 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
17988 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
17992 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
17993 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
17994 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
17995 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
17996 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
17997 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
17998 delivery of the address to be deferred.
18000 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18001 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
18002 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
18003 routers, and the eventual transport.
18005 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
18006 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
18007 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
18008 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
18009 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
18011 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
18012 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
18013 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
18014 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
18015 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
18017 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
18018 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
18019 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
18021 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
18023 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
18025 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
18027 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
18028 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
18030 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
18031 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18032 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
18033 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
18034 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
18035 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
18036 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
18040 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
18042 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
18043 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
18044 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
18045 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
18046 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
18051 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
18052 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
18053 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
18054 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
18055 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
18056 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
18057 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
18058 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
18059 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
18060 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
18063 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
18065 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
18068 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
18070 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
18071 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
18072 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
18073 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
18076 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
18077 .cindex "case of local parts"
18078 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
18079 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
18080 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
18081 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
18082 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
18083 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
18084 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
18087 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18088 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
18089 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
18090 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
18091 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
18092 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
18093 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
18094 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
18095 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
18097 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
18098 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
18099 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
18100 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
18104 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
18105 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
18106 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
18107 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
18109 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
18110 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
18111 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
18112 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
18113 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
18114 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
18115 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
18116 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
18117 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
18118 the router is skipped.
18120 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
18121 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
18122 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
18123 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
18124 setting to achieve this. For example:
18126 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
18128 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
18129 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
18130 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
18134 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
18135 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
18136 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
18137 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
18138 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
18139 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
18140 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
18141 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
18143 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
18144 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
18146 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
18147 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
18149 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
18150 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
18151 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
18153 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18155 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
18157 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
18160 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
18162 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
18163 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
18167 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
18168 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
18169 be specified using &%condition%&.
18171 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
18172 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
18173 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
18174 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18175 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
18176 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
18177 Router rules processing behavior.
18179 This is best illustrated in an example:
18181 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
18182 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
18184 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18187 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
18190 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
18191 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
18192 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
18193 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
18194 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
18195 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
18196 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
18197 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
18199 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
18200 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
18201 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
18202 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
18205 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
18206 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
18207 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
18208 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
18209 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
18212 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
18213 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18214 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18215 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
18216 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
18217 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18218 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18219 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18220 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
18221 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
18222 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
18223 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
18224 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
18225 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
18229 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
18230 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
18231 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
18232 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
18233 transport option of the same name.
18235 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18236 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18237 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18238 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18239 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18240 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
18241 the dnssec request bit set.
18242 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18244 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
18245 .cindex "MX record" "security"
18246 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
18247 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
18248 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
18249 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
18250 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
18251 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
18252 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
18255 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
18256 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
18257 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
18258 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
18259 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
18260 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
18261 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
18262 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
18266 .option driver routers string unset
18267 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
18271 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
18272 .cindex "DSN" "success"
18273 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
18274 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
18275 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
18276 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
18277 Not effective on redirect routers.
18281 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
18282 .cindex "envelope sender"
18283 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
18284 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
18285 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
18286 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
18287 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
18288 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
18289 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
18291 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
18292 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
18293 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
18296 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
18297 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
18298 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
18299 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
18301 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
18302 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
18303 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
18304 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
18310 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
18311 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
18312 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
18313 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
18314 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
18316 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
18317 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
18318 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
18319 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
18320 setting &%return_path%&.
18322 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
18323 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
18324 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
18328 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
18329 .cindex "address" "testing"
18330 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
18331 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
18332 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
18333 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
18334 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
18335 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
18336 on for the system alias file.
18337 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18340 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
18341 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
18342 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
18346 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
18347 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
18348 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
18349 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
18353 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
18354 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18355 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
18359 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
18360 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
18361 verifying a sender, verification fails.
18365 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
18366 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
18367 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
18368 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
18369 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
18370 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
18371 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
18372 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
18373 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
18375 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
18376 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
18377 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
18378 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
18379 transport for further details.
18382 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
18383 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
18384 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18385 .cindex "transport" "local"
18386 .cindex "router" "setting group"
18387 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
18388 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
18390 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
18391 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
18392 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
18393 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
18394 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18398 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
18399 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
18400 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
18401 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18402 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18403 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18404 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18405 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18406 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
18407 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
18408 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
18409 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
18410 &"see"& the added header lines.
18412 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
18413 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
18414 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
18415 failures are treated as configuration errors.
18417 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
18418 for a router; all listed headers are added.
18420 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18421 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18423 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
18424 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
18425 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18426 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
18427 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
18428 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
18429 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
18430 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
18431 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
18432 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
18436 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
18437 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18438 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
18439 This option specifies a list of text headers,
18440 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
18441 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
18442 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
18443 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
18444 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
18445 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
18446 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
18447 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
18448 &"see"& the original header lines.
18450 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
18451 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
18452 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
18455 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
18456 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
18458 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
18459 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
18461 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
18462 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
18463 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
18464 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
18466 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
18467 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
18468 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18472 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
18473 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
18474 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
18475 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
18476 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
18477 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
18478 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
18481 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
18485 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
18487 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
18488 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
18489 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
18490 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
18491 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
18492 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
18494 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
18495 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
18497 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
18498 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
18500 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
18501 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
18503 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
18504 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
18505 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
18506 domain that is being routed.
18508 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18509 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
18512 .option initgroups routers boolean false
18513 .cindex "additional groups"
18514 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18515 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18516 .cindex "transport" "local"
18517 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
18518 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
18519 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
18520 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
18521 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
18525 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
18526 .cindex affix "router precondition"
18527 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
18528 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
18529 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
18530 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
18531 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
18534 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
18535 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
18536 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
18537 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
18538 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
18539 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
18540 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
18541 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
18542 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
18544 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18545 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
18546 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
18547 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
18548 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
18549 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
18550 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
18551 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
18552 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
18553 the relevant transport.
18555 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
18556 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
18557 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
18560 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
18561 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
18562 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
18563 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
18564 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
18568 local_part_prefix = real-
18570 transport = local_delivery
18572 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18573 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18575 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18576 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18579 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
18580 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
18581 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
18582 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
18585 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
18586 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
18590 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
18591 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
18592 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
18593 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
18594 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
18595 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
18596 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
18597 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
18598 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
18602 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
18603 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
18607 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
18608 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
18609 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
18610 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
18611 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18613 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
18614 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
18617 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
18619 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
18620 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
18621 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
18622 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
18623 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
18624 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
18625 each virtual domain:
18629 local_parts = postmaster
18630 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
18634 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
18635 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
18636 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
18637 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
18638 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
18639 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
18640 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
18641 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
18642 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
18643 redirect addresses.
18647 .option more routers boolean&!! true
18648 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
18649 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
18650 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
18651 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
18652 delivery to be deferred.
18654 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
18655 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
18657 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
18658 means of the setting
18662 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
18663 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
18664 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
18666 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
18667 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
18668 controls what happens next.
18671 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
18672 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
18673 .cindex "router" "timeout"
18674 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
18675 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
18676 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
18677 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
18678 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
18680 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
18681 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
18682 applies to all of them.
18686 .option pass_router routers string unset
18687 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
18688 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
18689 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
18690 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
18691 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
18692 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
18693 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
18694 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
18695 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
18696 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
18700 .option redirect_router routers string unset
18701 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
18702 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
18703 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
18704 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
18705 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
18707 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
18708 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
18709 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
18710 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
18714 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
18715 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
18716 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
18717 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
18718 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
18719 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
18720 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
18722 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
18723 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
18724 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
18725 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
18726 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
18728 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
18729 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
18730 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
18731 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
18732 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
18735 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
18736 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
18739 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
18740 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
18741 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
18742 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
18743 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
18744 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
18745 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
18746 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
18748 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
18749 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
18750 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
18751 operates as follows:
18753 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
18754 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
18755 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
18756 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
18759 require_files = mail:/some/file
18760 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
18762 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
18763 &%require_files%& condition fails.
18765 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
18766 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
18767 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
18768 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
18770 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
18771 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
18772 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
18773 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
18774 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
18776 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
18777 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
18778 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
18779 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
18780 check again in that process.
18782 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
18783 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
18784 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
18785 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
18786 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
18787 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
18788 as if the file did not exist. For example:
18790 require_files = +/some/file
18792 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
18793 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
18794 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
18798 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
18799 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18800 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
18801 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
18802 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
18803 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
18804 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
18805 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
18808 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
18809 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
18810 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
18811 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
18812 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
18815 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
18816 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
18817 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
18821 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
18822 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
18823 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
18825 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
18826 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
18827 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
18828 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
18829 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
18830 cause the router to defer.
18832 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
18833 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
18835 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18837 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
18838 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
18840 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
18841 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
18842 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
18843 of these values that is set:
18846 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18848 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18850 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18852 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18855 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
18856 router, but not for the transport.
18860 .option self routers string freeze
18861 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
18862 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
18863 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
18864 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
18865 and &(manualroute)& routers.
18866 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
18868 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
18869 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
18870 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
18871 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
18872 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
18874 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
18875 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
18876 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
18877 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
18878 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
18883 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
18885 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
18886 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
18887 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
18888 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
18890 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
18891 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
18892 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
18897 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
18898 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
18899 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
18900 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
18901 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
18902 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
18908 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
18909 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
18910 be passed to the next router.
18913 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
18916 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
18917 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
18918 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
18919 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
18920 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
18921 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
18926 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
18927 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
18928 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
18929 address matches something on the list.
18930 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
18933 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
18934 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
18935 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
18936 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
18937 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
18938 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
18939 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
18943 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
18944 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
18945 .cindex "packet radio"
18946 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
18947 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
18948 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
18949 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
18950 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
18951 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
18952 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
18953 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
18955 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
18956 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
18957 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
18958 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
18959 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
18960 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
18961 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
18962 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
18963 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
18964 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
18966 translate_ip_address = \
18967 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
18970 The file would contain lines like
18972 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
18973 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
18975 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
18980 .option transport routers string&!! unset
18981 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
18982 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
18983 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
18984 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
18985 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
18986 delivery is deferred.
18988 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
18989 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
18990 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
18994 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
18995 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18996 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
18997 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
18998 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
18999 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
19000 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
19001 overridden by a setting on the transport.
19002 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19003 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19004 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
19010 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
19011 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
19012 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
19013 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
19014 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
19015 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
19016 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
19017 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
19018 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
19019 logged, and delivery is deferred.
19021 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
19022 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
19023 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
19024 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
19025 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
19027 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
19033 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
19034 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
19035 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19036 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19037 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19038 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
19039 delivery to be deferred.
19041 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
19042 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
19043 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
19044 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
19045 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
19046 sometimes true and sometimes false).
19048 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
19049 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
19050 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
19051 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
19052 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
19053 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
19054 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
19055 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
19057 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
19058 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
19059 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
19060 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
19061 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
19062 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
19063 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
19064 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
19065 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
19066 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19068 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
19069 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
19070 subsequent routers.
19073 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
19074 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19075 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19076 .cindex "transport" "local"
19077 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
19078 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
19079 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19080 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
19081 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19082 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19083 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
19084 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
19085 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
19086 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
19087 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
19088 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19092 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
19093 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
19094 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19097 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
19098 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
19100 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
19101 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
19102 delivering in cutthrough mode or
19103 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
19104 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
19105 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
19106 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
19108 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
19109 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
19110 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
19114 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
19115 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
19117 delivering in cutthrough mode
19118 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
19119 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19121 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19124 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
19125 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
19126 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
19127 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19129 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
19130 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
19131 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
19138 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19139 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19141 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
19142 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
19143 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
19144 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
19145 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
19146 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
19147 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
19148 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
19149 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
19153 domains = mydomain.example
19155 transport = local_delivery
19157 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
19158 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
19159 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
19160 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
19167 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19168 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19170 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
19171 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
19172 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
19173 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
19174 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
19175 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
19177 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
19178 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
19179 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
19180 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
19183 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
19184 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
19185 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
19186 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
19187 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19188 generic option, the router declines.
19190 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
19191 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
19192 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
19194 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19195 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19196 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
19197 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
19198 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
19199 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
19202 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
19203 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
19204 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
19205 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
19206 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
19207 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
19209 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
19210 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
19211 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
19212 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
19213 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
19214 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
19215 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
19216 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
19217 case routing fails.
19220 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
19221 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
19222 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
19223 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
19224 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
19226 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
19227 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
19229 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
19231 The domain does not exist in DNS
19233 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
19234 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
19235 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
19237 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
19239 MX record points to a non-existent host.
19241 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
19242 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
19244 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
19245 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
19247 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
19248 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
19250 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
19251 not be found in the MX records (see below)
19257 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
19258 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
19259 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
19261 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
19262 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
19263 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
19264 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
19265 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
19266 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
19267 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19270 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
19271 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
19272 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
19273 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
19274 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
19275 required. For example,
19279 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
19280 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
19281 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
19282 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
19283 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
19286 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
19287 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
19288 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
19289 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
19290 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
19291 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
19293 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
19294 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
19295 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
19296 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
19297 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
19298 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
19299 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
19300 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
19302 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
19303 when there is a DNS lookup error.
19308 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19309 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
19310 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
19311 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
19312 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
19313 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
19314 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
19315 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
19319 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
19320 .cindex IPv6 disabling
19321 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
19322 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19323 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19324 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19325 only A records are used.
19327 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
19328 .cindex IPv4 preference
19329 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
19330 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
19331 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
19332 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
19333 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
19335 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19336 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
19337 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
19338 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
19339 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
19340 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
19341 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
19344 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
19346 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
19347 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
19348 the address record.
19351 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19352 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19353 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
19354 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19359 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
19360 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19361 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
19362 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
19363 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
19364 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
19365 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
19366 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
19367 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
19372 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
19373 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
19374 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
19375 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
19376 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
19377 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
19378 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
19379 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
19380 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
19381 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
19382 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
19384 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
19385 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
19388 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
19389 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
19390 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
19391 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
19392 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
19396 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
19397 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19398 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
19399 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
19400 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19401 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19402 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19403 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19405 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19406 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
19407 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19408 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
19409 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
19410 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
19411 without processing them independently,
19412 provided the following conditions are met:
19415 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
19416 &%headers_remove%&.
19418 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
19425 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
19426 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
19427 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
19428 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
19429 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
19430 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
19431 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
19432 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
19433 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
19434 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
19436 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
19437 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
19442 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
19443 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
19444 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
19445 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
19450 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
19451 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
19452 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
19453 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
19456 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
19458 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
19459 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
19460 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
19461 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
19462 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
19463 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
19466 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
19467 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
19468 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
19469 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
19470 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
19472 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
19473 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
19474 such as that implied by
19478 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
19479 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
19480 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
19481 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
19491 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19492 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19494 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
19495 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
19496 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
19497 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
19498 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
19499 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
19500 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
19501 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
19502 router handles the address
19506 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
19507 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
19508 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
19510 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
19512 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
19513 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
19515 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
19516 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
19517 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
19518 &%self%& option determines what happens.
19520 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
19521 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
19522 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
19523 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
19527 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19528 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19530 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
19531 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
19532 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
19533 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
19534 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
19535 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
19538 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
19540 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
19542 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
19543 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
19544 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
19545 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
19546 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
19547 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
19548 must not be specified for it.
19550 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
19551 .option hosts iplookup string unset
19552 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
19553 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
19554 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
19555 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
19556 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
19559 .option optional iplookup boolean false
19560 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
19561 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
19562 delivery to the address is deferred.
19565 .option port iplookup integer 0
19566 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
19567 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
19571 .option protocol iplookup string udp
19572 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
19573 protocols is to be used.
19576 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
19577 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
19580 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
19582 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
19583 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
19586 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
19587 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
19588 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
19589 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
19590 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
19591 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
19592 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
19593 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
19596 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
19597 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
19598 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
19599 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
19600 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
19601 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
19602 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
19603 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
19604 following could be used:
19606 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
19607 reroute = $local_part@$1
19610 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
19611 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
19612 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
19613 call. It does not apply to UDP.
19618 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19619 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19621 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
19622 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
19623 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
19624 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
19625 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
19626 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
19627 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
19628 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
19629 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
19630 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
19632 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
19633 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
19634 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
19635 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
19636 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
19637 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
19638 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
19641 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
19642 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
19643 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
19644 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
19645 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
19646 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
19647 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
19650 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
19651 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
19652 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
19653 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
19654 below, following the list of private options.
19657 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
19659 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
19660 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
19662 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
19663 See &%host_find_failed%&.
19665 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
19666 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
19667 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
19668 of the following values:
19677 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
19678 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
19679 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
19682 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
19683 router only if &%more%& is true.
19685 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
19686 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
19687 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
19688 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
19690 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
19691 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
19692 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
19695 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
19696 .cindex "randomized host list"
19697 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
19698 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
19699 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
19700 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
19701 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
19702 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
19703 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
19704 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
19706 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
19707 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
19708 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
19709 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
19711 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
19713 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
19714 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
19715 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
19716 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
19717 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
19720 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
19721 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
19722 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
19725 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
19727 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
19728 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
19732 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
19733 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
19734 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
19735 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
19738 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
19739 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
19740 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
19741 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
19742 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
19743 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
19744 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
19745 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
19747 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
19748 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
19749 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
19750 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
19751 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
19752 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
19753 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
19754 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
19759 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
19760 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
19761 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
19762 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
19763 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
19764 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
19766 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
19768 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
19772 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
19773 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19775 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
19776 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
19777 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
19778 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
19779 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
19780 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
19781 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
19782 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
19783 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
19784 in a &%route_list%&).
19786 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
19787 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
19788 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
19789 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
19793 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
19794 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
19795 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
19796 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
19797 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
19798 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
19799 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
19802 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
19803 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
19805 This data can be accessed by setting
19807 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
19809 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
19810 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
19811 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
19812 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
19813 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
19818 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
19819 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
19820 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
19821 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
19822 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
19823 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
19824 The format of each item
19825 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
19826 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
19828 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
19829 variables are set during its expansion:
19832 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19833 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
19834 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
19836 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
19839 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
19841 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
19844 .vindex "&$value$&"
19845 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
19846 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
19848 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
19852 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
19853 semicolon is the default route list separator.
19857 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
19858 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
19859 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
19860 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
19861 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
19862 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
19865 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
19866 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
19867 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
19869 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
19870 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
19873 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
19874 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
19875 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
19876 number follows. For example:
19878 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
19882 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
19883 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
19884 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
19885 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
19886 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
19889 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
19890 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
19891 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
19892 records in the DNS. For example:
19894 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
19896 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
19899 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
19901 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
19902 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
19903 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
19904 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
19905 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
19906 happens is controlled by the
19907 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
19908 &%self%& option of the router.
19910 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
19911 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
19912 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
19913 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
19914 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
19915 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
19916 defined by MX preferences.
19918 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
19919 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
19920 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
19922 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
19923 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
19924 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
19925 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
19927 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
19928 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
19931 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
19932 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
19933 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
19935 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
19936 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
19940 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
19941 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
19942 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
19943 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
19944 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
19945 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
19946 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
19949 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
19950 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19952 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
19953 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
19955 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
19956 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
19957 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
19959 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
19960 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
19961 timeout), delivery is deferred.
19963 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
19965 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
19970 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
19971 domain2 host4:host5
19973 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
19974 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
19975 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
19976 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
19979 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
19980 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
19981 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
19982 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
19985 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
19986 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
19991 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
19992 &%host_find_failed%& option.
19995 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
19996 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
20000 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
20001 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
20002 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
20005 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
20006 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
20007 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
20008 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
20010 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
20012 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
20013 your first router something like this:
20016 driver = manualroute
20017 domains = !+local_domains
20018 transport = remote_smtp
20019 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
20021 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
20022 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
20023 they are tried in order
20024 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
20025 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
20028 driver = manualroute
20029 transport = remote_smtp
20030 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
20032 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
20033 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
20034 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
20035 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
20036 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
20037 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
20038 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
20039 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
20042 .cindex "mail hub example"
20043 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
20044 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
20045 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
20046 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
20047 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
20048 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
20049 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
20050 lookup is easier to manage.
20052 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
20053 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
20057 driver = manualroute
20058 transport = remote_smtp
20059 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
20061 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
20062 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
20063 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
20064 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
20065 domain can be used to find the host:
20068 driver = manualroute
20069 transport = remote_smtp
20070 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
20072 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
20073 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
20074 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
20078 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
20079 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
20080 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
20081 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
20082 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
20083 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
20086 driver = manualroute
20087 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
20088 route_list = saved.domain.example
20090 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
20091 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
20092 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
20095 driver = manualroute
20097 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
20098 *.saved.domain2.example \
20099 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
20102 .vindex "&$domain$&"
20104 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
20105 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
20106 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
20107 the address if the lookup fails.
20110 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
20111 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
20112 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
20113 one way it can be done:
20119 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
20120 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
20121 return_fail_output = true
20126 driver = manualroute
20128 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
20130 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
20132 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
20134 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
20135 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
20136 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
20138 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
20139 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
20148 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20149 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20151 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
20152 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
20153 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
20154 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
20155 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
20156 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
20157 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
20158 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
20159 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
20160 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
20162 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
20164 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
20165 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
20166 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
20167 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
20168 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
20171 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
20172 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
20173 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
20174 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
20175 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
20176 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
20179 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
20180 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
20181 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
20182 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
20183 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
20184 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
20185 not set, a value for the gid also.
20187 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
20188 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
20189 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
20190 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
20191 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
20192 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
20196 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
20197 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
20198 before running the command.
20201 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
20202 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
20203 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
20207 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
20208 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
20209 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
20210 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
20211 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
20214 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
20217 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
20218 &%no_more%& is set.
20220 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
20221 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
20222 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
20223 included in the SMTP response.
20225 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
20226 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
20227 included in any SMTP response.
20229 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
20231 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
20232 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
20234 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
20235 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
20236 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
20239 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
20240 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
20243 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
20244 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
20246 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
20247 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
20248 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
20249 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
20251 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
20252 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
20253 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
20254 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
20255 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
20257 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
20258 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
20259 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
20260 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
20261 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
20263 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
20264 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
20265 variable. For example, this return line
20267 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
20269 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
20270 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
20271 .ecindex IIDquerou1
20272 .ecindex IIDquerou2
20277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20278 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20280 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
20281 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
20282 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
20283 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
20284 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
20285 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
20286 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
20287 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
20288 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
20289 redirected in several different ways:
20292 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
20295 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
20297 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
20299 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
20301 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
20303 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
20305 It can be discarded.
20308 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
20309 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
20310 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
20311 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
20313 If success DSNs have been requested
20314 .cindex "DSN" "success"
20315 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
20316 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
20320 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
20321 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
20322 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
20323 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
20324 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
20325 aliases, in a configuration like this:
20329 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
20331 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
20332 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
20333 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
20334 cause delivery to be deferred.
20336 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
20337 &_.forward_& files, like this:
20342 file = $home/.forward
20345 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
20346 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
20347 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
20348 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
20353 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
20354 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
20355 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
20356 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
20359 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
20360 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
20361 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
20362 practice the router may not be able to operate.
20364 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
20365 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
20366 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
20367 saves some resources.
20375 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
20376 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20377 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
20378 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
20379 can be interpreted in two different ways:
20382 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
20383 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
20384 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
20385 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
20386 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
20387 document is intended for use by end users.
20389 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
20390 described in the next section.
20393 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
20394 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
20395 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
20396 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
20397 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
20401 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
20402 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
20403 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
20404 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
20405 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
20406 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
20407 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
20408 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
20409 commas or newlines.
20410 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
20413 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
20414 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
20415 next newline character is ignored.
20417 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
20418 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
20419 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
20420 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
20423 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20424 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
20425 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
20426 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
20427 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
20428 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
20431 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
20435 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
20436 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
20437 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
20438 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
20439 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
20440 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
20441 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
20442 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
20443 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
20444 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
20445 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
20447 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
20448 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
20449 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
20450 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
20451 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
20453 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
20455 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
20456 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
20457 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
20458 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
20459 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
20462 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
20463 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
20464 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
20465 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
20466 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
20468 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
20469 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
20474 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
20475 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
20478 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20480 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
20481 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
20482 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
20483 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
20484 should really contain
20486 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
20488 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
20489 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
20490 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
20494 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
20495 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
20496 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
20499 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
20500 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
20501 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
20502 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
20503 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
20504 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20505 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20507 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
20508 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
20509 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
20510 in double quotes, for example:
20512 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
20514 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
20515 quote just the command. An item such as
20517 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
20519 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
20521 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
20522 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
20523 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
20524 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
20525 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
20526 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
20527 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
20528 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
20529 an &%accept%& router.
20532 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
20533 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
20534 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
20535 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
20537 /home/world/minbari
20539 is treated as a filename, but
20541 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
20543 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
20544 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
20545 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
20546 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
20548 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
20549 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
20551 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
20552 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
20553 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
20554 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
20557 .cindex "included address list"
20558 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
20559 If an item is of the form
20561 :include:<path name>
20563 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
20564 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
20565 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
20566 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
20567 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
20568 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
20570 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
20572 It must be given as
20574 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
20577 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
20578 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
20579 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
20580 .cindex "black hole"
20581 .cindex "abandoning mail"
20582 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
20583 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
20584 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
20588 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
20589 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
20590 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
20592 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
20593 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
20594 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
20595 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
20599 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
20600 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
20601 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
20602 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
20603 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
20604 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
20605 redirection items of the form
20610 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
20611 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
20612 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
20613 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
20615 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
20617 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
20619 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
20620 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
20622 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
20623 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
20624 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
20626 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20627 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
20628 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
20629 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
20630 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
20631 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
20632 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
20633 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
20634 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
20637 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
20638 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
20639 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
20640 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
20642 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
20643 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
20644 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
20645 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
20646 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
20648 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
20649 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
20650 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
20651 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
20652 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
20656 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
20657 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
20658 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
20659 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
20660 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
20661 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
20662 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
20666 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
20667 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
20668 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
20669 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
20670 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
20671 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
20672 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
20673 aliasing scheme of the type
20675 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
20679 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
20680 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
20681 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
20684 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
20685 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
20687 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
20688 the pipes are distinct.
20692 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
20693 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
20694 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
20695 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
20696 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
20697 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
20698 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
20699 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
20700 can be used to avoid this.
20703 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
20704 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
20705 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
20706 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
20707 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
20708 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
20709 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
20713 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
20715 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
20716 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
20719 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
20720 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
20721 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
20724 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
20725 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
20726 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
20727 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
20730 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
20731 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
20732 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
20733 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
20734 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
20735 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
20736 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
20738 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
20739 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
20742 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
20743 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
20744 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
20745 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
20746 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
20750 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
20751 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
20752 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
20753 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
20754 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
20755 let ordinary users do.
20759 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
20760 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
20761 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
20762 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
20763 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
20764 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
20766 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
20767 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
20768 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
20769 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
20770 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
20771 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
20773 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
20775 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
20776 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
20777 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
20778 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
20779 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
20780 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
20781 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
20782 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
20785 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
20786 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
20787 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
20788 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
20789 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
20790 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
20791 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
20792 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
20796 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
20797 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
20798 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
20799 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
20800 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
20801 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
20804 .option data redirect string&!! unset
20805 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
20806 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
20807 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
20808 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
20809 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
20811 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
20812 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
20813 terminated with newline characters. For example:
20815 data = #Exim filter\n\
20816 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
20818 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
20819 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
20820 choice into a newline.
20823 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
20824 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
20825 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20826 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20827 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
20830 .option file redirect string&!! unset
20831 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
20832 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
20833 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
20834 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
20835 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
20836 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
20837 entirely of comments), the router declines.
20839 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
20840 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
20841 runs a check on the containing directory,
20842 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
20843 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
20844 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
20845 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
20846 not, the router declines.
20849 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
20850 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
20851 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
20852 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
20853 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
20854 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
20855 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
20858 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
20859 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
20860 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
20861 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
20862 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
20865 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
20866 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20867 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20868 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
20872 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
20873 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20874 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20875 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
20876 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20881 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
20882 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20883 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
20884 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20885 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
20886 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
20887 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
20888 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
20889 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
20890 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
20891 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
20894 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
20895 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20896 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20897 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20898 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
20901 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
20902 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20903 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20904 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
20905 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
20906 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
20908 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
20909 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20910 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20911 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
20912 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
20913 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
20914 &_.forward_& files).
20917 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
20918 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20919 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20920 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20921 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
20924 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
20925 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20926 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20927 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
20928 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
20929 of the embedded Perl support.
20932 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
20933 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20934 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20935 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20936 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
20939 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
20940 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20941 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20942 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20943 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
20946 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
20947 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20948 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20949 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
20950 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
20951 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
20952 &%one_time%& is set.
20955 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
20956 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20957 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20958 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
20959 to make use of &%run%& items.
20962 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
20963 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20964 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20965 If this option is true, items of the form
20967 :include:<path name>
20969 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
20972 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
20973 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20974 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20975 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
20976 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
20977 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
20978 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
20981 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
20982 .cindex "restricting access to features"
20983 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
20984 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
20985 &%allow_filter%& is true.
20988 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
20989 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
20990 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
20991 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
20992 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
20997 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
20998 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
20999 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
21000 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
21001 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
21002 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
21003 bounce may well quote the generated address.
21006 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
21008 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21009 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
21010 file did not exist.
21013 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
21015 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
21016 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
21017 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
21019 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
21020 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
21021 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
21022 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
21023 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
21024 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
21025 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
21026 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
21030 .option include_directory redirect string unset
21031 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
21032 redirection list must start with this directory.
21035 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
21036 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
21037 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
21040 .option one_time redirect boolean false
21041 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
21042 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
21043 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
21044 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
21045 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
21046 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
21047 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
21048 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
21049 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
21050 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
21051 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
21052 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
21053 before they subscribed.
21055 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
21056 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
21057 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
21058 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
21061 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
21062 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
21063 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
21064 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
21066 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
21067 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
21068 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
21070 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
21073 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
21074 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
21075 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
21076 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
21077 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
21081 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
21082 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
21083 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
21084 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
21085 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
21086 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
21087 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
21088 See &%check_owner%& above.
21091 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
21092 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
21093 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
21094 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
21097 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
21098 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
21099 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
21100 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
21101 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
21102 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
21103 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
21106 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
21107 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
21108 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
21109 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
21110 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
21111 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
21112 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
21113 &$qualify_recipient$&.
21115 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
21116 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
21117 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
21120 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
21121 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
21122 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
21123 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
21124 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
21125 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
21126 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
21127 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
21128 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
21129 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
21132 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
21133 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
21134 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
21135 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
21136 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
21137 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
21140 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
21141 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
21142 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
21143 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
21144 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
21145 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
21148 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
21149 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
21150 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
21151 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
21152 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
21155 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
21156 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
21157 :subaddress part of an address.
21159 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
21160 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
21161 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
21162 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
21165 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
21166 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
21167 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
21168 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
21169 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
21170 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
21171 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
21175 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
21176 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
21177 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
21178 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
21179 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
21180 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
21181 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
21182 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
21183 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
21184 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
21185 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
21186 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
21187 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
21188 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
21189 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
21190 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
21192 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
21193 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
21194 the following routers.
21196 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
21197 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
21198 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
21199 so it is passed to the following routers.
21201 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
21202 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
21203 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
21204 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
21206 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
21207 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
21208 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
21209 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
21215 file = $home/.forward
21216 file_transport = address_file
21217 pipe_transport = address_pipe
21218 reply_transport = address_reply
21221 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
21222 syntax_errors_text = \
21223 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
21224 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
21225 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
21226 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
21227 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
21228 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
21229 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
21230 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
21231 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
21232 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
21234 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
21235 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
21236 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
21241 local_part_prefix = real-
21242 transport = local_delivery
21244 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
21245 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
21247 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
21248 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
21252 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
21253 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21256 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
21257 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
21258 .ecindex IIDredrou1
21259 .ecindex IIDredrou2
21266 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21269 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
21270 "Environment for local transports"
21271 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
21272 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
21273 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
21274 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
21275 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
21276 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
21277 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
21279 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
21280 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
21281 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
21282 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
21284 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
21285 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
21286 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
21287 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
21288 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
21292 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
21293 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
21294 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
21295 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
21296 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
21297 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
21298 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
21301 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
21302 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
21306 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
21308 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
21309 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
21310 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
21311 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
21316 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
21317 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
21318 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
21319 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
21320 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
21321 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
21322 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
21323 group (set by the transport). For example:
21326 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
21330 transport = group_delivery
21333 # This transport overrides the group
21335 driver = appendfile
21336 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
21339 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
21340 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
21341 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
21344 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
21345 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
21346 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
21347 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
21348 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
21349 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
21351 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
21352 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
21353 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
21354 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
21355 original gid is also used.
21357 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
21358 following that is set is used:
21361 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
21363 A &%group%& setting of the router;
21365 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
21366 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
21368 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
21370 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
21371 the uid is the creator's uid;
21373 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
21376 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
21377 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
21378 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
21379 The first of the following that is set is used:
21382 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
21384 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
21386 A &%user%& setting of the router;
21388 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
21393 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
21394 &%never_users%& list.
21400 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
21401 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
21402 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
21403 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
21404 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
21405 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
21406 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
21407 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
21408 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
21409 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21412 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
21414 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
21416 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
21418 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
21421 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
21424 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
21426 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
21430 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
21431 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
21432 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
21436 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
21437 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21438 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21439 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
21440 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
21441 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
21442 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
21443 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
21444 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
21445 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
21446 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
21447 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
21448 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
21449 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
21457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21460 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
21461 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
21462 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
21463 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
21464 The following generic options apply to all transports:
21467 .option body_only transports boolean false
21468 .cindex "transport" "body only"
21469 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
21470 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
21471 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
21472 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
21473 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
21474 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
21475 automatically suppress them.
21478 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
21479 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
21480 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
21481 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
21482 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
21483 logged, and delivery is deferred.
21486 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
21487 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
21488 deliveries by the transport or for any
21489 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
21490 what you are doing.
21493 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
21494 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
21495 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
21496 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
21498 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
21499 output, and Exim carries on processing.
21500 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
21501 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
21502 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
21503 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
21505 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
21506 transport and the router that called it.
21508 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
21509 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
21510 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
21511 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
21512 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
21513 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
21514 safely be resent to other recipients.
21517 .option driver transports string unset
21518 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
21519 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
21522 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
21523 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
21524 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
21525 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
21526 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
21527 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
21528 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
21529 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
21530 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
21531 resent to other recipients.
21534 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
21536 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
21537 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
21540 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
21541 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
21542 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
21543 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
21544 &%user%& (see below).
21547 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
21548 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
21549 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
21550 This option specifies a list of text headers,
21551 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
21552 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
21553 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
21554 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
21555 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21556 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21557 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21559 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
21560 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
21563 .option headers_only transports boolean false
21564 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
21565 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
21566 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
21567 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
21568 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
21569 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
21570 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
21573 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
21574 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
21575 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
21576 This option specifies a list of header names,
21577 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
21578 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
21579 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
21581 Each list item is separately expanded.
21582 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
21583 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
21584 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
21586 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
21587 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
21589 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
21590 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
21591 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
21595 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
21596 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
21597 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
21598 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
21599 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
21600 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
21601 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
21602 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
21605 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
21608 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
21609 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
21610 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
21611 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
21612 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
21613 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
21614 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
21615 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
21616 change envelope recipients at this time.
21619 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
21620 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
21622 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
21623 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
21624 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
21625 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
21626 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
21627 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
21628 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
21632 .option initgroups transports boolean false
21633 .cindex "additional groups"
21634 .cindex "groups" "additional"
21635 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
21636 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
21637 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
21638 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
21641 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
21642 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
21643 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
21644 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
21645 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
21646 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
21647 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
21648 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
21650 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
21651 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
21652 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
21653 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
21654 Obviously there is scope for
21655 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21656 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21658 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
21659 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21660 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21661 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21662 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
21665 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
21666 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
21667 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
21668 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
21669 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
21670 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
21671 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
21672 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
21673 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
21674 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
21675 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
21676 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
21677 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
21682 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
21683 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
21684 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
21685 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
21686 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
21687 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
21688 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
21689 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
21692 local_part_prefix = *-
21694 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
21697 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
21699 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
21700 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
21701 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
21702 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
21703 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
21706 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
21707 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
21708 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
21709 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
21710 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
21711 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
21712 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
21713 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
21714 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
21716 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
21717 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
21718 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
21719 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
21721 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
21722 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
21723 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
21726 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
21727 .cindex "envelope sender"
21728 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
21729 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
21730 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
21731 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
21732 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
21733 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
21734 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
21735 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
21736 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
21738 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
21739 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
21741 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
21742 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
21743 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
21744 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
21745 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
21746 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
21747 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
21749 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
21750 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
21751 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
21752 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
21753 &%errors_to%& in a router.
21757 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
21758 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
21759 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
21760 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
21761 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
21762 have easy access to it.
21764 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
21765 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
21766 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
21767 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
21768 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
21772 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
21773 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
21776 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
21777 .cindex "shadow transport"
21778 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
21779 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
21780 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
21782 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
21783 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
21784 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
21785 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
21786 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
21787 cause a log line to be written.
21789 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
21790 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
21791 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
21792 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
21793 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
21796 ST=<shadow transport name>
21798 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
21799 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
21800 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
21801 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
21802 headers that some sites insist on.
21805 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
21806 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21807 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21808 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
21809 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
21810 individual users or via a system filter.
21811 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
21813 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
21814 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
21815 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
21816 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
21817 command must be specified as an absolute path.
21819 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
21820 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
21821 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
21822 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
21823 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
21824 &(pipe)& transports.
21826 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
21827 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
21828 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
21829 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
21830 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
21832 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
21833 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
21834 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
21835 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
21837 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
21838 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
21839 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
21840 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
21841 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
21842 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
21844 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21845 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
21846 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
21847 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
21848 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
21849 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
21850 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
21851 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
21853 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21854 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
21855 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
21856 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
21857 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
21858 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
21859 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
21860 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
21861 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
21862 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
21865 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21866 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
21867 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
21868 which the message is being sent. For example:
21870 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
21871 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
21874 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
21875 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
21876 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
21878 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
21879 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
21880 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
21883 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
21885 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
21886 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
21887 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
21888 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
21889 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
21890 Exim tried to expand the first one.
21892 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
21893 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
21894 arguments. Consider this example:
21896 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21897 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21899 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
21900 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
21902 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
21903 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
21907 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
21908 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
21909 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
21910 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
21911 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
21912 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
21913 bounced from a transport filter.
21915 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
21916 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
21917 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
21920 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
21921 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
21922 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
21923 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
21924 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
21925 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
21926 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
21927 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
21928 becomes a temporary error.
21931 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
21932 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21933 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
21934 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
21935 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
21936 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
21937 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
21940 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
21941 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
21942 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
21944 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
21945 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
21946 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
21947 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
21949 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
21950 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
21951 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
21958 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21959 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21961 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
21963 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
21964 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
21965 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
21966 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
21967 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
21968 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
21969 copy of the message is delivered each time.
21971 .cindex "batched local delivery"
21972 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
21973 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
21974 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
21975 local transport, for example:
21978 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
21979 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
21980 recipients saves space.
21982 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
21983 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
21985 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
21986 to a scanner program or
21987 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
21991 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
21992 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
21993 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
21995 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
21996 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
21997 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
21998 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
21999 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
22000 to certain conditions:
22003 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22004 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
22005 batching is possible.
22007 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22008 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
22009 addresses with the same domain are batched.
22011 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
22012 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
22013 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
22014 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
22015 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
22018 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
22019 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
22020 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
22024 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
22025 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
22026 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
22027 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
22028 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
22029 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
22030 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
22033 escape_string = ".."
22035 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
22036 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
22037 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
22039 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22040 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
22041 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
22042 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
22043 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
22044 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
22046 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
22047 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22048 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
22049 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
22050 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
22051 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
22052 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
22053 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
22054 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
22059 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22060 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22062 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
22063 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
22064 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
22065 .cindex "directory creation"
22066 .cindex "creating directories"
22067 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
22068 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
22069 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
22070 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
22071 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
22072 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
22073 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
22074 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
22075 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
22076 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
22078 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
22079 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
22080 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
22083 .cindex "quota" "system"
22084 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
22085 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
22086 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
22088 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
22089 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
22090 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
22091 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
22093 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
22094 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
22097 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
22098 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
22099 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
22100 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
22105 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
22106 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
22107 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
22108 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
22109 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
22111 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22112 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22113 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
22114 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
22115 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
22116 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
22117 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
22118 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
22119 operation. There are two cases:
22122 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
22123 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
22124 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
22125 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
22126 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
22127 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
22128 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
22130 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
22131 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
22132 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
22136 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
22137 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
22138 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
22139 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
22144 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
22146 require "fileinto";
22147 fileinto "folder23";
22149 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
22150 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
22151 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
22152 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
22153 way of handling this requirement:
22155 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
22156 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
22157 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
22159 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
22163 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
22164 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
22165 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
22167 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
22168 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
22169 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
22170 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
22171 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
22172 path to the transport.
22174 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
22175 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
22180 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
22181 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
22185 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
22186 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
22187 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
22188 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
22189 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
22190 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
22191 delivery is deferred.
22194 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
22195 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22196 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22197 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
22198 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
22199 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
22200 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
22201 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
22204 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
22205 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22206 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
22207 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
22211 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
22212 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
22215 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
22216 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
22217 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
22218 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
22219 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
22222 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
22223 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
22224 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
22225 process is running.
22228 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
22229 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22230 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
22231 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
22232 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
22233 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
22234 contains is significant.
22236 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
22237 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
22238 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
22239 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
22240 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
22242 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
22243 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
22244 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
22245 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
22246 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
22247 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
22249 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22250 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
22251 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22252 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
22254 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
22255 .cindex "directory creation"
22256 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
22257 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
22258 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
22260 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
22261 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
22262 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
22263 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
22264 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
22268 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
22269 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
22270 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
22271 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
22272 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
22275 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
22276 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
22277 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
22278 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
22279 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
22280 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
22281 &%file_must_exist%&.
22284 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
22285 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
22286 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
22287 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
22289 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
22290 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
22291 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
22292 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
22293 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
22296 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
22298 .vindex "&$inode$&"
22299 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
22300 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
22301 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
22303 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
22305 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
22306 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
22310 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
22311 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
22312 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
22315 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
22316 See &%check_string%& above.
22319 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
22320 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
22321 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
22322 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
22323 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
22324 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
22327 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22328 .cindex "locking files"
22329 .cindex "lock files"
22330 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
22331 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
22333 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
22334 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
22337 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
22338 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
22341 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
22342 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
22343 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
22344 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
22345 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
22346 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
22350 .option file_format appendfile string unset
22351 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
22352 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
22353 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
22354 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
22355 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
22356 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
22357 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
22358 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
22361 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
22362 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
22364 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
22365 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
22366 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
22367 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
22368 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
22369 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
22370 delivery is deferred.
22373 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
22374 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
22375 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
22376 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
22379 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
22380 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22381 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
22382 .cindex "locking files"
22383 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
22384 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
22385 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
22386 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
22387 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
22388 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
22389 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
22390 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
22392 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
22393 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
22394 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
22395 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
22397 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
22398 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
22401 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
22403 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
22404 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
22405 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
22407 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
22408 local deliveries because of errors of the form
22410 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
22413 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
22414 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
22415 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
22416 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
22419 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
22420 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
22421 for details of locking.
22424 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
22425 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
22426 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
22429 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22430 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
22431 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
22434 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
22435 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
22436 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
22437 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
22438 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
22441 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
22442 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22443 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22444 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22445 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
22446 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
22447 external source that maintains the data.
22450 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
22451 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
22452 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22453 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
22454 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
22455 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
22456 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
22457 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
22461 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
22462 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
22463 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
22464 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
22465 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
22466 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
22467 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
22468 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
22469 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
22470 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22473 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
22474 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
22475 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
22476 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
22477 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
22478 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
22479 calculation. The default value is:
22481 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
22483 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
22484 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
22486 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
22488 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
22490 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
22491 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
22492 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
22493 directly into that directory.
22496 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
22497 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
22498 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22501 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
22502 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
22503 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
22506 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
22507 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
22508 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
22509 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
22510 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
22511 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
22512 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
22513 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
22515 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
22516 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
22517 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
22518 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
22519 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
22520 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
22521 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
22522 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
22523 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
22524 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
22527 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
22528 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
22529 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
22530 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
22531 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
22532 below for further details.
22535 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
22536 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22537 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22540 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
22541 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
22542 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
22545 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
22546 .cindex "locking files"
22547 .cindex "file" "locking"
22548 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
22549 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
22550 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22551 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
22552 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
22553 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
22554 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
22556 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
22557 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
22558 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
22565 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
22566 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
22567 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
22568 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
22569 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
22570 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
22571 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
22572 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
22574 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
22575 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
22576 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
22577 append messages to it.
22580 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22581 .cindex "&""From""& line"
22582 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
22583 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22584 in which case it is:
22586 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
22587 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
22589 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22590 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
22592 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
22593 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
22594 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
22595 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
22600 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
22601 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
22603 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
22604 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
22605 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
22606 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
22607 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
22608 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
22609 value, and this option is ignored.
22612 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
22613 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
22614 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
22615 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
22616 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
22619 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
22620 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
22621 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
22622 on users about incoming mail.
22625 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
22626 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
22627 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
22628 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
22629 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
22630 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
22631 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
22632 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
22633 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
22635 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
22636 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
22637 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
22639 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
22640 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
22641 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
22642 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
22643 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
22644 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
22646 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
22647 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
22648 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
22649 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
22650 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
22653 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22654 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22656 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
22658 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
22659 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
22660 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
22661 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
22662 system quota failures.
22664 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
22665 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
22666 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
22667 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
22668 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
22669 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
22670 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
22671 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
22672 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
22673 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
22676 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
22677 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
22678 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
22679 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
22680 delivery directory.
22683 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
22684 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
22685 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
22686 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
22687 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
22690 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
22691 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
22693 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
22694 See &%quota%& above.
22697 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
22698 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
22699 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
22700 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
22701 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
22702 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
22703 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
22705 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
22706 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
22707 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
22708 the file length to the filename. For example:
22710 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
22711 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
22713 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
22714 number of lines in the message.
22716 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
22717 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
22718 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
22720 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
22723 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
22724 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
22725 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
22727 quota_warn_message = "\
22728 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
22729 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
22730 This message is automatically created \
22731 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
22732 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
22733 a warning threshold that is\n\
22734 set by the system administrator.\n"
22738 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
22739 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
22740 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
22741 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
22742 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
22743 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
22744 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
22745 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
22746 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
22750 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
22752 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
22753 percent sign is ignored.
22755 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
22756 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
22757 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
22758 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
22759 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
22760 &'From:'& line, the default is:
22762 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
22764 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
22765 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
22768 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
22769 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
22773 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
22774 .cindex "envelope sender"
22775 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
22776 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
22777 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
22778 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
22779 for details of batch SMTP.
22782 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
22783 .cindex "carriage return"
22785 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
22786 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
22787 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
22788 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
22790 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
22791 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
22792 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
22793 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
22794 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
22795 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
22798 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22799 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
22800 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
22801 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
22802 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22803 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
22806 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
22807 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
22808 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
22809 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
22810 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
22812 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
22813 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
22814 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
22815 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
22817 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
22818 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
22819 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
22820 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
22821 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
22824 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
22825 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
22828 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
22829 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
22830 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
22831 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
22832 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
22833 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
22834 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
22836 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22837 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
22838 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
22839 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
22842 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
22843 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
22844 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
22847 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
22848 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
22849 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
22850 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
22851 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
22852 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
22853 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
22854 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
22855 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
22857 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
22858 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
22859 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
22860 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
22865 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
22866 .cindex "appending to a file"
22867 .cindex "file" "appending"
22868 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
22871 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
22875 .cindex "directory creation"
22876 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
22877 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
22878 &%directory_mode%& option.
22881 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
22882 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
22886 .cindex "file" "locking"
22887 .cindex "locking files"
22888 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
22889 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
22890 reliably over NFS, as follows:
22893 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
22894 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
22895 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
22897 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
22899 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
22900 Unlink the hitching post name.
22902 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
22903 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
22904 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
22905 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
22907 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
22908 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
22909 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
22910 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
22911 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
22912 it before trying again.
22916 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
22917 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
22918 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
22921 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
22922 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
22923 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
22924 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
22925 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
22926 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
22927 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
22928 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
22929 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
22933 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
22934 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
22935 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
22936 delivery is deferred.
22939 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
22940 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
22941 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
22945 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
22946 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
22947 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
22950 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
22951 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
22952 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
22955 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
22956 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
22957 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
22958 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
22959 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
22960 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
22961 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
22962 that prevents link following.
22965 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
22966 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
22967 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
22968 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
22969 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
22972 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
22975 .cindex "file" "locking"
22976 .cindex "locking files"
22977 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
22978 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
22979 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
22980 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
22981 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
22983 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
22985 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
22986 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
22987 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
22989 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
22990 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
22991 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
22993 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
22994 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
22995 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
22996 delivery is deferred.
22998 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
22999 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
23000 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
23001 immediately. It retries up to
23003 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
23005 times (rounded up).
23008 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
23009 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
23012 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
23013 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
23014 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23015 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
23016 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
23017 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
23018 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
23019 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
23020 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
23021 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
23023 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
23024 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
23025 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
23026 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
23027 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
23028 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
23029 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
23031 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
23032 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
23033 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
23034 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
23037 .cindex "maildir format"
23038 .cindex "mailstore format"
23039 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
23040 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
23041 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
23042 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
23043 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
23045 .cindex "directory creation"
23046 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
23047 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
23048 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
23049 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
23050 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
23051 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
23056 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
23057 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
23058 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
23059 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
23060 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
23061 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
23062 &_new_& subdirectory.
23064 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
23065 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
23066 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
23067 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
23068 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
23069 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
23070 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
23072 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
23073 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
23074 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
23075 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
23076 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
23077 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
23078 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
23079 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
23081 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
23082 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
23083 folders. Consider this example:
23085 maildir_format = true
23086 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
23087 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
23088 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
23089 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
23091 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
23092 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
23093 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
23094 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
23095 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
23096 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
23098 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
23099 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
23100 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
23101 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
23102 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
23104 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
23105 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
23106 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
23108 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23109 .cindex "maildir++"
23110 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
23111 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
23112 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
23113 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
23114 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
23115 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
23116 amount of space used.
23118 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
23119 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
23120 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
23121 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
23122 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
23123 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
23128 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
23129 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
23130 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
23131 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
23132 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
23133 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
23136 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
23137 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
23138 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
23139 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
23140 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
23141 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
23142 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
23143 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
23144 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
23145 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
23146 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
23147 backwards compatibility).
23149 For one common implementation, you might set:
23151 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
23153 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
23155 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
23156 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
23157 &[stat()]& each message file.
23160 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
23161 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
23162 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23163 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
23164 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
23165 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
23166 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
23167 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
23168 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
23170 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
23171 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
23172 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
23173 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
23174 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
23175 need to know the quota.
23177 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
23178 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
23180 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
23181 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
23182 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
23186 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
23187 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
23188 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
23189 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
23190 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
23191 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
23192 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
23193 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
23195 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
23196 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
23197 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
23198 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
23199 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
23200 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
23202 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
23203 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
23204 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
23205 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
23206 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
23207 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
23209 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
23210 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
23211 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
23212 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
23215 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
23216 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
23217 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
23218 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
23219 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
23221 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
23223 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
23224 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
23225 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
23226 .ecindex IIDapptra1
23227 .ecindex IIDapptra2
23234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23237 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
23238 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
23239 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
23240 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
23241 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
23242 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
23243 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
23244 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
23246 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
23247 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
23248 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
23249 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
23250 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
23253 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
23254 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
23255 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
23256 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
23257 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
23259 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
23260 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
23261 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
23262 transport is run as a consequence of a
23264 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
23265 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
23266 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
23267 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
23268 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
23269 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
23271 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
23272 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
23273 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
23274 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
23276 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
23277 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
23278 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
23279 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
23280 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
23281 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
23282 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
23284 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
23285 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
23286 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
23287 the transport defers.
23288 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
23289 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
23291 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
23292 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
23293 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
23294 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
23296 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23297 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
23298 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
23299 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
23300 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
23301 problems. They are just discarded.
23305 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
23306 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
23308 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
23309 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
23310 message when the message is specified by the transport.
23313 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
23314 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
23315 when the message is specified by the transport.
23318 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
23319 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
23320 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
23321 string comes first.
23324 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
23325 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
23326 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
23329 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
23330 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
23331 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
23334 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
23335 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
23336 specified by the transport.
23339 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
23340 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
23341 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
23342 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
23345 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
23346 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
23347 the message is specified by the transport.
23350 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
23351 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
23355 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
23356 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
23357 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
23358 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
23359 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
23363 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
23364 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
23365 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
23366 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
23368 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
23369 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
23370 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
23371 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
23372 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
23373 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
23374 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
23377 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
23378 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
23379 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
23380 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
23381 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
23383 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
23384 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
23385 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
23386 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
23387 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
23388 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
23391 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
23392 See &%once%& above.
23395 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
23396 See &%once%& above.
23397 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
23400 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
23401 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
23402 specified by the transport.
23405 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
23406 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
23407 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
23408 configuration option.
23411 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
23412 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
23413 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
23414 automatic responses. For example:
23416 subject = Re: $h_subject:
23418 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
23419 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
23420 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
23421 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
23426 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
23427 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
23428 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
23429 the text comes first.
23432 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
23433 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
23434 when the message is specified by the transport.
23435 .ecindex IIDauttra1
23436 .ecindex IIDauttra2
23441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23442 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23444 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
23445 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
23446 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
23447 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
23448 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
23449 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
23451 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
23452 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
23453 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
23454 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
23455 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
23456 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
23460 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
23461 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
23462 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
23465 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
23466 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23469 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
23470 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23471 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
23472 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
23473 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23476 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
23477 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
23478 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
23479 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
23480 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
23481 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
23484 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
23485 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
23486 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
23487 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
23488 in its response to the LHLO command.
23490 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
23491 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
23492 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
23493 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
23496 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
23497 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
23498 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
23499 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
23504 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
23508 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
23509 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
23513 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23514 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23516 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
23517 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
23518 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
23519 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
23520 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
23521 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
23522 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
23523 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
23527 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23528 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
23529 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
23530 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
23531 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
23533 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23534 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
23535 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
23536 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
23537 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
23538 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
23539 that are routed to the transport.
23541 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
23542 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
23543 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
23544 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
23545 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
23546 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
23547 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
23551 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
23552 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
23553 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
23555 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
23556 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
23557 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
23558 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
23559 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
23560 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
23561 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
23564 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
23565 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
23566 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
23567 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
23568 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
23569 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
23570 of "1" to enforce serialization.
23575 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
23576 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
23577 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
23578 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
23579 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
23580 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
23581 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
23582 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
23583 &"local delivery failed"&.
23585 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
23586 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
23587 will be sent as normal.
23589 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
23590 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
23591 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
23592 apply in this case.
23594 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
23595 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
23596 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
23597 a non-existent command may be the problem.
23599 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
23600 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
23601 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
23602 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
23603 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
23604 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
23605 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
23610 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
23611 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
23612 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
23613 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
23614 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
23617 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
23618 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
23619 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
23620 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
23622 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
23623 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
23624 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
23625 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
23626 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
23628 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
23630 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
23631 arguments. You have to write
23633 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
23635 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
23636 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
23637 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
23638 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
23639 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
23640 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
23643 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
23646 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23647 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23648 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23649 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
23650 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
23651 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
23652 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
23653 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
23654 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
23655 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
23656 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
23658 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, Special handling takes place
23659 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
23660 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
23661 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
23662 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
23663 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
23664 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
23665 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
23667 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
23668 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
23669 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
23670 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
23671 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
23672 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
23673 control what is done with it.
23675 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
23676 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
23677 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
23678 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
23679 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
23680 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
23681 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
23682 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
23683 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
23684 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
23685 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
23689 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
23690 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23691 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23692 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
23693 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
23694 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
23695 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
23696 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
23698 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
23699 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
23700 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
23701 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
23702 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
23703 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
23704 &`LOGNAME `& see below
23705 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
23706 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
23707 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
23708 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
23709 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
23710 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
23711 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
23712 &`USER `& see below
23714 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
23715 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
23716 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
23717 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
23718 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
23719 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
23720 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
23723 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
23724 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
23725 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
23729 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
23730 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
23731 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
23732 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
23735 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
23736 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
23740 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
23741 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
23742 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23743 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
23744 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
23745 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
23746 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
23747 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
23748 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
23749 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
23750 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
23753 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
23755 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
23756 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
23757 &%use_shell%& is set.
23760 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
23761 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23764 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
23765 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
23766 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23769 .option check_string pipe string unset
23770 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
23771 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
23772 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
23773 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
23774 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
23775 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
23776 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
23780 .option command pipe string&!! unset
23781 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
23782 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
23783 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
23784 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
23785 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
23786 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
23789 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
23790 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
23791 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
23792 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
23793 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
23794 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
23795 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
23798 .option escape_string pipe string unset
23799 See &%check_string%& above.
23802 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
23803 .cindex "exec failure"
23804 .cindex "failure of exec"
23805 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
23806 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
23807 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
23808 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
23809 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
23812 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
23813 .cindex "signal exit"
23814 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
23815 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
23816 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
23817 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
23820 .option force_command pipe boolean false
23821 .cindex "force command"
23822 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
23823 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
23824 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
23825 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
23826 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
23827 command. For example:
23829 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
23833 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
23834 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
23835 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
23838 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
23839 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
23840 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
23841 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
23842 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
23843 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
23845 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
23846 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
23849 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
23850 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
23851 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
23852 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
23853 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
23854 written to the main log.
23857 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
23858 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
23859 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
23860 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
23861 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
23862 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
23866 .option log_output pipe boolean false
23867 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
23868 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
23869 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
23870 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23873 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
23874 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
23875 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
23876 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
23877 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
23878 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
23879 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
23880 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
23883 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
23884 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23885 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
23888 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
23892 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
23893 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23894 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
23895 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
23896 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
23901 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23902 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23905 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
23906 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23907 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
23908 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
23912 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23913 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23916 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
23917 This option is expanded and
23918 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
23919 variable of the subprocess.
23920 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
23921 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
23922 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
23925 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
23926 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
23927 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
23928 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
23929 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
23930 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
23931 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
23932 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
23933 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
23936 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
23937 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23938 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
23939 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
23940 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
23941 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
23942 accept the message is used.
23945 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
23946 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
23947 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
23948 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
23949 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
23950 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
23953 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
23954 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
23955 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
23956 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
23957 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
23958 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
23959 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
23963 .option return_output pipe boolean false
23964 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
23965 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
23966 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
23967 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
23968 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
23969 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
23970 of them may be set.
23974 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
23975 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
23976 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
23977 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
23978 and &%return_output%& is not set,
23979 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
23980 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
23981 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
23982 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
23983 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
23984 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
23985 and 73, respectively.
23988 .option timeout pipe time 1h
23989 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
23990 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
23991 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
23992 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
23993 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
23994 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
23996 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
23997 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
23998 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
23999 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
24000 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
24001 delivery to be deferred.
24003 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
24004 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
24007 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
24008 .cindex "envelope sender"
24009 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
24010 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
24011 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
24012 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
24013 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
24015 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
24016 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
24017 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
24018 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
24019 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
24020 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
24024 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
24025 .cindex "carriage return"
24027 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24028 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24029 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
24030 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24032 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
24033 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
24034 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
24035 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
24036 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24039 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
24040 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24041 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
24042 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
24043 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
24044 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
24045 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
24046 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
24047 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
24052 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
24053 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
24054 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
24055 .cindex "external local delivery"
24056 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
24057 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
24058 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
24059 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
24060 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
24061 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
24062 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
24063 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
24064 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
24065 configuration for &%procmail%&:
24070 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
24074 check_string = "From "
24075 escape_string = ">From "
24084 transport = procmail_pipe
24086 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
24087 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
24088 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
24089 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
24090 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
24091 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
24093 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
24097 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
24098 use a shell to run pipe commands.
24101 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
24102 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
24105 local_delivery_cyrus:
24107 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
24108 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
24120 local_part_suffix = .*
24121 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
24123 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
24124 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
24126 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
24127 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
24130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24133 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
24134 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
24135 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
24136 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
24137 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
24138 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
24139 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
24140 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
24143 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
24144 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
24148 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
24149 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
24150 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
24151 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
24152 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
24153 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
24154 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
24156 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
24157 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
24158 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
24159 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
24160 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
24161 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
24166 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
24167 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
24168 no further messages are sent over that connection.
24172 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
24174 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24175 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
24176 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
24177 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
24178 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
24179 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
24180 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
24181 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
24184 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
24185 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
24186 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24187 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24188 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
24189 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
24190 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
24191 are the values that were set when the message was received.
24192 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
24193 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
24194 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
24195 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
24196 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
24197 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
24199 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
24200 and will be removed in a future release.
24203 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
24204 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
24205 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
24208 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
24209 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
24210 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
24211 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
24212 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
24213 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
24214 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
24215 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
24217 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
24218 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
24219 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24220 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
24221 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
24222 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
24223 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
24224 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
24225 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
24228 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
24230 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
24231 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
24232 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
24233 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
24234 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
24237 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
24238 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
24239 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
24240 particular connection.
24242 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
24243 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
24244 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
24245 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
24247 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
24248 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
24249 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
24251 authenticated_sender = $local_part
24253 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
24254 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
24256 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
24257 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
24261 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
24262 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
24263 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
24264 authenticated as a client.
24267 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
24268 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
24269 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
24270 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
24273 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
24274 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
24275 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
24276 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
24277 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
24278 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
24279 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
24282 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
24283 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
24284 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
24285 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24286 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
24287 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
24288 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
24292 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24293 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
24294 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24295 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
24296 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
24297 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
24298 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
24299 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
24300 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
24301 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
24302 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
24303 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
24304 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
24305 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
24308 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
24309 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
24310 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
24311 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
24314 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
24315 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
24316 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
24317 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
24318 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
24319 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
24320 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
24321 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
24322 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
24323 DKIM signing options. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
24326 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
24327 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
24328 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
24329 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
24330 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
24333 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
24334 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
24335 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
24336 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
24337 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
24338 unhappy at this prospect, so...
24340 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
24341 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
24342 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
24343 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
24344 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
24345 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
24346 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
24347 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
24351 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
24352 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
24353 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
24354 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
24355 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
24358 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
24359 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
24360 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
24361 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
24365 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24366 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24367 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24368 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24369 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24370 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
24371 the dnssec request bit set.
24372 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24376 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
24377 .cindex "MX record" "security"
24378 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
24379 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
24380 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
24381 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
24382 the dnssec request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
24383 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
24384 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
24388 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
24389 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
24390 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
24391 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
24392 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
24393 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
24394 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
24396 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
24397 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
24398 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
24399 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
24400 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
24403 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
24404 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
24405 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
24406 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
24407 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
24408 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24409 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24410 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
24412 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
24413 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
24414 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
24415 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
24416 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
24417 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
24419 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
24420 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
24421 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
24422 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
24423 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
24425 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
24426 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
24427 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
24428 copy of the message is sent.
24430 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
24431 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
24432 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
24433 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
24437 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
24438 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
24439 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
24442 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
24443 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
24444 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
24445 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
24446 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
24447 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
24449 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
24450 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
24451 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
24452 implementations of TLS.
24454 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
24455 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
24456 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
24457 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
24458 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
24459 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
24460 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
24465 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
24466 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
24467 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
24468 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
24469 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
24470 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
24471 interface address, you could use this:
24473 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
24474 {$primary_hostname}}
24476 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
24479 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
24480 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
24481 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
24482 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
24483 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
24484 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
24486 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
24487 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
24488 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
24489 &%hosts_override%& is set.
24491 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
24492 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
24493 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
24494 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
24495 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
24496 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
24497 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
24499 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
24500 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
24501 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
24502 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
24503 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
24504 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
24505 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
24508 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
24509 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
24512 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24513 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
24514 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
24515 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
24516 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24517 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
24518 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
24519 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
24520 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
24521 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
24524 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
24525 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
24526 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
24527 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
24530 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24531 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24532 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24533 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24535 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24536 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
24537 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
24538 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
24539 to any host that matches this list.
24542 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
24543 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
24544 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
24545 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
24546 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
24547 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
24548 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
24549 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
24552 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
24553 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
24554 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
24559 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24560 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24561 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24562 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24563 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
24564 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24565 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
24566 explanation of when this might be needed.
24568 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" *
24569 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
24570 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
24571 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24572 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
24573 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
24574 message on the same session.
24576 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
24577 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
24578 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
24579 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
24580 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
24581 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
24586 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
24587 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
24588 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
24589 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
24590 &%fallback_hosts%&.
24593 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
24594 .cindex "randomized host list"
24595 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
24596 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
24597 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
24598 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
24599 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
24600 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
24601 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
24602 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
24604 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
24605 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
24606 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
24607 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
24609 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
24611 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
24612 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
24613 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
24615 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24616 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
24617 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
24618 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
24619 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
24620 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
24621 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
24622 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
24623 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24626 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" *
24627 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24628 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
24629 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24630 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24632 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24633 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24634 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
24635 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
24636 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
24637 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
24638 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24639 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24641 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
24642 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24643 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
24644 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
24645 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
24647 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
24648 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
24649 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
24650 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24651 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
24652 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
24654 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
24655 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
24656 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24657 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
24658 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
24659 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
24660 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
24662 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
24663 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
24664 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
24665 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
24666 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24667 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
24668 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
24670 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
24671 .cindex DANE "transport options"
24672 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
24673 If built with DANE support, Exim will lookup a
24674 TLSA record for any host matching the list.
24675 If found and verified by DNSSEC,
24676 a DANE-verified TLS connection is made to that host;
24677 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
24678 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
24680 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" unset
24681 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
24682 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
24683 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
24684 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
24685 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
24686 perform a TCP Fast Open.
24687 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
24688 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
24689 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
24691 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
24692 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
24694 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
24695 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
24696 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
24697 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
24698 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
24700 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
24701 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
24702 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
24703 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
24704 for multi-recipient messages.
24705 The option can usually be left as default.
24707 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
24708 .cindex "bind IP address"
24709 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
24711 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24712 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
24713 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
24714 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
24715 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
24716 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
24717 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
24718 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
24721 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
24722 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
24723 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
24724 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
24725 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
24726 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
24729 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
24731 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
24732 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
24733 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
24734 interface to use if the host has more than one.
24737 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
24738 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
24739 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
24740 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
24741 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
24742 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
24743 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
24744 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
24745 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
24746 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
24750 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
24751 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24752 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
24753 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
24754 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
24756 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
24757 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
24758 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
24759 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
24760 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
24764 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
24765 .vindex "&$domain$&"
24766 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
24767 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
24768 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
24769 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
24770 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
24771 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
24773 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
24774 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
24775 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
24777 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
24778 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
24779 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
24780 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
24781 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
24782 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
24783 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
24784 variable that contains an outgoing port.
24786 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
24787 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
24789 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
24790 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
24791 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
24794 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
24795 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
24799 .option protocol smtp string smtp
24800 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
24801 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
24802 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
24804 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
24805 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
24806 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
24807 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
24808 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
24810 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
24811 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
24812 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
24813 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
24814 but as of RFC 8314 it is perferred over STARTTLS for message submission
24815 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
24818 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
24819 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
24820 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
24821 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
24822 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
24823 addresses is not affected.
24825 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
24826 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
24827 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
24828 Exim to use only the host name.
24829 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
24832 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
24833 .cindex "serializing connections"
24834 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
24835 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
24836 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
24837 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
24838 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
24839 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
24840 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
24842 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
24843 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
24844 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
24845 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
24846 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
24847 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
24849 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
24850 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
24851 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
24852 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
24853 are used for ETRN serialization.
24855 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
24858 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
24859 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
24860 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
24861 .cindex "size" "of message"
24862 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24863 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24864 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
24865 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
24866 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
24867 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
24868 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
24869 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
24871 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
24872 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
24875 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
24876 .cindex proxy SOCKS
24877 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
24878 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
24881 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
24882 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
24883 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
24885 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24886 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24887 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
24888 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
24889 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
24892 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
24893 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
24894 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
24895 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
24899 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
24900 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
24901 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
24902 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
24903 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
24906 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
24907 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
24908 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
24909 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
24910 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
24911 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
24914 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
24917 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
24918 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
24920 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24921 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
24922 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
24923 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
24924 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24925 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
24926 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
24927 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
24930 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
24931 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
24932 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
24934 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24935 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
24936 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
24937 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
24938 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
24939 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
24940 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
24941 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
24942 ciphers is a preference order.
24946 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
24947 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
24948 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
24949 If this option is set then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
24950 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
24951 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
24952 certificate and private key for the session.
24954 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
24956 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
24962 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
24963 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
24964 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
24965 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
24966 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
24967 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
24968 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
24969 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
24970 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24971 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24975 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
24976 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
24977 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24978 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
24979 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
24980 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
24981 Note that unless the host is in this list
24982 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
24983 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
24984 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
24985 certificate verification succeeds.
24988 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
24989 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
24990 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
24991 This option give a list of hosts for which,
24992 while verifying the server certificate,
24993 checks will be included on the host name
24994 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
24995 versus Subject and Subject-Alternate-Name fields. Wildcard names are permitted
24996 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
24998 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
25001 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
25002 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25003 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25005 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25006 The value of this option must be either the
25008 or the absolute path to
25009 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
25010 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
25012 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
25013 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
25014 is taken as empty and an explicit location
25017 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
25018 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
25020 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
25022 either by file or directory
25023 are added to those given by the system default location.
25025 The values of &$host$& and
25026 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
25027 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25029 For back-compatibility,
25030 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
25031 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
25032 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
25035 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
25036 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
25037 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
25038 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
25039 certificate verification must succeed.
25040 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
25041 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
25042 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
25044 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer!! unset
25045 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
25046 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
25047 If built with internationalization support,
25048 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
25050 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
25055 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
25057 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25058 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
25059 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
25060 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
25061 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
25064 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
25065 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
25066 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
25067 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
25070 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
25071 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
25072 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
25074 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
25075 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
25076 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
25077 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
25078 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
25080 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
25081 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
25082 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
25083 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
25084 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
25085 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
25086 see below for an exception).
25088 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
25089 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
25090 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
25091 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
25092 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
25094 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
25095 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
25096 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
25097 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
25098 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
25099 reached their retry times.
25101 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
25102 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
25103 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
25104 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
25105 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
25106 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
25107 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
25108 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
25109 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
25110 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
25113 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
25114 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
25115 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
25116 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
25117 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
25118 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
25120 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
25121 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
25122 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
25123 possible IP addresses have been tried.
25124 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
25125 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
25131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25132 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25134 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
25135 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
25136 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
25137 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
25138 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
25139 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
25141 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
25142 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
25143 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
25144 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
25145 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
25146 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
25147 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
25149 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
25150 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
25151 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
25152 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
25155 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
25156 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
25157 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
25158 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
25160 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
25161 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
25162 facility; you do not have to use it.
25164 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
25165 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
25166 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
25167 address to which it applies.
25169 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
25170 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
25171 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
25172 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
25173 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
25174 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
25177 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
25178 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
25179 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
25180 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
25183 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
25184 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
25185 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
25186 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
25187 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
25190 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
25191 illustrated by these examples:
25194 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
25195 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
25196 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
25197 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
25199 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
25200 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
25205 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
25206 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
25207 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
25208 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
25209 message's processing.
25211 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
25212 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
25213 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
25214 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
25215 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
25216 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
25217 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
25218 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
25219 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
25221 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25222 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25223 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
25224 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
25225 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
25226 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
25227 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
25228 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
25229 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
25230 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
25232 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
25233 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
25234 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
25235 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
25236 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
25237 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
25239 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
25240 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
25241 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
25243 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
25244 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
25245 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
25246 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
25247 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
25248 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
25249 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
25250 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
25251 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
25253 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
25254 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
25260 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
25261 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
25262 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
25263 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
25264 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
25265 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
25266 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
25267 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
25268 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
25269 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
25271 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
25273 might produce the output
25275 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25276 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25277 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25278 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25279 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25280 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25281 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
25282 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
25284 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
25285 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
25286 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
25287 set for a particular transport.
25290 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
25291 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
25292 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
25295 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
25297 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
25298 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
25299 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
25300 any colons must be doubled, of course).
25302 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
25303 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
25304 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
25305 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
25308 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
25309 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
25310 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
25312 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
25313 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
25314 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
25315 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
25316 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
25317 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
25318 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
25320 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25321 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25322 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
25323 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
25324 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
25328 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
25329 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25332 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
25333 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
25334 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
25335 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
25336 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
25337 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
25338 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
25339 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
25340 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
25342 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
25343 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
25344 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
25346 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
25347 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
25348 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
25349 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
25350 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
25351 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
25352 of pattern they are set as follows:
25355 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
25356 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
25357 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
25360 *queen@*.fict.example
25362 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
25364 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
25368 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
25369 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
25372 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
25373 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
25374 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
25375 rewriting rule of the form
25377 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
25379 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
25385 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
25386 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
25387 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
25388 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
25389 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
25393 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
25394 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
25395 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
25396 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
25397 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
25399 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
25401 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
25404 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25405 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25406 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
25407 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
25408 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
25409 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
25410 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
25411 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
25412 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
25413 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
25414 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
25415 entry written to the panic log.
25419 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
25420 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
25423 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
25426 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
25428 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
25431 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
25432 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
25436 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
25438 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
25439 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
25440 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
25441 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
25442 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
25443 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
25445 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
25446 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
25447 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
25448 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
25449 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
25450 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
25451 &`h`& rewrite all headers
25452 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
25453 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
25454 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
25456 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
25457 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
25458 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
25460 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
25461 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
25464 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
25465 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
25466 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
25467 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
25468 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
25469 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
25470 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
25471 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
25472 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
25474 .vindex "&$domain$&"
25475 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25476 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
25477 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
25478 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
25479 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
25480 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
25481 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
25484 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
25485 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
25486 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
25487 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
25490 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
25491 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
25492 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
25494 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
25495 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
25496 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
25497 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
25499 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
25500 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
25501 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
25503 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
25504 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
25505 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
25506 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
25508 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
25512 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
25515 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
25516 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
25517 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
25518 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
25519 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
25520 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
25521 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
25522 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
25524 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
25525 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
25529 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
25530 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
25532 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
25533 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
25534 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
25536 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
25537 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
25538 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
25539 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
25540 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
25541 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
25542 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
25543 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
25545 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
25546 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
25548 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
25550 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
25551 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
25553 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
25554 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
25555 messages that originate outside the local host:
25557 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
25558 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
25560 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
25563 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
25564 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
25565 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
25566 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
25567 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
25568 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
25569 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
25570 components. For example, the rule
25572 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
25574 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
25575 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
25576 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
25577 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
25578 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
25579 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
25580 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
25587 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25590 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
25591 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
25592 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
25593 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
25594 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
25595 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
25596 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
25597 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
25598 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
25599 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
25600 address, domain and error.
25602 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
25603 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
25604 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
25605 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
25606 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
25607 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
25608 log selector is set, the message
25609 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
25610 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
25611 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
25612 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
25614 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
25615 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
25616 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
25617 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
25618 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
25619 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
25620 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
25621 domain are maintained independently.
25623 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
25624 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
25625 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
25626 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
25627 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
25628 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
25629 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
25630 the local address is reached.
25632 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
25633 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
25634 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
25635 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
25636 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
25638 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
25639 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
25640 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
25641 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
25642 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
25643 messages that it should now be retaining.
25647 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
25648 .cindex "retry" "rules"
25649 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
25650 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
25651 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
25652 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
25653 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
25654 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
25655 message's sender, respectively.
25658 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
25659 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
25660 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
25661 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
25662 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
25663 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
25666 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25668 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
25671 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
25673 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
25674 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
25677 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
25678 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
25679 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
25680 expressions work in address lists.
25682 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
25683 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
25687 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
25688 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
25689 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
25690 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
25691 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
25692 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
25693 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
25694 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
25695 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
25697 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
25698 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
25699 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
25700 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
25703 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
25704 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
25705 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
25706 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
25707 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
25708 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
25709 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
25710 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
25711 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
25712 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
25717 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
25719 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
25720 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
25721 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
25722 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
25723 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
25724 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
25726 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
25730 and the retry rules are
25732 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
25733 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
25735 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
25736 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
25737 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
25738 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
25739 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
25740 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
25742 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
25743 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
25744 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
25745 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
25747 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
25748 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
25749 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
25751 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
25753 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
25754 textual form of the IP address.
25756 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
25757 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
25758 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
25759 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
25762 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
25763 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
25764 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
25766 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
25767 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
25768 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
25770 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
25771 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
25773 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
25774 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
25777 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
25778 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
25779 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
25780 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
25781 retry rule of this form:
25783 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
25785 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
25786 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
25789 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
25790 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
25791 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
25792 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
25795 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
25796 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
25797 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
25798 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
25799 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
25801 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
25802 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
25804 .vitem &%refused_A%&
25805 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
25808 A connection was refused.
25810 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
25811 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
25813 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
25814 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
25816 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
25817 A connection attempt timed out.
25819 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
25820 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
25821 obtained from an MX record.
25823 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
25824 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
25825 obtained from an MX record.
25828 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
25830 .vitem &%tls_required%&
25831 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
25832 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
25833 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
25836 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25839 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
25840 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
25841 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
25842 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
25843 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
25844 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
25848 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
25849 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
25850 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
25851 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
25852 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
25856 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
25857 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
25858 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
25860 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
25861 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
25862 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
25863 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
25864 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
25865 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
25866 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
25868 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
25869 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
25872 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
25873 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
25874 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
25879 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
25880 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
25881 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
25882 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
25883 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
25886 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
25888 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
25890 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
25892 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
25893 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
25896 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
25898 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
25899 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
25900 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
25901 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
25902 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
25904 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
25905 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
25907 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
25909 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
25910 list is never matched.
25916 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
25917 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
25918 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
25919 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
25921 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
25923 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
25924 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
25925 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
25926 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
25927 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
25929 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
25930 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
25931 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
25932 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
25933 The available algorithms are:
25936 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
25939 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
25940 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
25941 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
25943 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
25944 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
25945 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
25946 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
25947 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
25948 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
25949 queue processing times.
25952 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
25953 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
25954 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
25955 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
25956 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
25957 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
25958 interval is found. The main configuration variable
25959 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
25960 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
25961 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
25962 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
25963 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
25965 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
25966 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
25967 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
25968 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
25969 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
25970 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
25973 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
25974 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
25975 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
25976 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
25977 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
25978 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
25979 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
25980 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
25981 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
25982 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
25983 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
25984 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
25986 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
25987 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
25988 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
25989 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
25990 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
25991 deliveries that have been deferred.
25994 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
25995 Here are some example retry rules:
25997 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
25998 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
25999 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
26000 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
26001 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
26002 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
26004 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
26005 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
26006 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
26007 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
26008 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
26009 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
26010 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
26013 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
26014 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
26015 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
26016 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
26017 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
26019 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
26020 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
26021 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
26022 were not obtained from an MX record.
26024 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
26025 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
26026 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
26027 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
26028 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
26032 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
26033 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
26034 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
26035 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
26036 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
26037 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
26038 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
26039 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
26040 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
26041 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
26042 failing for the first time.
26044 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
26045 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
26046 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
26047 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
26049 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
26050 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
26051 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
26056 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
26057 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
26058 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
26059 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
26060 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
26061 default retry rule:
26063 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
26065 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
26066 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
26067 failure for the recipient address that counts.
26069 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
26070 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
26071 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
26072 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
26073 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
26075 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
26076 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
26077 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
26079 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
26080 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
26081 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
26082 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
26083 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
26084 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
26085 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
26086 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
26087 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
26088 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
26089 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
26091 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
26092 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
26093 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
26094 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
26095 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
26098 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
26099 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
26100 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
26101 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
26102 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
26103 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
26104 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
26105 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
26106 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
26109 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
26110 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
26111 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
26112 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
26113 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
26114 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
26115 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
26116 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
26119 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
26120 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
26121 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
26122 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
26123 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
26124 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
26125 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
26126 time out the address.
26128 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
26129 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
26130 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
26131 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
26132 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
26133 considered immediately.
26134 .ecindex IIDretconf1
26135 .ecindex IIDregconf2
26142 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26143 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26145 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
26146 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
26147 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
26148 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
26149 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
26150 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
26151 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
26152 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
26153 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
26156 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
26157 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
26160 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
26161 the client's EHLO command.
26163 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
26164 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
26166 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
26167 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
26168 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
26169 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
26170 with the AUTH command.
26172 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
26174 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
26175 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
26176 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
26179 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
26180 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
26181 unauthenticated connection.
26184 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
26185 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
26186 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
26187 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
26189 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
26190 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
26191 &`Connected to server.example.`&
26192 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
26193 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
26194 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
26195 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
26196 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
26201 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
26202 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
26203 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
26204 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
26205 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
26206 included by setting
26209 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
26213 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
26218 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
26219 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
26220 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
26221 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
26222 work via a socket interface.
26224 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
26225 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
26227 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
26228 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
26229 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
26230 supporting setting a server keytab.
26231 The seventh can be configured to support
26232 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
26233 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
26234 The eighth authenticator
26235 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
26236 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
26237 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
26239 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
26240 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
26241 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
26242 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
26243 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
26244 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
26245 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
26247 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
26248 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
26249 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
26250 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
26251 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
26252 both sets of options, is required. For example:
26256 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26257 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
26259 client_secret = secret2
26261 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
26262 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
26264 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
26265 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
26266 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
26269 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
26270 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
26271 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
26272 authenticating data.
26274 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
26275 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
26276 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
26277 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
26278 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
26279 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
26280 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
26281 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
26282 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
26283 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
26286 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
26287 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
26288 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
26289 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
26293 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
26294 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
26295 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
26297 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26298 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
26299 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
26300 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
26301 encrypted by a setting such as:
26303 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
26307 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26308 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
26309 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
26310 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
26313 .option driver authenticators string unset
26314 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
26315 authenticators is to be used.
26318 .option public_name authenticators string unset
26319 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
26320 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
26321 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
26322 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
26323 defaults to the driver's instance name.
26326 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26327 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
26328 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
26329 mechanism is not advertised.
26330 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
26331 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
26332 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
26335 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26336 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
26337 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
26340 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
26341 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
26343 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
26344 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
26345 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
26346 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
26347 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
26348 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
26349 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26350 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
26351 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
26355 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
26356 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
26357 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
26358 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
26359 out the values of variables.
26360 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
26361 output, and Exim carries on processing.
26364 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
26365 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26366 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
26367 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
26368 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
26369 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
26370 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
26371 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
26372 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
26373 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
26374 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
26375 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
26378 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26379 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
26380 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
26381 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
26382 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
26383 remembered for later use.
26384 How it is used is described in the following section.
26390 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
26391 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
26392 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26393 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
26394 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
26398 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
26399 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
26401 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
26403 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
26404 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
26405 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
26406 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
26407 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
26408 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
26409 given for the MAIL command.
26411 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
26412 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
26415 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
26416 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
26417 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
26418 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
26419 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
26420 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
26421 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
26426 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
26427 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
26428 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
26429 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
26431 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26432 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
26433 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
26434 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
26435 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
26440 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
26441 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
26442 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
26443 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
26447 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
26449 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
26450 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
26453 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
26454 the mechanisms are advertised.
26456 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
26457 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
26458 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
26459 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
26460 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
26461 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
26462 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
26464 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
26466 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
26468 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
26469 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
26470 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
26473 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
26475 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
26476 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
26477 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
26479 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
26480 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
26481 command. This is the case if
26484 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
26486 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
26488 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
26489 server authenticators.
26493 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
26494 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
26495 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
26497 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
26498 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
26499 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
26500 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
26501 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
26502 rejected with a 504 error.
26504 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
26505 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
26506 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
26507 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
26508 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
26509 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
26510 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
26511 no successful authentication.
26513 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
26514 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
26515 &$authresults$& expansion item.
26520 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
26521 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
26522 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
26523 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
26524 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
26525 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
26526 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
26530 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
26532 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
26533 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
26534 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
26535 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
26536 command line to run this script on such data might be
26538 encode '\0user\0password'
26540 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
26541 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
26542 whose code value is zero.
26544 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
26545 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
26546 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
26547 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
26549 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
26550 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
26551 example, a command such as
26553 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
26555 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
26557 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
26558 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
26560 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
26562 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
26563 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
26564 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
26565 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
26569 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
26570 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
26571 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
26572 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
26573 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
26574 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
26577 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
26578 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
26579 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
26580 of the authenticator.
26583 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26584 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
26585 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
26586 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
26587 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
26588 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
26589 delivery to be deferred.
26591 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
26592 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
26593 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
26596 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
26597 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
26598 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
26599 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
26600 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
26601 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
26602 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
26603 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
26604 deliver the message unauthenticated.
26607 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
26608 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
26609 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
26610 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
26611 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
26612 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
26613 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
26614 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
26616 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
26618 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
26619 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
26620 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
26621 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
26622 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
26623 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
26624 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
26625 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
26626 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
26627 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
26628 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
26629 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
26630 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
26637 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26640 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
26641 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
26642 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
26643 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
26644 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
26645 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
26646 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
26647 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
26648 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
26649 connections as you do for login accounts.
26651 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
26652 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
26653 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
26655 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
26656 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
26657 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
26659 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
26660 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
26661 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
26664 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
26665 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26666 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26667 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
26668 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26669 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
26670 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26672 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
26673 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
26674 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
26675 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
26676 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
26677 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
26678 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
26680 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
26681 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
26682 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
26683 string expansions that also use them for other things.
26685 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
26686 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
26687 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
26689 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26690 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
26691 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
26692 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
26693 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
26694 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
26695 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
26696 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
26697 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
26698 string as the error text.
26700 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
26701 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
26702 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
26706 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
26707 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
26708 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
26709 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
26710 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
26711 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
26712 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
26713 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
26715 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
26716 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
26717 configured as follows:
26721 public_name = PLAIN
26723 server_condition = \
26724 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
26725 server_set_id = $auth2
26727 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
26728 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
26729 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
26730 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
26732 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
26733 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
26734 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
26735 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
26739 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
26741 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
26743 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
26744 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
26748 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
26749 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
26751 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
26752 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
26753 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
26754 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
26755 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
26757 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
26758 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
26759 authenticating clients it could make sense.
26761 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
26762 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
26763 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
26764 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
26765 This is an incorrect example:
26767 server_condition = \
26768 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
26770 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
26771 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
26772 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
26773 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
26774 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
26775 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
26776 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
26778 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
26779 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
26781 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
26782 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
26783 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
26784 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
26785 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
26788 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
26789 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
26790 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
26791 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
26792 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
26793 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
26794 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
26798 public_name = LOGIN
26799 server_prompts = User Name : Password
26800 server_condition = \
26801 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
26802 server_set_id = $auth1
26804 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
26805 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
26806 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
26807 strings are used to obtain two data items.
26809 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
26810 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
26811 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
26812 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
26813 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
26817 public_name = LOGIN
26818 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
26819 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
26822 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
26823 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
26824 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
26825 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
26827 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
26828 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
26829 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
26830 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
26831 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
26832 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
26833 uninterpreted string.
26836 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
26837 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
26838 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
26839 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
26840 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
26846 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
26847 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
26848 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
26850 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
26851 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
26852 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
26853 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
26856 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
26857 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
26858 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
26859 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
26860 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
26861 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
26862 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
26863 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
26864 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
26865 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
26866 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
26867 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
26869 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
26870 splitting takes priority and happens first.
26872 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
26873 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
26874 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
26875 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
26878 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
26879 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
26883 public_name = PLAIN
26884 client_send = ^username^mysecret
26886 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
26887 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
26888 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
26892 public_name = LOGIN
26893 client_send = : username : mysecret
26895 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
26896 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
26898 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
26899 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
26904 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26905 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26907 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
26908 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26909 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
26910 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
26911 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
26912 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
26913 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
26914 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
26915 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
26916 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
26917 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
26918 available in plain text at either end.
26921 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
26922 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
26923 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
26924 authenticator as a server:
26926 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26927 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
26928 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
26929 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
26930 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
26931 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
26932 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
26933 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
26934 returned to the client.
26936 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
26937 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
26938 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
26939 numeric variables for other things.
26941 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
26942 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
26943 user name, authentication fails.
26947 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26948 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
26949 server_set_id = $auth1
26951 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
26952 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
26953 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
26954 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
26958 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26959 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
26961 server_set_id = $auth1
26963 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
26964 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
26966 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
26967 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
26968 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
26973 public_name = CRAM-MD5
26974 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
26975 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
26976 server_set_id = $auth1
26979 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
26980 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
26981 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
26985 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
26986 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
26987 computing the response to the server's challenge.
26990 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
26991 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
26992 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
26996 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26997 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
26998 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
26999 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
27000 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
27001 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
27002 send the message to the current server.
27004 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
27009 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27011 client_secret = secret
27013 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
27014 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
27018 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27019 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27021 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
27022 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
27023 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
27024 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
27026 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
27027 at A L Digital Ltd.
27029 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
27030 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
27031 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
27032 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
27033 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
27035 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
27036 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
27037 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
27038 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
27040 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
27041 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
27042 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
27043 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
27044 depending on the driver you are using.
27046 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
27047 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
27048 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
27049 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
27050 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
27053 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
27054 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
27055 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
27056 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
27057 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
27058 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
27059 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
27060 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
27063 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
27064 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
27065 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
27066 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
27067 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
27068 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
27072 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
27073 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27074 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
27075 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
27078 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
27079 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27080 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27081 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27085 driver = cyrus_sasl
27086 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27087 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27088 server_set_id = $auth1
27091 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
27092 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27095 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
27096 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27099 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
27100 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
27101 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
27102 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
27105 driver = cyrus_sasl
27106 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27107 server_set_id = $auth1
27110 driver = cyrus_sasl
27111 public_name = PLAIN
27112 server_set_id = $auth2
27114 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
27115 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
27116 but it is present in many binary distributions.
27117 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
27118 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
27123 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27125 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
27126 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
27127 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
27128 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
27129 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
27130 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
27131 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
27132 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
27133 authenticator only. There is only one option:
27135 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
27137 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
27138 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
27139 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
27140 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
27144 public_name = PLAIN
27145 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27146 server_set_id = $auth1
27151 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
27152 server_set_id = $auth1
27154 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
27155 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
27156 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
27157 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
27158 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
27159 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
27160 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
27161 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
27164 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27165 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27166 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
27167 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
27168 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
27169 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
27170 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
27171 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27172 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27173 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
27174 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
27175 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
27176 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
27177 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM-SHA-1"
27178 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides server integration for the GNU SASL
27179 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
27180 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
27181 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
27182 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
27183 without code changes in Exim.
27185 Exim's &(gsasl)& authenticator does not have client-side support at this
27186 time; only the server-side support is implemented. Patches welcome.
27189 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
27190 Do not set this true without consulting a cryptographic engineer.
27192 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
27193 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
27194 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
27195 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
27198 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
27199 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
27200 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
27202 This is currently only supported when using the GnuTLS library. This is
27203 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
27204 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
27206 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
27207 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
27208 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
27210 However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be broken in current versions.
27211 Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
27212 with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
27215 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
27216 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
27217 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27218 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27221 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
27222 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
27223 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
27224 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
27229 public_name = X-ANYTHING
27230 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
27231 server_set_id = $auth1
27235 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
27236 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
27237 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
27238 the password itself.
27240 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
27241 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
27242 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
27243 if available, else the empty string.
27244 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
27245 else the empty string.
27247 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
27249 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
27250 option to be simply "true".
27253 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
27254 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
27255 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27258 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! unset
27259 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27260 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27261 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27264 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
27265 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
27266 &$auth1$& is not available at evaluation time.
27267 (This may change, as we receive feedback on use)
27270 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
27271 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
27272 Some mechanisms will use this data.
27275 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
27276 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27277 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
27278 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
27280 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
27281 meanings for these variables:
27284 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27285 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
27287 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27288 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
27290 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
27291 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
27294 On a per-mechanism basis:
27297 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
27298 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
27299 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27301 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
27302 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
27303 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27305 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27306 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
27307 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
27308 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
27311 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
27312 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
27313 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
27316 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
27317 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
27319 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
27321 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27322 server_realm = imap.example.org
27323 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
27324 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
27325 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
27326 server_condition = yes
27330 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27331 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27333 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
27334 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
27335 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
27336 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
27337 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
27338 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
27339 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
27342 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
27343 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
27344 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
27345 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
27347 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
27348 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
27349 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
27350 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
27352 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
27353 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
27354 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
27358 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
27359 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
27360 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
27361 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
27363 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
27364 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
27365 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
27366 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
27368 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27370 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
27371 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
27373 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
27374 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
27375 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
27380 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27381 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27383 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
27384 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
27385 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
27386 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
27387 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
27388 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
27389 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
27390 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
27391 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
27392 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
27393 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
27394 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
27395 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
27399 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
27400 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
27402 The server sends back a challenge.
27404 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
27405 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
27408 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
27412 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
27413 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
27414 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
27416 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
27417 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
27418 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
27419 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
27420 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
27421 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
27422 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
27423 for other things. For example:
27428 server_password = \
27429 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
27431 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27432 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27438 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
27439 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
27440 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
27444 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
27445 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
27448 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
27449 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
27452 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
27453 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
27454 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
27460 client_username = msn/msn_username
27461 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
27462 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
27464 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
27465 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
27471 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27474 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
27475 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
27476 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
27477 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27478 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27479 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27480 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
27481 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
27482 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
27483 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
27484 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
27485 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
27486 by the server configuration.
27488 The client presents an identity in-clear.
27489 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
27490 and for clients to only attempt,
27491 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
27493 One possible use, compatible with the
27494 K-9 Mail Andoid client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
27495 is for using X509 client certificates.
27497 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
27498 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
27499 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
27500 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
27501 client certificates only.
27503 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
27504 client-certificate authentication is being done.
27506 The client must present a certificate,
27507 for which it must have been requested via the
27508 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27509 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27510 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
27511 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
27513 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
27514 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
27515 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
27517 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
27518 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
27519 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27520 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
27521 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
27522 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27523 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27525 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
27527 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
27528 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27529 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
27530 "in &(external)& authenticator"
27531 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
27532 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
27534 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
27535 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
27536 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
27537 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
27538 an identity for authentication and
27539 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
27541 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
27542 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
27543 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
27544 string expansions that also use them for other things.
27546 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27547 Once an identity has been received,
27548 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
27549 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
27550 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
27551 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27552 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
27553 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
27554 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
27555 string as the error text.
27559 ext_ccert_san_mail:
27561 public_name = EXTERNAL
27563 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
27564 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27565 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27566 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
27567 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
27568 server_set_id = $auth1
27570 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27571 of your configured trust-anchors
27572 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27573 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
27575 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27576 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27577 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27579 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27582 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
27583 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
27584 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
27586 .option client_send external string&!! unset
27587 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
27588 identity being asserted.
27594 public_name = EXTERNAL
27596 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27597 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
27601 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
27602 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
27608 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27611 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
27612 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
27613 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
27614 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
27615 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
27616 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
27617 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
27618 authentication based on client certificates.
27620 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
27621 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
27622 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
27623 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
27624 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
27625 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
27627 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
27628 for which it must have been requested via the
27629 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
27630 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
27632 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
27633 run before any SMTP-level communication is done,
27634 and can authenticate the connection.
27635 If it does, SMTP authentication is not offered.
27637 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
27640 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
27641 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
27643 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
27644 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
27645 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
27646 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
27647 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
27648 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
27650 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
27651 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
27652 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
27654 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
27661 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
27662 {$tls_in_peercert}}
27663 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
27666 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
27667 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
27668 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
27670 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
27672 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
27673 of your configured trust-anchors
27674 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
27675 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
27677 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
27678 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
27679 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
27681 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
27683 . An alternative might use
27685 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
27687 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
27688 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
27689 . This would help for per-device use.
27691 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
27692 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
27694 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
27695 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
27698 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
27699 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
27700 a connect- or helo-ACL.
27704 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27705 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27707 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
27708 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
27709 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
27710 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
27711 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
27714 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
27715 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
27716 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
27717 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
27718 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
27719 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
27720 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
27721 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
27722 certificates are used.
27724 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
27725 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
27726 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
27727 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
27728 between them is encrypted.
27730 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
27731 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
27732 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
27733 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
27736 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
27737 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
27738 in order to get TLS to work.
27742 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
27744 .cindex "submissions protocol"
27745 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
27746 .cindex "smtps protocol"
27747 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
27748 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
27749 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
27750 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
27751 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
27752 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
27753 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
27754 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
27756 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
27757 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
27758 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
27760 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
27761 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
27762 reassigned for other use.
27763 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
27765 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
27766 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
27767 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
27769 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
27770 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
27771 the most common use is expected to be:
27773 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
27775 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
27776 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
27777 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
27778 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
27779 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
27782 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
27783 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
27790 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
27791 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
27792 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
27793 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
27794 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
27798 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
27802 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
27803 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
27805 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
27808 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
27809 cannot be the path of a directory
27810 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
27811 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
27813 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
27815 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
27816 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
27817 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
27818 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
27819 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
27821 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
27822 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
27823 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
27824 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
27825 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
27826 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
27827 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
27830 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
27831 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
27833 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
27834 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
27835 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
27836 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
27838 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option
27839 main option, it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
27841 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
27842 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
27843 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
27844 implementation, then patches are welcome.
27848 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
27849 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
27850 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
27851 but not the chosen filename.
27852 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
27853 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
27855 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
27856 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
27857 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
27858 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
27860 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
27861 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
27862 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
27863 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
27864 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
27865 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
27866 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
27868 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
27869 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
27870 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
27871 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
27872 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
27874 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
27875 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
27876 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
27877 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
27878 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
27879 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
27881 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
27882 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
27883 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
27885 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
27886 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
27887 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
27888 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
27891 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
27894 # chown exim:exim new-params
27895 # chmod 0600 new-params
27896 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
27897 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
27898 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
27899 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
27900 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
27901 # chmod 0400 new-params
27902 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
27904 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
27905 stalling is removed.
27907 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
27908 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
27909 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
27910 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
27911 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
27912 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
27913 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
27914 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
27915 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
27916 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
27917 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
27919 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
27920 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
27921 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
27922 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
27924 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
27925 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
27926 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
27927 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
27928 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
27931 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
27932 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
27933 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
27934 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
27935 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
27936 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
27937 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
27938 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
27939 directly to this function call.
27940 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
27941 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
27942 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
27943 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
27946 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
27948 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
27949 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
27950 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
27953 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
27954 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
27955 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
27959 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
27962 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
27963 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
27966 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
27967 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
27969 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
27970 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
27973 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
27974 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
27975 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
27976 not be moved to the end of the list.
27979 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
27982 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
27983 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
27986 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
27987 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
27988 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
27989 choice of clients used:
27991 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
27992 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
27997 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
27999 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
28002 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
28003 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
28004 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
28005 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
28007 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
28009 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
28013 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
28015 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
28016 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
28017 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
28018 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
28019 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
28020 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
28021 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
28022 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
28023 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
28024 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
28026 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
28027 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
28029 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
28030 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
28031 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
28032 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
28033 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
28034 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
28036 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
28037 "Priority strings". This is online as
28038 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
28039 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
28040 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
28041 then the example code
28042 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
28043 on that site can be used to test a given string.
28047 # Disable older versions of protocols
28048 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
28051 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
28052 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
28053 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
28055 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
28056 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
28057 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
28058 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
28062 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
28068 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
28069 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
28070 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
28071 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
28072 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
28073 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
28074 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
28076 If STARTTLS is to be used you
28077 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
28079 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
28080 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
28081 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
28084 554 Security failure
28086 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
28087 rejected with a 554 error code.
28089 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
28090 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
28092 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
28093 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
28094 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
28095 from someone able to intercept the communication.
28097 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
28099 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
28101 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
28102 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
28104 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
28105 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
28106 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
28107 that goes with it. These files need to be
28108 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
28109 always be given as full path names.
28110 The key must not be password-protected.
28111 They can be the same file if both the
28112 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
28113 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
28114 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
28115 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
28116 the server's certificate.
28118 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
28119 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
28120 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
28121 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
28122 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
28123 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
28125 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
28126 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
28127 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
28129 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
28130 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
28131 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
28134 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
28135 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
28136 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
28138 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
28140 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
28141 with the parameters contained in the file.
28142 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
28147 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
28148 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
28149 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
28150 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
28156 for a way of generating file data.
28158 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
28159 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
28160 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
28161 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
28162 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
28164 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28165 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28166 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28167 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
28168 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
28169 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
28170 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
28171 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
28172 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
28174 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
28175 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
28176 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
28177 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
28178 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
28179 documentation for more details.
28181 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
28182 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
28185 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
28186 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
28187 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
28188 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
28189 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
28190 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
28191 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
28192 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
28193 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
28194 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
28195 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
28196 an explicit file or,
28197 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
28198 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
28200 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
28203 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
28204 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
28205 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
28207 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
28209 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
28211 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
28212 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
28214 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
28215 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
28216 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
28217 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
28218 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
28219 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
28220 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
28221 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
28222 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
28223 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
28225 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
28226 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
28227 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
28228 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
28230 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28231 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
28232 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
28233 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
28234 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
28235 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
28238 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
28239 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
28240 .cindex "revocation list"
28241 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
28242 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
28243 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
28244 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
28245 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
28246 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
28247 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
28249 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
28250 file from every certificate authority they know of.
28252 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
28253 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
28254 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
28255 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
28256 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
28257 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
28259 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
28260 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
28261 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
28262 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
28264 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
28265 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
28266 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
28267 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
28268 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
28269 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
28270 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
28271 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
28273 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
28274 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
28275 support for OCSP stapling is included.
28277 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28278 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
28279 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
28280 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
28281 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
28283 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
28284 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
28285 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
28286 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
28287 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
28290 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
28291 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
28294 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
28295 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
28296 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
28297 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
28298 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
28299 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
28301 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
28302 not any of the chain from CA to it.
28304 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
28307 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
28308 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
28309 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
28311 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
28312 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
28313 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
28319 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
28320 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
28321 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
28322 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
28323 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
28324 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
28325 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
28326 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
28327 within the &(smtp)& transport.
28329 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
28330 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
28331 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
28332 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
28333 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
28335 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
28336 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
28337 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
28338 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
28339 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
28342 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
28343 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
28344 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
28345 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
28346 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
28347 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
28348 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
28349 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
28350 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
28351 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
28354 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
28355 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
28356 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
28357 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
28359 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
28360 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
28362 the system default set (depending on library version),
28364 or (depending on library version) a directory.
28365 The client verifies the server's certificate
28366 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
28367 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
28368 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
28369 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
28371 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
28372 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
28373 or need not succeed respectively.
28375 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
28376 checks are made: that the host name (the one in the DNS A record)
28377 is valid for the certificate.
28378 The option defaults to always checking.
28380 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
28381 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
28382 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
28384 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
28385 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
28386 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
28389 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
28390 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
28391 for OCSP to be relevant.
28394 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
28395 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
28396 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
28397 alternative hosts, if any.
28400 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
28401 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
28402 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
28406 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28407 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
28408 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
28409 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
28410 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
28412 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
28413 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
28414 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
28415 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
28416 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
28417 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
28418 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
28419 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
28420 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
28421 outgoing connection.
28425 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
28426 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
28427 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
28428 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
28429 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
28430 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
28431 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
28432 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
28433 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
28434 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
28437 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
28438 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
28441 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
28442 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
28443 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
28444 be of limited use in that environment.
28446 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
28447 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
28448 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
28449 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
28450 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
28452 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
28453 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
28454 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
28455 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
28456 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
28458 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
28459 received from a client.
28460 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
28462 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
28463 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
28464 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
28467 &%tls_certificate%&
28473 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
28478 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
28479 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
28480 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
28481 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
28482 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI is arrived, so
28483 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
28484 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
28486 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
28489 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
28490 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
28491 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
28492 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
28494 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
28495 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
28496 built, then you have SNI support).
28500 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
28502 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
28503 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
28504 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
28505 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
28506 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
28507 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
28508 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
28509 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
28510 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
28511 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
28513 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
28514 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
28515 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
28516 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
28517 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
28518 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
28519 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
28521 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
28522 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
28523 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
28524 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
28525 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
28526 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
28527 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
28528 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
28529 and delay other deliveries to that host.
28531 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
28532 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
28533 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
28534 information is recorded.
28536 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
28537 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
28538 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
28543 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
28544 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
28545 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
28546 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
28547 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
28548 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
28550 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
28551 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
28552 document is currently at
28554 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
28556 and their FAQ is at
28558 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
28561 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
28562 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
28564 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
28565 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
28566 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
28567 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
28570 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
28571 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
28572 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
28573 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
28574 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
28575 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
28576 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
28577 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
28578 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
28579 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
28580 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
28581 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
28582 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
28584 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
28585 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
28586 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
28587 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
28591 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
28592 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
28593 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
28594 with OpenSSL, like this:
28595 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
28596 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
28598 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
28601 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
28602 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
28603 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
28604 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
28605 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
28606 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
28607 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
28609 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
28610 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
28611 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
28612 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
28613 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
28614 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
28616 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
28617 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
28618 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
28619 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
28620 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
28621 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
28622 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
28623 be a sensible resolution).
28625 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
28626 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
28627 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
28629 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
28630 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
28631 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
28632 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
28633 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
28634 signed with that self-signed certificate.
28636 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
28637 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
28638 Open-source PKI book, available online at
28639 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
28640 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
28641 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
28645 .section DANE "SECDANE"
28647 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
28648 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
28649 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
28650 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
28651 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
28652 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
28654 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
28655 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
28656 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
28658 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
28659 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
28661 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and side-channel communicate) copies of server certificates
28662 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
28663 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
28665 DANE requires a server operator to do three things: 1) run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
28666 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
28667 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
28669 2) add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
28670 3) offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
28672 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
28673 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
28674 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
28675 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
28677 The TLSA record for the server may have "certificate usage" of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
28678 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
28679 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
28680 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
28681 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
28682 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
28684 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
28685 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
28686 does require careful arrangement.
28687 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
28688 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
28689 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
28690 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
28691 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
28693 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
28694 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
28696 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
28697 "MTA-STS", described below.
28699 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
28700 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
28701 connections to you.
28702 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
28703 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
28704 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
28705 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
28706 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
28707 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
28709 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
28710 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
28711 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
28712 random serial numbers.
28713 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
28714 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
28715 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
28716 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
28718 The TLSA record should have a Selector field of SPKI(1) and a Matching Type field of SHA2-512(2).
28720 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
28721 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records; and commands like
28724 openssl x509 -in -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
28725 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
28730 are workable for 4th-field hashes.
28732 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
28734 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
28735 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
28736 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
28737 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
28739 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
28740 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
28742 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
28743 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
28744 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
28747 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
28748 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
28752 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
28753 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
28754 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
28755 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
28756 control the OCSP request.
28758 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
28759 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
28762 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
28763 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
28764 The require variant will result in failure if the target host is not DNSSEC-secured.
28766 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
28768 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using dnssec.
28769 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
28770 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
28771 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
28773 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
28774 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
28775 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
28776 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
28777 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
28778 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
28779 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
28781 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
28785 tls_try_verify_hosts
28786 tls_verify_certificates
28788 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
28791 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
28792 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
28794 Currently the &%dnssec_request_domains%& must be active and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
28796 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
28798 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
28799 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
28800 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
28801 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
28803 .cindex DANE reporting
28804 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
28805 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
28806 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
28807 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
28808 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
28809 Section 4.3 of that document.
28811 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
28813 DANE is specified in published RFCs and decouples certificate authority trust
28814 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
28815 to get through". There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS, which
28816 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website. At the
28817 time this text was last updated, MTA-STS was still a draft, not yet an RFC.
28818 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
28819 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
28820 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
28823 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
28824 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
28825 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
28827 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
28828 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
28829 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
28830 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
28831 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
28832 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
28833 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
28837 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28838 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28840 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
28841 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
28842 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
28843 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
28844 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
28845 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
28846 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
28847 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
28848 one very small ACL:
28852 accept hosts = one.host.only
28854 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
28855 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
28857 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
28858 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
28859 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
28860 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
28861 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
28862 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
28863 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
28864 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
28867 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
28868 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
28869 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
28872 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
28873 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
28874 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
28875 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
28876 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
28877 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28878 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
28879 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
28880 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28881 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28882 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
28883 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
28884 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
28885 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
28886 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
28887 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
28888 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28889 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28890 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
28891 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
28894 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
28895 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
28896 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
28897 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
28898 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
28899 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
28900 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
28901 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
28902 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
28903 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
28904 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
28905 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
28906 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
28907 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
28908 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
28909 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
28910 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
28911 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
28912 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
28913 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
28916 For example, if you set
28918 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
28920 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
28921 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
28922 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
28923 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
28924 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
28925 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
28926 testing as possible at RCPT time.
28929 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
28930 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
28931 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
28932 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
28933 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
28934 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
28935 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
28936 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
28937 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
28938 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
28939 in any of these ACLs.
28941 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
28942 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
28943 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
28944 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
28945 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
28946 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
28947 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
28948 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
28950 control = suppress_local_fixups
28952 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
28953 run, it is too late.
28955 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
28956 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
28958 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
28959 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
28960 temporary error for these kinds of message.
28963 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
28964 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
28965 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
28966 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
28967 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
28968 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
28969 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
28970 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
28971 &%smtp_banner%& option.
28974 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
28975 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
28976 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
28977 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
28978 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
28979 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
28980 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
28981 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
28982 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
28984 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
28985 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
28986 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
28988 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
28989 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
28990 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
28991 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
28995 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
28996 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
28997 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
28998 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
28999 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
29000 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
29001 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
29002 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
29003 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
29004 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
29006 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
29007 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
29008 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
29009 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
29010 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
29011 associated with the DATA command.
29013 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
29014 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
29015 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
29016 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
29017 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
29018 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
29019 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
29020 the data specified is received.
29022 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
29023 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
29024 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
29025 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
29026 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
29029 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
29030 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
29031 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
29032 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
29034 .section "The SMTP DKIM ACL" "SECTDKIMACL"
29035 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
29036 enabled (which is the default).
29038 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
29039 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
29040 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
29042 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29044 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
29047 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
29048 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
29049 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
29051 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29054 .section "The SMTP PRDR ACL" "SECTPRDRACL"
29055 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
29056 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
29057 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
29058 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
29059 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
29060 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
29063 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
29064 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
29065 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
29066 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
29067 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
29068 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
29069 for some or all recipients.
29071 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
29072 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
29073 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
29074 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
29075 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
29077 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
29078 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
29079 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
29081 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
29082 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
29084 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
29085 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
29086 the feature was not requested by the client.
29088 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
29089 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
29090 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
29091 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
29092 does not in fact control any access.
29093 For this reason, it may only accept
29094 or warn as its final result.
29096 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
29097 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
29098 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
29099 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
29101 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
29102 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
29104 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
29105 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
29108 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
29109 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
29110 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
29111 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
29112 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
29115 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
29116 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
29117 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
29118 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
29119 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
29120 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
29121 situation even worse.
29123 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
29124 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
29125 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
29128 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
29129 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
29130 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
29131 connection. The possible values are:
29133 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
29134 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
29135 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
29136 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
29137 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
29138 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
29139 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
29140 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
29141 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
29142 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
29144 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
29145 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
29146 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
29147 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
29148 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
29152 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
29153 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
29154 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
29155 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
29157 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
29158 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
29160 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
29161 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
29162 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
29163 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
29164 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
29166 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
29167 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
29168 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
29171 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
29172 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
29173 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
29174 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
29175 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
29176 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
29178 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
29179 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
29180 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
29182 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
29183 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
29184 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
29185 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
29187 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
29188 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
29189 matches the string.
29191 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
29192 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
29193 want to have something like
29195 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
29197 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
29198 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
29204 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
29205 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
29206 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
29207 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
29208 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
29209 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
29210 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
29211 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
29212 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
29214 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
29215 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
29216 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
29219 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
29220 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
29221 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
29222 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
29224 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
29225 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
29226 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
29227 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
29228 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
29229 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
29230 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
29232 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
29233 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
29236 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
29237 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
29238 recipients; it may create new recipients.
29242 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
29243 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
29244 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
29245 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
29246 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
29247 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
29249 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
29250 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
29251 used to accept or reject anything.
29253 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
29254 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
29255 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
29256 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
29258 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
29259 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
29260 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
29261 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
29262 configuration file.
29267 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
29268 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
29270 .vindex &$local_part$&
29271 .vindex &$sender_address$&
29272 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
29273 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29274 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
29275 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
29276 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
29277 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
29278 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
29279 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29281 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
29282 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
29283 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
29286 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
29287 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
29288 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
29289 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
29290 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
29293 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
29294 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
29295 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
29296 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
29297 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
29298 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
29299 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
29300 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
29306 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
29307 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
29308 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
29309 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
29310 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
29311 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
29312 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
29313 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
29314 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
29315 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
29316 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
29317 unencrypted connections.
29320 accept encrypted = *
29321 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
29323 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
29325 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
29326 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
29327 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
29328 option to do this.)
29332 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
29333 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
29334 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
29335 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
29336 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
29337 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
29338 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
29340 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
29341 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
29342 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
29345 deny dnslists = list1.example
29346 dnslists = list2.example
29348 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
29349 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
29350 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
29351 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
29352 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
29355 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
29356 The ACL verbs are as follows:
29359 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
29360 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
29361 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
29362 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
29363 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
29364 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
29365 check a RCPT command:
29367 accept domains = +local_domains
29371 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
29372 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
29373 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
29374 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
29377 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
29378 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
29379 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
29382 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
29383 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
29384 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
29385 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
29386 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
29387 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
29389 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
29390 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
29392 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
29393 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
29394 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
29396 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
29397 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
29398 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
29403 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
29404 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
29405 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
29406 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
29407 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
29408 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
29409 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
29413 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
29414 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
29415 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
29418 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
29420 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
29424 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
29425 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
29426 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
29427 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
29428 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
29429 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
29430 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
29431 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
29432 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
29434 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
29435 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
29436 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
29440 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
29441 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
29442 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
29444 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
29445 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
29447 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
29448 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
29451 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
29452 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
29453 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
29454 example, when checking a RCPT command,
29456 require message = Sender did not verify
29459 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
29460 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
29461 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
29462 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
29465 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
29466 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
29467 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
29468 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
29469 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
29470 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
29471 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
29473 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
29474 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
29475 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
29476 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
29477 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29479 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
29480 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
29481 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
29482 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
29483 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
29484 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
29488 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29489 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
29490 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
29491 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
29493 warn !verify = sender
29494 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
29498 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
29500 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
29501 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
29502 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
29503 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
29504 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
29508 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
29509 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
29510 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
29511 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
29512 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
29513 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
29514 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
29515 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
29516 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
29517 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
29519 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
29520 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
29521 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
29522 on the same SMTP connection.
29524 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
29525 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
29526 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
29529 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
29530 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
29531 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
29533 accept hosts = whatever
29534 set acl_m4 = some value
29535 accept authenticated = *
29536 set acl_c_auth = yes
29538 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
29539 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
29540 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
29542 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
29543 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
29544 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
29545 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
29546 error is generated.
29548 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
29549 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
29552 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
29553 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
29554 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
29555 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
29557 deny domains = *.dom.example
29558 !verify = recipient
29560 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
29561 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
29562 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
29563 two statements are equivalent:
29565 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
29566 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
29568 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
29569 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
29571 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
29572 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
29573 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
29575 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29576 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
29577 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
29578 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
29580 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
29581 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
29582 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
29583 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
29584 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
29585 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
29586 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
29588 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
29589 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
29590 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
29591 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
29592 message is handled.
29594 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
29595 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
29596 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
29597 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
29599 require message = Can't verify sender
29601 message = Can't verify recipient
29603 message = This message cannot be used
29605 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
29606 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
29607 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
29608 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
29609 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
29610 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
29612 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
29613 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
29614 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
29615 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
29618 !senders = *@my.domain.example
29619 message = Invalid sender from client host
29621 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
29622 by which time Exim has set up the message.
29626 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
29627 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
29628 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
29631 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29632 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
29633 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
29634 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
29636 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29637 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
29638 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
29639 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
29640 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
29641 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
29642 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
29643 write rather ugly lines like this:
29645 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
29647 Instead, all you need is
29649 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
29652 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29653 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29654 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
29655 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
29656 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
29657 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
29658 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
29659 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
29661 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
29662 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
29663 in several different ways. For example:
29665 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
29666 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
29667 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
29671 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
29673 accept ...some conditions
29674 control = queue_only
29676 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
29677 other words, when the conditions are all true.
29680 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
29682 accept ...some conditions...
29683 control = queue_only
29684 ...some more conditions...
29686 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
29687 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
29688 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
29692 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
29693 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
29696 warn ...some conditions...
29700 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
29701 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
29705 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
29706 &%require%& verb. For example:
29708 require control = no_multiline_responses
29712 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
29713 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
29715 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
29716 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
29717 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
29718 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
29719 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
29720 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
29722 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
29725 deny ...some conditions...
29728 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
29729 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
29732 ...some conditions...
29734 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
29735 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
29737 warn ...some conditions...
29743 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
29744 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
29745 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
29746 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
29747 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
29748 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
29749 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
29753 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
29754 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
29755 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
29756 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
29757 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
29758 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
29759 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
29762 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29763 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
29764 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
29765 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
29767 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
29768 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
29770 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
29773 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
29774 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
29776 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
29777 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
29778 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
29781 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
29782 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
29783 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
29784 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
29785 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
29786 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
29789 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29790 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
29791 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
29794 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
29795 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
29796 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
29797 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
29798 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
29799 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
29801 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
29802 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
29803 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
29804 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
29805 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
29806 logging rejections.
29809 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
29810 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
29811 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
29812 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
29813 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
29814 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
29815 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
29816 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
29818 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
29819 &` log_reject_target =`&
29821 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
29822 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
29826 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29827 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
29828 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
29829 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
29830 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
29831 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
29832 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
29835 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
29836 &` control = freeze`&
29837 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
29839 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
29840 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
29841 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
29844 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
29845 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
29849 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29850 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
29851 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
29852 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
29853 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
29854 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
29855 &%accept%& for details.)
29857 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
29858 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
29859 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
29860 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
29861 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
29863 require message = Host not recognized
29866 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
29869 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
29870 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
29871 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
29872 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
29873 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
29874 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
29875 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
29876 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
29877 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
29880 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
29881 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
29882 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
29884 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
29885 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
29887 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
29888 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
29889 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
29892 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
29893 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
29895 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
29896 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
29897 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
29900 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
29901 For ACLs that are called by an &%acl =%& ACL condition, the message is
29902 stored in &$acl_verify_message$&, from which the calling ACL may use it.
29904 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
29905 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
29906 However, the original message is available in the variable
29907 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
29908 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
29909 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
29910 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
29912 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
29913 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
29914 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
29915 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
29916 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
29917 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
29921 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29922 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
29923 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
29924 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
29926 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
29928 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
29929 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
29930 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
29931 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
29934 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
29935 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
29936 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
29937 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
29940 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
29941 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
29942 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
29943 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
29946 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
29947 .cindex "UDP communications"
29948 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
29949 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
29950 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
29951 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
29952 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
29953 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
29954 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
29957 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
29958 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
29965 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
29966 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
29967 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
29970 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
29971 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
29972 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
29973 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
29974 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
29975 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
29976 not work without it. For example:
29978 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
29979 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
29981 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
29982 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
29983 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
29984 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
29985 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
29988 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
29989 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
29990 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
29991 .cindex "case of local parts"
29992 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29993 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
29994 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
29995 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
29996 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
29997 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
30000 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
30001 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
30002 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
30003 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
30004 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
30006 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
30007 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
30010 warn control = caseful_local_part
30011 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
30013 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
30015 control = caselower_local_part
30017 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
30018 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
30021 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
30022 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
30023 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
30024 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
30026 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
30027 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
30028 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
30029 is used for all recipients of the message,
30030 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
30031 and data is copied from one to the other.
30033 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
30034 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
30035 If a recipient-verify callout
30037 connection is subsequently
30038 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
30039 any subsequent recipients and the data,
30040 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
30042 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
30043 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
30044 Note also that headers cannot be
30045 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
30046 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
30047 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
30048 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
30049 this will affect the timestamp.
30051 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
30052 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
30053 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
30054 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
30057 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
30058 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
30059 before the entire message has been received from the source.
30060 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
30064 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
30065 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
30066 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
30067 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
30068 before the acceptance "<=" line.
30070 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
30072 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
30073 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
30074 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
30075 and does not queue the message.
30076 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
30078 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
30080 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
30083 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
30084 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
30085 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
30086 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
30087 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
30088 by default called &'debuglog'&.
30089 The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
30090 may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
30091 the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
30093 Logging started this way may be stopped, and the file removed,
30094 with the &'kill'& option.
30095 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
30099 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
30100 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
30101 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
30102 control = debug/kill
30106 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
30107 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
30108 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
30109 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
30110 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30113 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
30114 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
30115 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
30116 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
30117 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
30118 strings or to numeric value.
30119 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
30120 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
30121 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
30123 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
30124 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
30125 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
30126 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
30127 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
30130 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
30131 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
30132 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
30133 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
30134 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
30135 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
30136 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
30137 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
30139 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
30140 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
30141 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
30142 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
30143 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
30144 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
30148 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
30149 .cindex "fake defer"
30150 .cindex "defer, fake"
30151 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
30152 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
30153 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
30154 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
30155 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
30157 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
30158 .cindex "fake rejection"
30159 .cindex "rejection, fake"
30160 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
30161 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
30162 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
30163 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
30164 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30165 the same SMTP connection.
30167 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
30168 message is supplied, the following is used:
30170 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
30171 550-kept for evaluation.
30172 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
30173 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
30175 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
30177 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
30178 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
30179 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30180 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30181 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
30182 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
30185 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
30186 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
30187 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
30188 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
30190 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
30191 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
30192 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
30193 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30194 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
30195 disables such output flushing.
30197 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
30198 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
30199 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
30200 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
30201 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
30202 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
30204 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
30205 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
30206 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
30207 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
30208 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
30209 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
30210 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
30211 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
30212 to be useful in production.
30214 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
30215 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
30216 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
30217 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
30218 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
30220 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
30221 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
30222 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
30223 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
30224 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
30225 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
30228 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
30229 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
30230 verification failed"&) is sent.
30232 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
30236 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
30237 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
30239 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
30240 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
30241 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
30242 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
30243 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
30244 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
30245 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
30247 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
30248 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
30249 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
30250 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
30251 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
30252 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
30253 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
30254 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
30255 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
30256 same SMTP connection.
30258 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
30259 .cindex "message" "submission"
30260 .cindex "submission mode"
30261 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
30262 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
30263 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
30264 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
30265 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
30266 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
30267 late (the message has already been created).
30269 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
30270 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
30271 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
30272 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
30273 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
30275 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
30276 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
30277 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
30278 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
30279 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
30282 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
30283 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
30285 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
30287 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
30290 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
30291 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
30292 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
30293 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
30296 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
30297 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
30299 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
30300 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message addresses
30302 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
30306 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
30307 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
30310 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
30312 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
30313 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
30315 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
30317 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
30322 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
30323 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
30324 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
30325 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
30326 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
30327 to an incoming message, as in this example:
30329 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
30330 dialup.mail-abuse.org
30331 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
30333 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30334 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30335 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30336 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
30337 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
30340 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
30341 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30343 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
30344 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
30345 contains one or more newlines that
30346 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
30347 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
30348 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
30350 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30351 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30352 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
30353 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
30354 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
30355 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
30356 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
30357 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
30358 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
30359 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
30360 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
30362 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
30363 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
30365 until they are added to the
30366 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
30367 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
30368 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
30369 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
30370 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
30371 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
30372 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30374 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
30376 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30377 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30379 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30380 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30382 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30383 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
30385 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
30386 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
30387 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
30388 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
30391 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
30392 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
30393 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
30394 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
30395 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
30396 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
30397 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
30400 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
30401 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
30402 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
30403 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
30404 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
30406 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
30407 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
30408 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
30409 to be a header name first.) For example:
30411 warn add_header = \
30412 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
30414 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
30415 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
30416 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
30417 up in reverse order.
30419 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30420 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
30421 system filter or in a router or transport.
30425 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
30426 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
30427 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
30428 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
30429 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
30430 from an incoming message, as in this example:
30432 warn message = Remove internal headers
30433 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30435 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
30436 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
30437 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
30438 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
30439 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
30440 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
30442 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
30443 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
30445 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
30446 list of header names. The header matching is case insensitive. Wildcards are
30447 not permitted, nor is list expansion performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
30448 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
30449 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
30451 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
30452 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
30453 warn message = Remove internal headers
30454 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
30456 Header names for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
30457 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
30458 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
30459 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
30460 a non-existent header. Further header lines to be removed may be accumulated
30461 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are removed from the message,
30462 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, headers to be removed are
30463 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are removed from the message after
30464 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
30465 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
30466 would have been removed.
30468 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
30469 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
30470 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
30471 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
30472 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
30473 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
30474 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
30475 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
30476 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
30478 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
30479 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
30481 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
30482 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
30484 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
30485 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
30487 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
30488 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
30489 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
30490 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
30493 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
30494 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
30495 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
30500 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
30501 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
30502 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
30503 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
30504 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
30505 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30507 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
30508 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
30509 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
30510 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
30511 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
30512 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
30513 The conditions are as follows:
30517 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
30518 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
30519 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
30520 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
30521 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
30522 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
30523 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
30524 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
30525 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
30526 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
30527 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
30528 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
30530 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
30531 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
30532 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
30533 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
30534 The name and values are expanded separately.
30535 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
30536 will act as argument separators.
30538 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
30539 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
30540 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
30541 conditions are tested.
30543 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
30544 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
30545 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
30546 for different local users or different local domains.
30548 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30549 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
30550 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
30551 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
30552 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
30553 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
30554 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
30559 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
30560 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
30561 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
30562 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
30563 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
30564 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
30565 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
30566 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
30567 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
30568 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
30569 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
30570 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
30573 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
30574 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
30575 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30576 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30577 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
30578 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
30579 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
30580 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30582 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
30583 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
30584 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30585 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30586 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30587 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
30588 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
30589 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
30590 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
30591 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
30593 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30594 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
30595 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
30596 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
30597 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
30598 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
30599 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
30600 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
30601 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
30604 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
30605 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
30608 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
30609 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
30610 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
30611 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
30612 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
30613 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
30614 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
30620 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
30621 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
30622 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
30623 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
30624 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
30625 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
30626 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
30628 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30630 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
30631 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
30632 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
30634 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
30635 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
30636 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
30637 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
30638 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
30639 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
30641 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
30642 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
30644 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
30645 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
30647 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
30648 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
30649 statement can then check the IP address.
30651 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
30652 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
30653 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
30654 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
30656 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
30657 message = $host_data
30659 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
30661 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
30662 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
30663 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
30664 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
30665 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
30666 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
30667 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
30668 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
30669 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
30670 the next &%local_parts%& test.
30672 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
30673 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
30674 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
30675 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
30676 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30677 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
30678 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30680 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30681 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
30682 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30683 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30684 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
30685 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
30686 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
30689 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
30690 .cindex "rate limiting"
30691 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
30692 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
30694 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30695 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
30696 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
30697 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
30698 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
30699 recipient address against a list of recipients.
30701 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
30702 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
30703 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
30704 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30705 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
30706 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
30707 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30709 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
30710 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
30711 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30712 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
30713 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30714 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
30715 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
30716 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
30717 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
30718 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
30719 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
30720 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
30721 influence the sender checking.
30723 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30724 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30726 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
30727 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
30728 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
30729 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
30730 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
30731 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
30735 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
30736 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
30738 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
30739 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
30740 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
30741 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30742 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
30743 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30745 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
30746 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30747 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
30748 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
30749 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
30750 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
30751 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
30752 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
30753 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
30754 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
30756 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
30757 .cindex "CSA verification"
30758 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
30759 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
30760 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
30762 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
30763 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30764 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30765 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
30766 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
30767 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30768 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30769 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
30770 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
30771 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
30773 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
30774 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
30775 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
30777 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
30778 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30779 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
30780 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
30781 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
30782 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
30783 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30784 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30785 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
30786 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
30787 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
30788 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
30789 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
30790 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
30791 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
30793 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
30794 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
30795 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
30796 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
30799 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
30800 !verify = header_sender
30803 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
30804 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30805 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
30806 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
30807 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
30808 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
30809 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
30810 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
30811 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
30812 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
30813 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
30814 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
30815 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
30818 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
30819 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
30823 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
30824 common as they used to be.
30826 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
30827 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30828 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
30829 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
30830 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
30831 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
30832 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
30833 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
30834 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
30835 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
30836 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
30837 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
30838 independently of this condition.
30840 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
30841 option), this condition is always true.
30844 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
30845 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
30846 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
30847 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
30848 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
30849 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
30850 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
30851 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
30852 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
30854 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
30855 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
30858 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
30859 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30860 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
30861 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
30862 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
30863 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30864 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
30865 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
30866 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
30867 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
30868 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
30869 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
30870 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
30871 value for the child address.
30873 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
30874 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30875 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
30876 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
30877 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
30878 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
30879 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
30880 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
30881 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
30882 original IP address.
30884 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
30885 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
30887 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
30888 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
30890 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
30891 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30892 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
30893 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
30894 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
30895 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
30896 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
30897 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
30898 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
30900 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
30901 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
30902 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
30903 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
30904 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
30905 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
30906 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
30908 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
30909 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
30910 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
30912 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
30913 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
30914 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
30915 verified as a sender.
30917 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
30918 (eg. is generated from the received message)
30919 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
30921 verify = sender=${sg{${address:$h_sender:}}{/}{//}}
30927 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
30928 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
30929 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
30930 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
30931 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
30932 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
30933 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
30934 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
30935 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
30936 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
30938 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
30939 dialups.mail-abuse.org
30941 the following records are looked up:
30943 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30944 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
30946 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
30947 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
30948 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
30949 use two separate conditions:
30951 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30952 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30954 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
30955 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
30956 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
30959 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
30960 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
30961 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
30962 following special items in the list:
30964 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
30965 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
30966 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
30968 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
30969 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
30970 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
30971 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
30973 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
30975 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
30976 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
30978 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
30979 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
30980 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
30982 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
30984 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
30985 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
30986 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
30987 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
30988 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
30989 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
30991 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
30992 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
30993 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
30997 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
30998 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
30999 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
31000 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
31001 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
31003 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
31005 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
31006 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
31007 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
31008 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
31013 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
31014 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
31015 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
31016 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
31017 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
31018 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
31019 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
31021 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
31022 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31024 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
31025 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
31026 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
31027 up by this example is
31029 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
31031 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
31032 addresses. For example:
31034 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31035 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
31037 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
31038 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
31043 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
31044 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
31045 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
31046 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
31047 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
31048 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
31049 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
31050 either to double the separators like this:
31052 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
31054 or to change the separator character, like this:
31056 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
31058 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
31059 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
31060 occurs. Consider this condition:
31062 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
31064 The DNS lookups that occur are:
31066 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
31067 a.domain.black.list.tld
31069 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
31070 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
31071 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
31072 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
31073 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
31074 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
31075 error for a previous item.
31077 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
31078 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
31080 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
31081 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
31083 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
31084 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
31086 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
31087 $sender_address_domain \
31088 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
31090 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
31091 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
31092 $sender_address_domain} }} }
31094 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
31095 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
31096 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
31097 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
31099 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
31101 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
31102 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
31104 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
31105 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
31110 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
31111 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
31112 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
31113 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
31114 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
31115 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
31119 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
31121 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
31122 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
31123 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
31125 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
31126 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
31127 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
31130 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
31131 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
31132 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
31133 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
31134 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
31135 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
31136 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
31137 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
31138 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
31139 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
31140 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
31141 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
31142 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
31143 cases, for example:
31145 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
31147 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
31148 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
31149 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
31150 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
31152 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
31154 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
31155 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
31157 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
31158 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
31159 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
31160 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
31161 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
31164 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
31165 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
31166 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
31168 deny hosts = !+local_networks
31169 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
31171 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
31176 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
31177 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
31178 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
31179 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
31182 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
31184 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
31185 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
31186 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
31187 describes how multiple records are handled.
31189 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
31190 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
31191 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
31193 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31195 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
31196 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
31197 first. For example:
31199 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
31200 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
31203 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
31204 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
31205 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
31206 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
31207 tested. For example:
31209 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
31211 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
31212 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
31213 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
31215 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31217 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
31222 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
31223 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
31226 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31228 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31229 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
31231 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31233 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
31234 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
31235 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
31236 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
31238 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
31239 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
31241 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
31242 previous example is precisely equivalent to
31244 deny dnslists = a.b.c
31245 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
31247 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
31248 Consider this example:
31250 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31252 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
31255 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
31257 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
31259 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
31260 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
31261 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
31263 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
31268 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
31269 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
31270 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
31271 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
31272 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
31273 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
31275 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
31277 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
31278 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
31279 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
31280 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
31281 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
31282 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
31285 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
31286 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
31287 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31289 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
31290 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
31293 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
31295 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31296 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
31298 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
31300 for the condition to be true.
31303 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
31304 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
31306 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
31307 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
31309 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
31311 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31312 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
31314 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
31315 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
31317 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
31319 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
31320 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
31322 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
31324 for the condition to be false.
31326 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
31327 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
31332 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
31333 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
31334 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
31335 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
31336 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
31337 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
31338 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
31339 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
31340 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
31343 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
31344 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
31345 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
31346 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
31347 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
31348 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
31349 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
31352 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
31353 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
31355 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
31356 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31358 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
31359 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
31360 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
31361 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
31362 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
31363 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
31365 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
31366 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
31367 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
31370 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
31371 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
31372 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
31373 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
31375 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
31376 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
31377 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
31381 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
31382 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
31383 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
31384 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
31385 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
31386 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
31388 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
31389 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31391 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
31392 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
31393 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
31395 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
31397 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
31398 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
31400 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
31401 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
31403 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
31404 dnslists = some.list.example
31407 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
31408 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
31409 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
31411 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
31414 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
31415 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
31416 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
31417 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
31418 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
31419 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
31420 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
31421 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
31422 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
31423 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
31425 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
31427 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
31428 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
31430 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
31431 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
31432 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
31435 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
31436 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
31437 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
31438 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
31439 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
31440 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
31441 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
31442 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
31443 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
31445 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
31446 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
31447 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
31448 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
31450 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
31451 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
31452 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
31453 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
31454 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
31455 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
31456 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
31457 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
31458 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
31459 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
31461 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
31462 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
31463 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
31466 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
31467 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
31468 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
31469 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
31470 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
31471 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
31473 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
31474 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
31475 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
31476 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
31477 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
31478 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
31479 the &%count=%& option.
31482 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
31483 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
31484 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
31485 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
31486 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
31488 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
31489 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
31490 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
31491 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
31493 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
31494 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
31495 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
31496 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
31497 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
31498 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
31499 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
31501 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
31502 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
31503 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACLs. In
31504 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
31505 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
31506 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
31507 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
31509 The &%per_addr%& option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
31510 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
31511 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
31512 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
31515 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
31516 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
31517 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
31518 multiple different commands.
31520 The &%count=%& option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
31521 measured rate. For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
31522 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&. If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
31523 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
31524 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&). The count does not have to be an integer.
31526 The &%unique=%& option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
31529 .section "Ratelimit update modes" "ratoptupd"
31530 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
31531 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
31532 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
31533 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
31535 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
31536 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
31538 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
31539 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
31540 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
31541 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
31545 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
31546 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31547 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31550 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
31551 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
31552 (max $sender_rate_limit)
31555 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
31556 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
31557 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
31558 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
31559 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
31560 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
31563 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
31564 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
31565 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
31566 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
31567 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
31570 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratoptfast"
31571 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
31572 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
31573 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
31574 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
31575 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
31578 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
31579 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
31580 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
31581 up to the given limit.
31582 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
31583 consists of refusing the message, and
31584 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
31585 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
31586 likely not what is wanted.
31588 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
31589 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
31590 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
31591 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
31592 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
31593 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
31594 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
31595 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
31597 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
31601 .section "Limiting the rate of different events" "ratoptuniq"
31602 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
31603 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
31604 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
31605 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
31606 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
31607 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
31608 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
31609 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
31611 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
31612 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
31613 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
31614 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
31615 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
31616 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
31618 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
31619 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
31622 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
31623 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
31624 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
31625 required increases with larger limits.
31627 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
31628 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
31629 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
31630 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
31631 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
31632 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
31633 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
31634 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
31635 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
31639 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
31640 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
31641 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
31642 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
31643 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
31644 message. For example:
31646 # Log all senders' rates
31647 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
31648 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
31650 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
31651 # at the decimal point.
31652 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
31653 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
31654 $sender_rate_limit }s
31656 # Keep authenticated users under control
31657 deny authenticated = *
31658 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
31660 # System-wide rate limit
31661 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
31662 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
31664 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
31665 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
31666 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
31667 messages per $sender_rate_period
31668 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
31669 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
31670 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
31672 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
31673 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
31674 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
31675 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
31676 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
31677 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
31678 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
31682 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
31683 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
31684 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
31685 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
31686 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
31687 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
31688 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
31689 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
31690 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
31692 verify = sender/callout
31693 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
31695 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
31696 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
31697 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
31698 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
31699 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
31700 The available options are as follows:
31703 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
31704 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
31705 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
31707 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
31708 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
31709 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
31710 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
31712 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
31713 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
31715 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
31716 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
31717 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
31718 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
31721 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
31722 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
31723 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
31724 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31725 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
31726 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
31729 warn !verify = sender
31730 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
31732 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
31733 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
31734 verification failure.
31736 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
31737 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
31740 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
31741 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
31743 &%route%&: Routing failed.
31745 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
31746 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
31747 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
31749 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
31751 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
31754 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
31755 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
31757 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
31758 address verification to:
31761 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
31767 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
31768 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
31769 .cindex "callout" "verification"
31770 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
31771 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
31772 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
31773 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
31774 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
31775 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
31776 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
31777 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
31778 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
31781 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
31782 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
31783 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
31784 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
31785 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
31786 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
31788 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
31789 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
31790 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
31791 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
31792 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
31794 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
31795 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
31796 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
31797 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
31798 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
31799 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
31800 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
31801 supplies a host list.
31802 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
31804 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
31805 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
31806 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
31807 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
31808 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
31809 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
31810 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
31812 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
31813 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
31814 following SMTP commands are sent:
31816 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
31818 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
31821 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
31824 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
31827 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
31828 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
31829 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
31830 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
31831 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
31832 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
31834 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
31835 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
31836 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
31837 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
31838 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
31840 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
31841 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
31842 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
31843 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
31844 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
31849 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
31850 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
31851 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
31852 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
31854 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
31856 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
31857 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
31858 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
31862 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
31863 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
31864 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
31867 verify = sender/callout=5s
31869 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
31870 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
31871 the &%connect%& parameter.
31874 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31875 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
31876 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
31877 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
31879 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
31881 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
31883 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
31884 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
31885 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
31886 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
31887 updated in this circumstance.
31889 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
31890 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
31891 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
31892 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
31893 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
31894 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
31897 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31898 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
31899 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
31900 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
31901 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
31902 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
31903 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
31904 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
31905 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
31906 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
31908 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
31910 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
31913 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
31914 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
31915 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
31918 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
31920 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
31921 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
31922 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
31923 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
31924 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
31927 .vitem &*no_cache*&
31928 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
31929 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
31930 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
31932 .vitem &*postmaster*&
31933 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
31934 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
31935 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
31936 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
31937 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
31938 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
31939 made, until the cache record expires.
31941 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
31942 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
31943 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
31946 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
31948 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
31949 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
31951 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
31953 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
31954 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
31955 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
31956 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
31960 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
31961 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
31962 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
31963 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
31964 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
31966 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
31968 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
31969 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
31970 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
31971 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
31972 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
31974 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
31975 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
31976 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31978 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
31980 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
31981 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
31982 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
31983 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
31984 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
31986 .vitem &*use_sender*&
31987 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
31989 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
31991 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
31992 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
31993 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
31994 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
31995 usefulness of callout caching.
31998 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
32000 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
32002 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
32003 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
32004 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
32005 when that is used for the connections.
32006 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
32007 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
32008 if the use_sender option is used,
32009 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
32010 and if no other callouts intervene.
32013 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
32014 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
32015 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
32016 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
32017 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
32018 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
32019 these circumstances.
32021 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
32022 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
32023 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
32024 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
32025 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
32026 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
32027 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
32029 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
32030 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
32031 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
32032 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
32037 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
32038 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
32039 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
32040 .cindex "caching" "callout"
32041 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
32042 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
32043 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
32044 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
32045 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
32046 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
32048 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
32049 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
32052 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
32053 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
32054 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
32056 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
32057 commands up to and including
32061 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
32062 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
32063 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
32064 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
32065 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
32066 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
32067 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
32069 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
32070 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
32071 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
32072 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
32073 will eventually be noticed.
32075 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
32076 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
32077 behaviour will be the same.
32081 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
32082 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
32083 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
32084 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
32085 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
32086 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
32089 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
32091 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
32092 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
32093 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
32094 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
32095 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
32096 550 Sender verification failed
32098 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
32099 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
32100 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
32101 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
32104 verify = sender/no_details
32107 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
32108 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
32109 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
32110 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
32111 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
32112 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
32113 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
32116 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
32117 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
32118 verification also fails.
32120 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
32121 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
32124 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
32125 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
32126 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
32129 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
32131 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
32132 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
32133 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
32134 verification to succeed.
32136 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
32137 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
32138 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
32139 option. For example:
32141 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
32143 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
32144 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
32146 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
32147 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
32148 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
32149 address and a report is output for each of them.
32153 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
32154 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
32155 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
32156 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
32157 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
32158 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
32159 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
32163 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
32164 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
32165 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
32166 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
32167 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
32168 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
32170 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
32171 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
32172 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
32173 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
32176 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
32178 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
32180 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
32181 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
32183 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
32184 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
32187 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
32188 use for the DNS query. The default is:
32190 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
32192 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
32193 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
32194 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
32195 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
32198 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
32200 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
32201 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
32202 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
32204 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
32205 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
32206 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
32207 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
32208 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
32209 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
32210 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
32211 of legitimate HELO domains.
32213 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
32214 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
32215 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
32216 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
32219 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
32221 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
32222 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
32223 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
32228 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
32229 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
32230 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
32231 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
32232 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
32233 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
32234 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
32235 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
32237 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
32238 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
32239 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
32240 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
32241 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
32242 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
32243 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
32244 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
32246 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
32247 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
32250 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
32251 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
32254 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
32255 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
32258 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
32259 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
32261 recipients = +batv_senders
32263 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
32264 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
32266 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
32267 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
32268 !condition = $prvscheck_result
32270 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
32271 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
32272 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
32273 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
32274 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
32276 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
32277 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
32278 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
32279 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
32280 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
32281 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
32282 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
32284 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
32285 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
32286 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
32287 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
32291 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
32293 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
32294 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
32295 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
32298 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
32301 external_smtp_batv:
32303 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
32304 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
32305 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
32306 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
32309 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
32313 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
32314 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
32315 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
32316 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
32317 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
32318 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
32319 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
32320 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
32321 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
32322 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
32324 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
32325 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
32326 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
32327 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
32328 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
32329 same host is fulfilling both functions,
32331 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
32333 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
32334 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
32335 system to arbitrary domains.
32338 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
32339 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
32340 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
32341 example, suppose you want to do the following:
32344 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
32345 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
32346 &'my.dom2.example'&.
32348 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
32349 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
32351 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
32352 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
32356 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
32358 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
32359 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
32360 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
32362 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
32366 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
32367 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
32369 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
32370 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
32371 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
32372 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
32373 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
32374 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
32375 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
32379 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
32380 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
32381 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
32382 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
32383 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
32388 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32389 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32391 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
32392 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
32393 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
32394 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
32395 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
32396 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
32399 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
32400 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
32401 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
32402 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
32403 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
32405 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
32406 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
32407 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
32410 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
32411 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
32413 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
32414 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
32415 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
32417 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
32418 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
32420 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
32423 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
32426 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
32427 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
32428 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
32429 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
32430 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
32431 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
32433 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
32434 temporarily created in a file called:
32436 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
32438 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
32439 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
32440 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
32441 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
32442 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
32444 control = no_mbox_unspool
32446 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
32447 same directory by default.
32451 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
32452 .cindex "virus scanning"
32453 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
32454 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
32455 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
32456 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
32457 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
32458 in memory and thus are much faster.
32460 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
32461 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
32463 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
32464 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
32465 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
32466 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
32468 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
32470 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
32472 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
32474 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
32476 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
32477 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
32478 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
32482 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
32483 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
32484 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
32485 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
32486 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
32487 This scanner type takes one option,
32488 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32489 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32490 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32491 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32492 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
32493 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
32494 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
32496 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
32497 If &`pass_unscanned`&
32498 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
32499 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
32504 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32505 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
32506 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
32508 If you omit the argument, the default path
32509 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
32511 If you use a remote host,
32512 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
32513 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
32514 For information about available commands and their options you may use
32516 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
32522 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
32523 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
32524 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
32526 .vitem &%aveserver%&
32527 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32528 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
32529 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
32530 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
32533 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
32538 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
32539 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
32540 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
32541 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
32542 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
32544 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
32545 a UNIX socket specification,
32546 a TCP socket specification,
32547 or a (global) option.
32549 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
32550 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
32551 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
32552 and the second a port number,
32553 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
32554 These per-server options are supported:
32556 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32559 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32560 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
32562 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
32566 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
32567 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
32568 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
32569 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
32570 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
32572 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
32574 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
32575 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
32576 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
32577 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
32579 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
32580 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
32581 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
32582 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
32583 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
32584 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
32585 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
32586 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
32587 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
32589 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
32590 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
32591 (Connection refused)
32594 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
32595 contributing the code for this scanner.
32598 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
32599 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
32600 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
32601 type takes 3 mandatory options:
32604 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
32605 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
32608 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
32609 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
32610 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
32611 the &"trigger"& expression.
32614 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
32615 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
32616 &"name"& expression.
32619 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
32621 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
32623 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
32624 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
32625 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
32626 configuration setting:
32628 av_scanner = cmdline:\
32629 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
32630 found in file:'(.+)'
32633 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
32634 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
32636 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
32637 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
32638 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
32639 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
32642 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
32643 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
32645 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
32646 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
32649 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
32650 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
32651 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
32655 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
32657 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
32659 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
32660 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
32661 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
32662 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
32665 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
32667 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
32670 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
32671 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
32672 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
32674 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
32676 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
32677 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
32679 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
32680 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
32681 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
32682 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
32683 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
32686 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
32688 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
32691 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
32692 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
32693 though some documentation was available in English.
32694 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
32695 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
32696 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
32698 The only option for this scanner type is
32699 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
32700 provided that mksd has
32701 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
32703 av_scanner = mksd:2
32705 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
32708 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
32709 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
32710 running on the local machine.
32711 There are four options:
32712 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
32713 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
32714 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
32715 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
32716 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
32719 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
32721 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
32722 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
32723 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
32724 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
32725 specify an empty element to get this.
32728 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
32729 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
32730 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
32731 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
32732 client communication. For example:
32734 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
32736 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
32740 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
32741 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
32744 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
32745 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
32746 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
32747 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
32748 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
32749 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
32752 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
32753 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
32754 The first element can then be one of
32757 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
32758 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
32761 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
32762 the condition fails immediately.
32764 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
32765 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
32766 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
32767 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
32768 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
32771 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
32772 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
32773 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
32775 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
32776 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
32779 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
32781 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
32783 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32784 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32785 is set to record the actual address used.
32787 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
32788 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
32789 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
32790 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
32793 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
32794 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
32796 Here is a very simple scanning example:
32798 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32801 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
32803 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32804 malware = */defer_ok
32806 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
32807 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
32809 av_scanner = $acl_m0
32811 in the main Exim configuration.
32813 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32814 set acl_m0 = sophie
32817 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
32818 set acl_m0 = aveserver
32823 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
32824 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
32825 .cindex "spam scanning"
32826 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
32828 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
32829 score and a report for the message.
32830 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
32832 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
32833 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
32834 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
32836 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
32838 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
32840 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
32841 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
32844 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
32845 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
32846 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
32847 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
32848 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
32849 configuration as follows (example):
32851 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
32853 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
32854 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
32855 iptables firewall, consider setting
32856 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
32857 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
32858 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
32859 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
32863 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
32865 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
32867 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
32870 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
32871 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
32872 filename instead of an address/port pair:
32874 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
32876 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
32877 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
32878 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
32879 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
32881 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
32882 192.168.2.11 783 : \
32885 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
32886 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
32887 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
32890 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
32891 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
32892 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
32893 take care to not double the separator.
32895 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
32896 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
32897 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
32898 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
32900 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
32902 The supported options are:
32904 pri=<priority> Selection priority
32905 weight=<value> Selection bias
32906 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
32907 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
32908 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
32909 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
32912 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
32913 higher values being tried first.
32914 The default priority is 1.
32916 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
32917 Within a priority set
32918 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
32919 The default value for selection bias is 1.
32921 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
32922 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
32923 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
32924 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
32926 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
32927 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
32929 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
32930 The default value is two minutes.
32932 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
32933 a failed connect is made.
32934 The default is to not retry.
32936 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
32937 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
32938 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
32941 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
32942 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
32943 is set to record the actual address used.
32945 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
32946 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
32948 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32951 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
32952 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
32953 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
32954 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
32955 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
32958 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
32959 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
32960 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
32961 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
32962 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
32964 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
32965 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
32967 or the use of PRDR,
32968 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
32969 are needed to use this feature.
32971 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
32972 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
32973 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
32976 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
32977 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
32978 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
32981 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
32982 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
32986 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
32987 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
32988 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
32989 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
32991 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
32992 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
32994 Except for &$spam_report$&,
32995 these variables are saved with the received message so are
32996 available for use at delivery time.
32999 .vitem &$spam_score$&
33000 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
33001 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
33003 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
33004 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
33005 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
33006 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
33007 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
33009 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
33010 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
33011 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
33012 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
33013 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
33014 spam bar is 50 characters.
33016 .vitem &$spam_report$&
33017 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
33018 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
33019 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
33020 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
33021 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
33022 unencoded in headers.
33024 .vitem &$spam_action$&
33025 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
33026 spam score versus threshold.
33027 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
33031 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
33032 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
33033 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
33035 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
33036 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
33037 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
33038 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
33039 spam condition, like this:
33041 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
33042 spam = joe/defer_ok
33044 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
33046 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
33049 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
33050 warn spam = nobody:true
33051 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
33052 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
33054 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
33055 # is over threshold
33057 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
33059 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
33060 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
33062 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
33067 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
33068 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
33069 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
33070 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
33071 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
33072 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
33073 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
33074 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
33075 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
33076 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
33079 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
33080 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
33081 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
33082 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
33083 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
33084 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
33085 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
33087 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
33088 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
33089 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
33090 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
33091 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
33093 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
33094 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
33095 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
33096 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
33097 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
33100 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
33102 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
33106 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
33108 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
33109 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
33110 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
33111 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
33113 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
33114 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
33115 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
33116 the full path and filename.
33118 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
33119 filename, and the default path is then used.
33121 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
33122 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
33123 a file with its original, proposed filename using
33125 decode = $mime_filename
33127 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
33128 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
33129 automatically unlinked.
33131 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
33132 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
33133 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
33134 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
33135 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
33137 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
33138 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
33139 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
33141 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
33142 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
33143 available in the MIME ACL:
33146 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
33147 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
33148 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
33149 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
33150 contains the empty string.
33152 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
33153 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
33154 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
33160 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
33161 case-insensitively.
33163 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
33164 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
33165 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
33166 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
33167 only used for display purposes.
33169 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
33170 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
33171 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
33173 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
33174 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
33175 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
33177 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
33178 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33179 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
33180 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
33181 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
33183 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
33184 This variable contains the normalized content of the
33185 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
33186 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
33188 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
33189 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
33190 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
33191 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
33195 application/octet-stream
33199 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
33202 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
33203 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
33204 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
33205 containing the decoded data.
33210 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
33211 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
33212 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
33213 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
33216 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
33218 found, this variable contains the empty string.
33220 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
33221 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
33222 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
33223 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
33225 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
33226 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
33230 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
33233 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
33234 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
33237 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
33238 and the rest are attachments.
33241 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
33244 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
33245 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
33246 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
33248 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
33249 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
33250 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
33251 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
33253 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
33254 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
33255 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
33256 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
33257 want to carry out specific actions on them.
33259 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
33260 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
33261 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
33262 decoding is fully recursive.
33264 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
33265 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
33266 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
33267 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
33268 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
33269 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
33270 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
33275 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
33276 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
33277 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
33278 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
33279 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
33281 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
33282 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
33283 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
33284 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
33285 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
33287 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
33288 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
33289 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
33290 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
33291 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
33292 32K characters are checked.
33294 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
33295 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
33296 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
33297 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
33298 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
33300 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
33301 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
33303 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
33304 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
33305 matching regular expression.
33306 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
33307 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
33309 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
33317 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33318 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33320 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
33321 "Local scan function"
33322 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
33323 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
33324 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
33325 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
33326 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
33328 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
33329 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
33330 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
33331 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
33332 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
33334 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
33335 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
33336 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
33337 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
33339 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
33340 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
33341 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
33342 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
33344 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
33345 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
33346 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
33347 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
33348 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
33349 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
33350 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
33351 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
33352 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
33356 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
33357 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
33358 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
33359 function is before building Exim, by setting
33360 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
33361 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
33362 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
33363 directory, so you might set
33365 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
33366 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
33368 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
33369 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
33370 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
33371 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
33372 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
33373 _src/local_scan.c_.
33375 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
33376 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
33378 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33380 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
33385 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
33386 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
33387 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
33388 You must include this line near the start of your code:
33390 #include "local_scan.h"
33392 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
33393 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
33394 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
33395 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
33396 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
33397 strings and pointers to character strings:
33399 #define CS (char *)
33400 #define CCS (const char *)
33401 #define CSS (char **)
33402 #define US (unsigned char *)
33403 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
33404 #define USS (unsigned char **)
33406 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
33408 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
33410 The arguments are as follows:
33413 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
33414 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
33415 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
33417 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
33418 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
33419 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
33420 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
33421 case this changes in some future version.
33423 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
33424 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
33427 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
33430 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
33431 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
33432 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
33433 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
33434 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
33435 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
33437 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
33438 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33439 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
33441 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
33442 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
33443 queued without immediate delivery.
33445 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
33446 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
33447 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
33448 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
33449 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
33452 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
33453 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
33454 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
33457 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33458 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
33459 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
33460 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
33461 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
33462 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
33463 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33465 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
33466 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
33467 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
33470 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
33471 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
33472 &%-oe%& command line options.
33476 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
33477 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
33478 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
33479 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
33480 want to do this, you must have the line
33482 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
33484 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
33485 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
33486 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
33489 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
33490 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
33491 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
33492 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
33493 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
33494 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
33496 static int my_integer_option = 42;
33497 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
33499 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
33500 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
33501 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
33504 int local_scan_options_count =
33505 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
33507 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
33508 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
33512 my_string = some string of text...
33514 The available types of option data are as follows:
33517 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
33518 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
33519 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
33520 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
33521 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
33522 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
33525 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
33526 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
33527 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
33528 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
33531 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
33532 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
33535 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
33536 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
33537 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
33538 printed with the suffix K or M.
33540 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
33541 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
33542 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
33543 always output in octal.
33545 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
33546 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
33547 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
33549 .vitem &*opt_time*&
33550 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
33551 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
33554 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
33555 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
33559 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
33560 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
33561 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
33562 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
33563 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
33564 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
33565 C variables are as follows:
33568 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
33569 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
33570 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33572 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
33573 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
33574 It is not valid if the &%spool_files_wireformat%& option is used.
33576 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
33577 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
33578 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
33579 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
33582 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
33583 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
33584 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
33587 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
33588 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
33592 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
33593 selected, you should use code like this:
33595 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33596 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33598 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
33599 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
33600 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
33602 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
33603 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
33606 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
33607 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
33609 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
33610 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
33612 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
33613 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
33614 &%-bh%& command line option.
33616 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
33617 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
33618 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
33620 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
33621 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
33622 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
33623 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
33625 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
33626 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
33627 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
33629 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
33630 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
33632 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
33633 The number of accepted recipients.
33635 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
33636 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
33637 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
33638 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
33639 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
33640 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
33641 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
33642 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
33643 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
33644 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
33645 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
33646 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
33648 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
33649 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
33651 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
33652 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
33653 locally-submitted messages.
33655 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
33656 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
33657 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
33659 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
33660 The name of the sending host, if known.
33662 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
33663 The port on the sending host.
33665 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
33666 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
33668 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
33669 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
33671 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
33672 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
33673 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
33677 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
33678 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
33679 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
33680 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
33685 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
33686 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
33688 .vitem &*int&~type*&
33689 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
33690 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
33691 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
33692 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
33693 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
33694 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
33696 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
33697 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
33700 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
33701 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
33702 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
33707 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
33708 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
33711 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
33712 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
33714 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
33715 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
33716 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
33717 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
33719 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
33720 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
33721 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
33722 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
33723 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
33724 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
33725 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
33726 is NULL for all recipients.
33731 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
33732 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
33733 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
33734 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
33738 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
33739 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
33741 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
33742 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
33743 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
33744 for the process in &%newumask%&.
33746 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
33747 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
33748 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
33749 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
33750 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
33752 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
33754 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
33755 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
33756 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
33757 return value is as follows:
33762 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
33768 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
33774 The process timed out.
33778 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
33781 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
33782 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
33783 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
33784 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
33785 forks a subprocess that is running
33787 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
33789 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
33790 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
33791 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
33792 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
33794 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
33795 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
33796 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
33797 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
33800 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
33801 *sender_authentication)*&
33802 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
33805 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
33807 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
33810 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33811 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
33812 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
33813 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
33814 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
33816 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
33817 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
33820 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
33821 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
33822 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
33823 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
33824 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
33825 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
33826 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
33827 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
33829 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
33830 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
33831 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
33832 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
33833 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
33834 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
33836 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33837 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
33838 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
33839 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
33841 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
33842 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
33843 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
33844 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
33845 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
33846 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
33847 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
33848 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
33849 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
33850 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
33852 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
33853 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
33855 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
33856 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
33859 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
33860 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
33861 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
33862 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
33863 match the specification, the function does nothing.
33866 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
33867 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
33868 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
33869 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
33870 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
33871 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
33873 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
33875 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
33876 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
33877 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
33878 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
33879 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
33882 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
33883 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
33884 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
33885 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
33886 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
33887 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
33888 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
33889 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
33891 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
33892 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
33893 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
33895 &`OK `& match succeeded
33896 &`FAIL `& match failed
33897 &`DEFER `& match deferred
33899 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
33900 inability to contact a database.
33902 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33904 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
33905 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
33906 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33908 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
33910 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
33911 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
33912 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
33914 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
33916 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
33919 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
33921 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
33922 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
33923 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
33924 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
33925 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
33926 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
33929 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
33931 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
33932 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
33933 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
33934 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
33935 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
33936 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
33939 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
33940 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
33941 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
33942 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
33944 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
33945 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
33946 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
33947 value afterwards. For example:
33949 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
33950 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
33951 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
33954 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
33955 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
33956 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
33957 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
33964 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
33965 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
33966 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
33967 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
33968 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
33969 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
33970 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
33971 binary string is returned with an error message.
33973 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
33974 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
33975 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
33977 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
33978 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
33979 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
33980 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
33981 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
33983 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
33984 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
33985 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
33987 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
33988 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
33989 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
33990 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
33994 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
33995 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
33998 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
33999 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
34000 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
34001 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
34002 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
34003 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
34004 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
34005 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
34008 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
34009 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
34011 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
34012 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
34013 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
34014 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
34015 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
34016 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
34017 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
34019 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
34020 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
34022 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
34023 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
34024 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
34025 multiple output lines.
34027 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
34028 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
34029 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
34030 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
34031 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
34032 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
34033 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
34036 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
34037 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
34038 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
34039 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34041 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
34042 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
34043 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
34045 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
34048 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
34051 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
34052 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
34053 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
34054 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
34055 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
34056 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
34062 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
34063 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
34064 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
34065 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
34066 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
34067 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
34068 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
34071 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
34072 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
34073 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
34074 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
34076 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
34077 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
34079 store_pool = POOL_PERM
34081 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
34082 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
34083 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
34084 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
34086 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
34087 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
34088 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
34089 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
34096 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34097 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34099 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
34100 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
34101 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
34102 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
34103 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
34104 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
34105 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
34106 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
34108 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
34109 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
34110 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
34111 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
34112 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
34114 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
34115 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
34116 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
34117 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
34118 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
34119 prevent it happening on retries.
34121 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34122 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34123 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
34124 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
34125 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
34126 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
34127 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
34128 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
34131 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
34132 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
34133 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
34134 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
34135 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
34136 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
34137 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
34139 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
34140 system_filter_user = exim
34142 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
34143 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
34144 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
34145 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
34146 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
34147 by the &%reply%& command.
34150 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
34151 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
34152 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
34153 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
34155 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
34156 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
34160 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
34161 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
34162 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
34163 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
34164 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
34165 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
34168 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
34169 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
34170 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
34171 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
34172 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
34173 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
34174 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
34176 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
34177 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
34178 succeed, it will not be tried again.
34179 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
34180 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
34182 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
34183 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
34184 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
34185 to which users' filter files can refer.
34189 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
34190 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
34191 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
34192 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
34193 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
34197 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
34198 .cindex "freezing messages"
34199 .cindex "message" "freezing"
34200 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
34201 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
34202 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
34203 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
34204 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
34205 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
34206 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
34207 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
34208 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
34210 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
34212 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
34214 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
34215 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
34216 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
34217 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
34218 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
34221 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
34222 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
34223 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
34224 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
34226 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
34227 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
34228 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
34229 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
34230 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
34231 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
34232 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
34233 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
34234 message. For example:
34236 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
34237 because it contains attachments that we are \
34238 not prepared to receive."
34241 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
34242 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
34243 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
34244 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
34245 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
34246 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
34249 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
34250 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
34252 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
34253 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
34254 generated by the filter.
34256 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
34258 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
34259 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
34265 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
34266 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
34271 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
34272 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
34273 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
34274 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
34275 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
34277 headers add <string>
34278 headers remove <string>
34280 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
34281 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
34282 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
34283 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
34284 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
34286 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
34287 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
34288 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
34291 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
34292 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
34295 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
34296 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
34297 space after input continuations is ignored.
34299 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
34300 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
34301 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
34302 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
34303 header with the same name, they are all removed.
34305 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
34306 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
34307 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
34308 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
34309 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
34310 used for all recipients of the message.
34312 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
34313 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
34314 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
34315 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
34316 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
34317 until the message is actually being written (see section
34318 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
34320 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
34321 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
34322 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
34323 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
34324 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
34325 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
34326 modified more than once.
34328 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
34329 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
34332 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
34333 headers remove "Subject"
34334 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
34335 headers remove "Old-Subject"
34340 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
34341 .cindex "envelope sender"
34342 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
34344 errors_to <some address>
34346 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
34347 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
34348 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
34351 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
34353 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
34354 address if its delivery failed.
34358 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
34359 .vindex "&$domain$&"
34360 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
34361 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
34362 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
34363 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
34364 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
34365 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
34366 which implements such a filter:
34371 domains = +local_domains
34372 file = /central/filters/$local_part
34377 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
34378 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
34379 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
34380 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
34382 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
34383 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
34384 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
34385 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
34387 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
34388 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
34389 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
34396 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34397 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34399 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
34400 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
34401 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
34402 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
34403 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
34404 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
34405 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
34406 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
34408 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
34409 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
34410 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
34411 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
34412 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
34414 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
34415 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
34416 loopback interface specially in any way.
34418 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
34419 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
34424 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
34425 .cindex "message" "submission"
34426 .cindex "submission mode"
34427 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
34428 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
34429 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
34430 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
34432 control = submission
34434 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
34435 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
34436 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
34437 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
34438 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
34439 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
34441 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
34442 control = submission
34444 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
34445 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
34446 is used to separate options. For example:
34448 control = submission/sender_retain
34450 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
34451 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
34452 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
34453 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
34454 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
34455 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
34456 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
34458 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
34459 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
34462 control = submission/domain=some.domain
34464 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
34465 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
34466 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
34467 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
34469 accept authenticated = *
34470 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
34471 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
34472 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
34474 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
34475 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
34476 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
34478 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
34480 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
34483 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
34485 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
34486 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
34487 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
34488 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
34490 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
34491 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
34492 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
34493 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
34494 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
34495 spoof another's address.
34497 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
34498 .cindex "line endings"
34499 .cindex "carriage return"
34501 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
34502 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
34503 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
34504 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
34505 use CRLF or just CR.
34507 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
34508 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
34509 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
34510 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
34511 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
34512 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
34513 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
34514 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
34518 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
34520 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
34523 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
34524 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
34527 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
34528 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
34529 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
34530 people trying to play silly games.
34532 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
34533 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
34541 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
34542 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
34543 .cindex "address" "qualification"
34544 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
34545 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
34546 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
34547 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
34548 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
34550 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
34551 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
34552 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
34553 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
34554 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
34556 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
34557 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
34558 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
34559 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
34560 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
34561 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
34562 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
34563 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
34568 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
34569 .cindex "&""From""& line"
34570 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
34571 .cindex "sender" "address"
34572 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
34573 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
34574 .cindex "envelope sender"
34575 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34576 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
34577 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
34578 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
34580 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
34581 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
34583 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
34584 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
34585 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
34586 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
34587 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
34588 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
34589 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
34590 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
34591 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
34593 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
34594 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
34595 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
34596 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
34597 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
34598 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
34599 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
34601 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
34602 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
34603 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
34605 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
34606 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
34607 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
34608 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
34612 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
34613 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
34614 .cindex "header lines" "Resent-"
34615 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
34616 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
34617 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
34618 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
34619 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
34622 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
34623 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
34626 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
34627 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
34631 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
34632 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
34634 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
34635 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
34636 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
34638 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
34641 For a locally-submitted message,
34642 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
34643 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
34644 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
34645 included in log lines in this case.
34647 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
34648 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
34654 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
34655 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
34656 includes the header line:
34658 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
34661 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
34662 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
34663 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
34664 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
34665 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
34666 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
34669 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
34670 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
34671 .cindex "header lines" "Date:"
34672 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
34673 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
34674 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
34676 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
34677 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
34678 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
34679 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
34680 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
34681 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
34682 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
34683 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
34687 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
34688 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
34689 .cindex "header lines" "Envelope-to:"
34690 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
34691 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
34692 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
34693 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
34694 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
34695 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
34699 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
34700 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
34701 .cindex "header lines" "From:"
34702 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
34703 .cindex "message" "submission"
34704 .cindex "submission mode"
34705 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
34706 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
34709 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
34710 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
34712 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34713 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
34715 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34716 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34717 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34719 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
34720 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34722 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34723 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34727 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
34729 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
34730 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
34731 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
34732 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34733 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
34734 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
34735 &%qualify_domain%&.
34737 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
34738 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
34739 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
34740 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
34743 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
34744 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
34745 .cindex "header lines" "Message-ID:"
34746 .cindex "message" "submission"
34747 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
34748 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
34749 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
34750 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
34751 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
34752 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
34753 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
34754 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
34755 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
34756 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
34759 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
34760 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
34761 .cindex "header lines" "Received:"
34762 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
34763 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
34764 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
34766 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
34767 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
34768 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
34769 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
34771 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
34772 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
34773 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
34776 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
34777 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
34778 .cindex "header lines" "References:"
34779 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
34780 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
34781 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
34782 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
34783 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
34784 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
34785 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
34786 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
34787 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
34791 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
34792 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
34793 .cindex "header lines" "Return-path:"
34794 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
34795 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
34796 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
34797 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
34798 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
34799 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
34803 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
34804 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
34805 .cindex "message" "submission"
34806 .cindex "header lines" "Sender:"
34807 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
34808 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
34809 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
34810 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34813 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
34814 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
34815 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
34816 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
34817 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
34818 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
34819 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
34820 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
34821 line is added to the message.
34823 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
34824 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
34825 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
34826 options true at the same time.
34828 .cindex "submission mode"
34829 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
34830 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
34831 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
34832 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
34834 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
34835 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
34836 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
34837 created as follows:
34840 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34841 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
34842 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
34844 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
34845 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
34847 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
34848 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
34851 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
34852 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
34853 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
34854 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
34856 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
34857 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
34858 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
34859 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
34863 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
34864 "SECTheadersaddrem"
34865 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
34866 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
34867 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
34868 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
34869 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
34870 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
34871 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
34873 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
34874 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
34875 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
34876 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
34877 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
34878 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
34880 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
34881 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
34882 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
34884 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
34885 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
34886 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
34888 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
34889 X-added-second: another added header line
34891 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
34893 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
34894 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
34895 Each header-line is separately expanded.
34897 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
34898 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
34899 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
34900 not part of the names. For example:
34902 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
34905 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
34906 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
34907 Each item is separately expanded.
34908 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
34909 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
34910 will act as list separators.
34912 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
34913 items are expanded at routing time,
34914 and then associated with all addresses that are
34915 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
34916 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
34917 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
34919 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
34920 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
34921 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
34922 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
34924 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
34925 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
34926 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
34929 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
34930 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
34931 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
34932 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
34933 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
34934 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
34935 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
34937 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
34938 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
34939 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
34940 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
34942 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
34943 the following consequences:
34946 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
34947 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
34948 to it, at all times.
34950 Header lines that are added by a router's
34951 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
34952 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
34954 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
34955 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
34957 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
34958 a later router or by a transport.
34960 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
34961 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
34963 headers_remove = subject
34964 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
34968 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
34969 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
34975 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
34976 .cindex "address" "constructed"
34977 .cindex "constructed address"
34978 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
34981 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
34985 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
34987 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
34988 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
34989 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
34990 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
34991 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
34992 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
34993 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
34994 there is no password file entry.
34997 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
34998 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
34999 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
35000 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
35001 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
35002 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
35003 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
35004 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
35008 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
35009 .cindex "case of local parts"
35010 .cindex "local part" "case of"
35011 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
35012 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
35013 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
35014 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
35015 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
35016 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
35019 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
35020 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
35021 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
35022 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
35023 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
35027 domains = +local_domains
35028 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
35029 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
35032 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
35033 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
35034 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
35035 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
35036 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
35040 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
35041 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
35042 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
35043 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
35044 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
35045 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
35046 empty components for compatibility.
35050 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
35051 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
35052 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
35053 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
35054 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
35055 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
35057 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
35058 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
35059 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
35060 example, a header such as
35064 might get rewritten as
35066 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
35068 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
35069 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
35072 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
35073 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
35074 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
35075 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
35076 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
35077 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
35078 .ecindex IIDmesproc
35082 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35083 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35085 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
35086 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
35087 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
35088 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
35089 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
35090 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
35091 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
35094 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
35096 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
35098 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
35101 For mail delivery, the following are available:
35104 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
35106 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
35109 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
35112 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
35113 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
35116 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
35117 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
35118 used to contain the envelope information.
35122 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
35123 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
35124 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
35125 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
35126 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
35129 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35130 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
35131 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
35132 processing is the same in both cases.
35134 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
35135 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
35136 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
35137 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
35138 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
35139 .cindex "transport" "filter"
35140 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
35141 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
35144 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
35145 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
35146 required for the transaction.
35148 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
35149 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
35150 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
35151 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
35152 is called for verification.
35154 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
35155 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
35156 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
35158 .cindex "carriage return"
35160 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35161 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
35162 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35165 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
35166 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
35167 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
35168 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
35169 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
35170 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
35171 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
35172 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
35173 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
35175 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
35176 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
35177 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
35178 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
35180 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
35181 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
35182 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
35183 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
35185 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
35186 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
35187 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
35188 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
35189 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
35190 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
35191 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
35192 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
35193 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
35194 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
35196 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
35197 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
35199 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
35200 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
35201 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
35202 square bracket of the IP address.
35207 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
35208 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
35209 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
35210 .cindex "host" "error"
35211 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
35212 message errors, and recipient errors.
35215 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
35216 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
35217 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
35220 Connection refused or timed out,
35222 Any error response code on connection,
35224 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
35226 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
35228 I/O errors at any time,
35230 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
35231 the &"."& at the end of the data.
35234 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
35235 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
35236 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
35237 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
35238 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
35239 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
35240 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
35241 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
35243 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
35244 .cindex "message" "error"
35245 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
35246 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
35247 message errors are:
35250 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
35253 Timeout after MAIL,
35255 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
35256 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
35257 connection at any other time.
35260 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
35261 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
35262 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
35263 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
35264 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
35265 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
35266 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
35267 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
35268 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
35269 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
35271 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
35272 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
35273 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
35276 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
35277 .cindex "recipient" "error"
35278 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
35279 recipient errors are:
35282 Any error response to RCPT,
35284 Timeout after RCPT.
35287 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
35288 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
35289 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
35290 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
35291 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
35292 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
35293 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
35294 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
35295 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
35296 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
35297 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
35298 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
35299 the retry clock is reset.
35301 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
35302 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
35303 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
35304 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
35305 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
35306 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
35307 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
35308 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
35309 recipient's retry time.
35312 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
35313 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
35314 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
35315 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
35316 until the next delivery attempt.
35318 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
35319 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
35320 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
35321 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
35322 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
35325 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
35326 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
35327 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
35328 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
35329 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
35330 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
35331 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
35333 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
35334 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
35335 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
35336 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
35337 then to be treated as a host error.
35339 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
35340 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
35341 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
35342 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
35343 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
35348 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
35349 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
35350 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
35353 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
35354 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
35355 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
35357 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
35359 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
35360 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
35361 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
35362 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
35363 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
35364 stream and exits with an error code.
35366 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
35367 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
35368 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
35369 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
35371 .cindex "carriage return"
35373 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
35374 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
35375 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
35377 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
35378 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
35379 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
35381 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
35382 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
35383 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
35384 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
35385 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
35386 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
35387 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
35388 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
35390 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
35391 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
35392 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
35393 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
35394 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
35395 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
35396 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
35397 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
35398 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
35400 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
35401 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
35402 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
35404 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
35405 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
35406 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
35407 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
35408 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
35410 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
35411 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
35412 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
35413 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
35414 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
35415 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
35416 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
35418 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
35419 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
35420 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
35421 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
35422 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
35424 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
35425 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
35426 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
35427 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
35428 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
35429 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
35430 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
35431 a delivery process.
35433 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
35434 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
35435 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
35436 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
35437 however, available with &'inetd'&.
35439 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
35440 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
35441 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
35442 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
35444 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
35445 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
35446 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
35450 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
35451 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
35452 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
35453 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
35454 the error response to the last command. The default value for
35455 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
35456 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
35457 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
35460 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
35461 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
35462 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
35463 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
35464 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
35465 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
35466 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
35467 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
35468 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
35469 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
35470 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
35474 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
35475 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
35476 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
35477 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
35478 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
35479 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
35480 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
35481 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
35483 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
35484 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
35485 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
35486 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
35487 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
35490 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
35491 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
35492 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
35494 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
35495 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
35496 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
35497 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
35498 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
35503 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
35504 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
35505 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
35506 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
35508 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
35509 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
35510 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
35511 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
35512 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
35513 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
35514 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
35515 SMTP response codes.
35517 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
35518 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
35519 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
35520 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
35521 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
35522 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
35523 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
35524 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
35529 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
35530 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
35531 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
35532 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
35533 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
35534 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
35535 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
35537 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
35538 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
35539 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
35540 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
35541 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
35542 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
35543 argument. For example,
35551 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
35552 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
35553 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
35554 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
35555 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
35557 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
35558 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
35559 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
35560 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
35561 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
35562 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
35563 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
35564 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
35566 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
35567 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
35568 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
35569 whatever the form of its argument. For
35572 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
35573 $sender_host_address
35575 .vindex "&$domain$&"
35576 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
35577 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
35578 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
35579 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
35580 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
35581 for it to change them before running the command.
35585 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
35586 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
35587 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
35588 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
35589 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
35590 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
35591 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
35592 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
35593 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
35594 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
35595 runs for RCPT commands:
35599 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
35603 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
35604 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
35605 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
35606 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
35607 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
35608 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
35609 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
35610 envelope along with the message.
35612 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
35613 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
35614 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
35615 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
35616 can be used to specify it.
35618 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
35619 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
35620 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
35621 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
35622 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
35625 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
35626 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
35627 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
35632 driver = manualroute
35633 transport = smtp_appendfile
35634 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
35638 driver = appendfile
35639 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
35644 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
35645 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
35646 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
35650 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
35651 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
35652 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
35653 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
35654 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
35655 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
35656 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
35657 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
35658 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
35659 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
35661 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
35662 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
35664 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
35665 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
35666 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
35667 make some use of automatically, for example:
35669 554 Unexpected end of file
35670 Transaction started in line 10
35671 Error detected in line 14
35673 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
35676 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
35677 The error message was:
35679 501 '>' missing at end of address
35681 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
35682 The error was detected in line 12.
35683 The SMTP command at fault was:
35685 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
35687 1 previous message was successfully processed.
35688 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
35690 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
35691 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
35693 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
35694 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
35698 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35699 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35701 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
35702 "Customizing messages"
35703 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
35704 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
35705 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
35706 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
35707 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
35709 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
35710 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
35711 option. Exim also adds the line
35713 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
35715 to all warning and bounce messages,
35718 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
35719 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
35720 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
35721 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
35722 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
35723 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
35724 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
35726 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
35727 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
35728 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
35729 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
35730 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
35733 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
35734 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
35735 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
35736 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
35737 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
35738 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
35739 option, rounded to a whole number.
35741 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
35744 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35745 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35747 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
35748 failing addresses with their error messages.
35750 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
35751 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
35753 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
35754 The fields exist for back-compatibility
35757 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
35758 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
35759 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
35761 Subject: Mail delivery failed
35762 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35763 {: returning message to sender}}
35765 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35767 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
35768 {that you sent }{sent by
35772 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
35773 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
35775 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
35777 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
35780 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
35782 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
35785 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
35786 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
35787 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
35788 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
35789 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
35793 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
35794 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
35796 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
35797 the delayed addresses.
35799 The third item then ends the message.
35802 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
35803 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
35805 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
35806 $warn_message_delay
35808 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
35810 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
35811 {that you sent }{sent by
35815 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
35816 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
35818 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
35819 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
35820 The date of the message is: $h_date
35822 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
35824 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
35825 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
35826 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
35827 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
35828 the message will be returned to you.
35830 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
35831 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
35832 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
35833 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
35834 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
35835 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
35836 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
35837 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
35843 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35844 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35846 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
35847 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
35848 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
35852 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
35853 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
35854 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
35855 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
35856 routing explicitly:
35858 send_to_smart_host:
35859 driver = manualroute
35860 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
35861 transport = remote_smtp
35863 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
35864 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
35865 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
35866 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
35867 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
35872 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
35873 .cindex "mailing lists"
35874 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
35875 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
35876 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
35878 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
35879 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
35880 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
35881 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
35885 domains = lists.example
35886 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35889 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35892 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
35893 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
35894 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
35895 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
35897 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
35898 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
35901 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
35902 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
35903 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
35904 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
35905 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
35907 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
35908 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
35909 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
35910 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
35911 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
35912 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
35913 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
35914 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
35915 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
35919 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
35920 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
35921 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
35922 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
35923 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
35924 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
35925 addresses are not rigorously checked.
35927 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
35928 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
35929 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
35930 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
35931 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
35935 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
35936 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
35937 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
35938 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
35939 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
35940 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
35941 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
35942 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
35943 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
35944 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
35946 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
35947 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
35948 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
35949 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
35950 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
35951 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
35952 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
35953 pre-existing messages.
35955 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
35956 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
35957 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
35958 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
35959 one level of expansion anyway.
35963 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
35964 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
35965 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
35966 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
35967 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
35968 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
35970 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
35971 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
35975 domains = lists.example
35976 local_part_suffix = -request
35977 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
35982 domains = lists.example
35983 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
35984 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
35985 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
35988 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
35993 domains = lists.example
35995 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
35997 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
35998 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
35999 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
36002 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
36003 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
36004 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
36005 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
36006 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
36007 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
36008 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
36009 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
36010 &"unrouteable address"& error.
36012 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
36013 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
36014 the address, giving a suitable error message.
36019 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
36021 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
36022 .cindex "envelope sender"
36023 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
36024 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
36025 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
36026 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
36027 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
36028 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
36030 .oindex &%errors_to%&
36031 .oindex &%return_path%&
36032 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
36033 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
36034 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
36035 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
36036 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
36037 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
36038 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
36044 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36045 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36047 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
36048 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
36049 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
36050 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
36051 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
36052 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
36053 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
36056 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
36058 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36059 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
36060 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
36061 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
36062 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
36063 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
36065 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
36066 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
36067 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
36068 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
36072 domains = ! +local_domains
36074 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
36075 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
36078 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
36079 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
36080 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
36081 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
36084 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
36085 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
36086 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
36087 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
36088 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
36092 domains = ! +local_domains
36093 transport = remote_smtp
36095 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
36096 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
36099 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
36100 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
36101 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
36102 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
36105 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
36106 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
36107 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
36108 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
36109 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
36110 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
36118 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
36119 .cindex "virtual domains"
36120 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
36121 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
36125 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
36126 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
36127 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
36129 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
36130 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
36131 have login accounts on that host.
36134 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
36135 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
36136 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
36137 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
36138 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
36139 to a router of this form:
36143 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
36144 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
36147 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
36148 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
36149 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
36150 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
36151 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
36152 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
36154 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
36155 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
36156 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
36157 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
36159 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
36160 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
36161 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
36165 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
36166 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
36167 transport = my_mailboxes
36169 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
36170 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
36171 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
36172 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
36173 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
36177 driver = appendfile
36178 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
36181 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
36182 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
36184 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
36185 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
36186 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
36187 information about the domains.
36191 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
36192 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
36193 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
36194 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
36195 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
36196 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
36197 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
36198 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
36199 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
36200 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
36201 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
36202 example, consider this router:
36207 file = $home/.forward
36208 local_part_suffix = -*
36209 local_part_suffix_optional
36212 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
36213 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
36214 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
36215 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
36217 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
36218 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
36221 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
36222 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
36223 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
36224 control over which suffixes are valid.
36226 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
36227 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
36233 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
36234 local_part_suffix = -*
36235 local_part_suffix_optional
36238 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
36239 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
36240 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
36241 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
36242 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
36246 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
36247 .cindex "vacation processing"
36248 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
36249 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
36250 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
36251 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
36252 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
36255 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
36256 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
36257 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
36258 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
36260 spqr, vacation-spqr
36263 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
36264 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
36265 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
36266 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
36267 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
36271 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
36272 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
36276 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
36277 .cindex "message" "copying every"
36278 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
36279 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
36280 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
36281 each day's messages.
36283 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
36284 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
36285 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
36286 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
36290 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
36291 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
36292 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
36293 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
36294 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
36295 permanently connected.
36297 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
36298 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
36299 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
36302 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
36303 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
36304 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
36305 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
36306 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
36307 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
36308 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
36309 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
36311 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
36312 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
36313 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
36314 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
36315 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
36316 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
36319 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
36320 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
36321 intermittent host. For example:
36323 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
36325 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
36326 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
36327 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
36328 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
36329 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
36330 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
36333 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
36334 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
36335 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
36336 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
36337 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
36338 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
36339 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
36343 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
36344 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
36345 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
36346 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
36347 delivered immediately.
36349 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
36350 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
36351 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
36352 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
36353 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
36354 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
36355 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
36356 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
36357 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
36358 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
36359 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
36360 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
36361 single SMTP connection.
36365 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36366 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36368 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
36369 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
36370 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
36371 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
36372 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
36373 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
36374 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
36375 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
36376 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
36377 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
36380 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
36381 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
36382 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
36383 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
36384 email is not desirable.
36386 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
36387 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
36388 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
36389 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
36390 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
36391 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
36392 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
36394 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
36395 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
36396 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
36397 before sending a message to the smart host.
36399 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
36400 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
36401 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
36403 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
36404 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
36405 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
36406 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
36407 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
36408 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
36409 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
36411 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
36415 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
36416 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
36418 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
36419 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
36420 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
36421 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
36422 successful, a zero return code is given.
36424 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
36425 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
36426 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
36427 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
36428 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
36431 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
36432 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
36433 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
36435 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
36436 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
36437 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
36438 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
36439 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
36441 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
36442 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
36443 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
36445 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
36446 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
36447 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
36448 are ever generated.
36450 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
36452 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
36453 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
36454 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
36457 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
36458 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
36459 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
36460 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
36461 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
36462 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
36467 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36468 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36470 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
36471 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
36472 .cindex "log" "types of"
36473 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
36478 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
36479 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
36480 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
36481 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
36482 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
36483 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
36484 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
36485 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
36487 .cindex "reject log"
36488 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
36489 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
36490 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
36491 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
36492 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
36493 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
36494 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
36495 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
36496 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
36499 .cindex "panic log"
36500 .cindex "system log"
36501 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
36502 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
36503 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
36504 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
36505 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
36506 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
36507 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
36508 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
36509 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
36512 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
36513 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
36514 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
36516 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
36519 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
36520 ways of changing this:
36523 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
36528 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
36530 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
36533 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
36537 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
36538 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
36539 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
36540 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
36541 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
36542 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
36547 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
36548 .cindex "log" "destination"
36549 .cindex "log" "to file"
36550 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
36552 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
36553 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
36554 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
36555 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
36556 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
36557 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
36558 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
36560 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
36561 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
36562 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
36563 references to the host name:
36565 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
36567 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
36568 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
36569 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
36570 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
36571 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
36574 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
36575 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
36576 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
36577 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
36578 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
36579 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
36580 implying the use of a default path.
36582 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
36583 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
36584 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
36585 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
36586 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
36587 equivalent to the setting:
36589 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
36591 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
36592 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
36593 that is where the logs are written.
36595 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
36596 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
36598 Here are some examples of possible settings:
36600 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
36601 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
36602 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
36603 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
36605 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
36610 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
36611 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
36612 .cindex "cycling logs"
36613 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
36614 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
36615 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
36616 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
36617 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
36618 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
36619 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
36621 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
36622 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
36623 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
36624 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
36625 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
36626 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
36627 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
36628 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
36629 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
36630 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
36631 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
36636 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
36637 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
36638 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
36639 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
36640 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
36641 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
36642 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
36643 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
36645 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
36646 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
36647 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
36648 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
36650 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
36651 examples of names generated by the above examples:
36653 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
36654 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
36655 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
36656 /var/log/exim/main.200212
36658 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
36659 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
36660 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
36661 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
36663 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
36664 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
36665 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
36666 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
36667 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
36668 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
36671 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36672 /var/log/exim-panic.log
36673 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
36674 /var/log/exim/panic
36678 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
36679 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
36680 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
36681 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
36682 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
36683 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
36684 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
36685 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
36686 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
36687 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
36688 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
36689 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
36690 the time and host name to each line.
36691 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
36694 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
36696 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
36698 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
36701 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
36702 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
36703 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
36704 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
36706 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
36707 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
36708 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
36709 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
36710 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
36711 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
36712 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
36713 RFC 3164, you should set
36715 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
36717 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
36718 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
36720 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
36721 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
36722 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
36723 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
36724 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
36725 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
36726 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
36727 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
36728 name, and pid as added by syslog:
36730 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
36731 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
36732 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
36733 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
36736 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
36739 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
36740 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
36741 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
36742 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
36744 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
36745 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
36746 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
36747 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
36748 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
36749 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
36751 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
36752 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
36753 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
36756 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
36758 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
36759 without modification.
36761 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
36762 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
36763 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
36768 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
36769 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
36770 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
36771 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
36772 timestamp. The flags are:
36774 &`<=`& message arrival
36775 &`(=`& message fakereject
36776 &`=>`& normal message delivery
36777 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
36778 &`>>`& cutthrough message delivery
36779 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
36780 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
36781 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
36785 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
36786 .cindex "log" "reception line"
36787 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36788 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
36789 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
36791 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
36792 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
36793 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
36795 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
36796 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
36797 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
36801 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
36805 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
36806 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
36807 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
36808 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
36809 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
36810 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
36811 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
36812 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
36813 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
36814 name in parentheses.
36816 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
36817 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
36818 the log containing text like these examples:
36820 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
36821 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
36823 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
36826 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
36827 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
36830 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
36831 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
36832 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
36833 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
36834 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
36835 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
36836 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
36837 suite that was used.
36839 .cindex log protocol
36840 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
36841 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
36842 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
36843 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
36844 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
36845 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
36846 authenticator name.
36848 .cindex "size" "of message"
36849 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
36850 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
36851 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
36852 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
36855 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36856 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36860 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
36861 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
36862 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
36863 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
36864 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
36865 to fit it on the page:
36867 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
36868 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
36869 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
36870 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
36871 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
36873 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
36874 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
36875 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
36876 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
36877 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
36879 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
36880 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
36881 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
36882 option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the authenticator name.
36884 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
36885 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
36887 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
36889 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
36890 parentheses afterwards.
36892 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
36893 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
36894 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
36895 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
36896 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
36897 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36898 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
36899 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
36900 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
36901 TLS cipher information is still available.
36903 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
36904 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
36905 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
36906 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
36907 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
36909 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
36910 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
36912 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
36913 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
36916 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
36917 .cindex "discarded messages"
36918 .cindex "message" "discarded"
36919 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
36920 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
36921 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
36923 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
36924 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
36926 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
36927 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
36929 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
36930 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
36934 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
36935 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
36937 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
36938 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
36940 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
36941 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
36942 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
36944 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
36945 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
36947 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
36948 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
36949 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
36953 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
36954 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
36955 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
36956 following form is logged:
36958 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
36959 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
36961 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
36962 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
36964 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
36965 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
36966 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
36967 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
36968 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
36970 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
36971 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
36972 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
36973 flagged with &`**`&.
36977 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
36978 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
36979 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
36980 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
36981 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
36985 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
36988 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
36990 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
36991 at the end of its processing.
36996 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
36997 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
36998 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
36999 the following table:
37001 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
37002 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
37003 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37004 &`CV `& certificate verification status
37005 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
37006 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
37007 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
37008 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37009 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
37010 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
37011 &`H `& host name and IP address
37012 &`I `& local interface used
37013 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
37014 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
37015 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
37016 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
37017 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
37018 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
37019 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
37020 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
37021 &`Q `& alternate queue name
37022 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
37023 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
37024 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
37025 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
37026 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
37027 &`S `& size of message in bytes
37028 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
37029 &`ST `& shadow transport name
37030 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
37031 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
37032 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
37033 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
37034 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
37038 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
37039 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
37040 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
37043 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
37044 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
37045 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
37046 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
37047 during the first delivery attempt.
37049 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
37050 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
37051 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
37053 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
37054 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
37055 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
37056 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
37057 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
37060 .cindex "error" "ignored"
37061 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
37064 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
37065 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
37067 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
37068 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37070 A delivery set up by a router configured with
37071 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
37072 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
37076 failed. The delivery was discarded.
37079 .cindex DKIM "log line"
37080 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
37081 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
37088 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
37089 .cindex "log" "selectors"
37090 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
37091 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
37092 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
37095 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
37097 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
37098 selection marked by asterisks:
37100 &` 8bitmime `& received 8BITMIME status
37101 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
37102 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
37103 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
37104 &` arguments `& command line arguments
37105 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
37106 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
37107 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
37108 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
37109 &`*dkim `& DKIM verified domain on <= lines
37110 &` dkim_verbose `& separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature
37111 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
37112 &` dnssec `& DNSSEC secured lookups
37113 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
37114 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
37115 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
37116 &` incoming_interface `& local interface on <= and => lines
37117 &` incoming_port `& remote port on <= lines
37118 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
37119 &` millisec `& millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times
37120 &`*msg_id `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value
37121 &` msg_id_created `& on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added
37122 &` outgoing_interface `& local interface on => lines
37123 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
37124 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
37125 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
37126 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
37127 &` pid `& Exim process id
37128 &` pipelining `& PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines
37129 &` proxy `& proxy address on <= and => lines
37130 &` receive_time `& time taken to receive message
37131 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
37132 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
37133 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
37134 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
37135 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
37136 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
37137 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
37138 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
37139 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
37140 &`*smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
37141 &` smtp_connection `& incoming SMTP connections
37142 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
37143 &` smtp_mailauth `& AUTH argument to MAIL commands
37144 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
37145 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
37146 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
37147 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
37148 &`*tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
37149 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
37150 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
37151 &` tls_sni `& TLS SNI on <= lines
37152 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
37154 &` all `& all of the above
37156 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
37157 section &<<SECID99>>&
37159 More details on each of these items follows:
37163 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
37164 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
37165 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
37166 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
37167 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
37168 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
37170 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
37171 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
37172 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
37173 this log selector is set.
37175 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
37176 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
37177 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
37178 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
37179 such users cannot access the log).
37181 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
37182 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
37183 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
37184 parentheses between them.
37186 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
37187 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
37188 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
37189 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
37190 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
37191 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
37192 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
37193 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
37194 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
37195 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
37196 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
37197 between the caller and Exim.
37199 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
37200 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
37201 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
37203 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
37204 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
37205 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
37206 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
37207 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
37208 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
37210 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
37211 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
37212 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
37213 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37214 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
37216 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
37217 .cindex "size" "of message"
37218 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
37219 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
37221 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37222 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37223 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
37224 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
37226 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
37227 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
37228 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
37230 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
37231 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
37232 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
37233 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
37234 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
37237 .cindex dnssec logging
37238 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
37239 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
37240 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
37241 It does not cover helo-name verification.
37242 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
37244 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
37245 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
37246 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
37247 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
37248 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
37249 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
37251 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
37252 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
37253 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
37254 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
37255 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
37257 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
37258 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
37259 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
37260 client's ident port times out.
37262 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
37263 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37264 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37265 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37266 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37267 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
37268 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
37269 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
37270 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
37271 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing &"=>"& and &"->"& lines.
37272 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37274 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
37275 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
37276 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
37277 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
37278 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
37279 on a proxied connection
37280 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
37281 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
37283 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
37284 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
37285 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
37286 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
37287 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
37288 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
37289 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
37290 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
37291 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
37292 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
37293 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
37295 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
37296 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
37297 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
37299 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
37300 .cindex millisecond logging
37301 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
37302 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
37303 appended to the seconds value.
37306 .cindex "log" "message id"
37307 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
37309 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
37310 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
37311 (submission mode) without one.
37312 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
37315 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
37316 .cindex "log" "local interface"
37317 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
37318 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
37319 .cindex "interface" "logging"
37320 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
37321 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
37322 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
37323 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
37325 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
37326 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
37327 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
37328 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
37329 containing => tags) following the IP address.
37330 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
37331 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
37332 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
37333 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
37334 local port is a random ephemeral port.
37336 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
37337 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
37338 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
37339 immediately after the time and date.
37341 .cindex log pipelining
37342 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
37343 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
37344 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
37345 The field is a single "L".
37347 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
37348 the field has a minus appended.
37350 .cindex "log" "queue run"
37351 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
37352 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
37354 .cindex "log" "queue time"
37355 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
37356 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
37357 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
37358 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
37359 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
37360 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
37361 message has been successfully received.
37362 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37363 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
37365 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
37366 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
37367 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
37368 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
37370 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
37371 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
37372 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
37373 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
37374 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
37376 .cindex "log" "recipients"
37377 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
37378 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
37379 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
37380 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
37382 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
37385 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
37386 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
37387 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
37388 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
37390 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
37391 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
37392 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
37393 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
37394 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
37396 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
37397 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
37398 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
37399 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
37402 .cindex "log" "return path"
37403 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
37404 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
37405 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
37406 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
37408 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
37409 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
37410 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
37411 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
37412 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
37414 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
37415 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
37416 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
37417 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
37420 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
37421 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
37424 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
37425 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
37426 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
37427 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
37429 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
37430 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
37432 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
37433 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
37434 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
37435 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
37436 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
37437 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
37440 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
37441 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
37442 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
37443 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
37444 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
37445 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
37446 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
37447 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
37448 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
37449 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
37451 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
37452 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
37453 reset if the daemon is restarted.
37454 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
37455 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
37456 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
37457 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
37458 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
37460 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
37461 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
37462 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
37463 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
37464 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
37465 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
37467 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
37468 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
37469 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
37470 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
37471 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
37472 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
37473 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
37474 already have their own log lines.
37476 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
37477 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
37478 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
37479 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
37480 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
37481 the same logging options.
37483 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
37484 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
37488 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
37489 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
37490 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
37491 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
37492 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
37494 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
37495 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
37496 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
37497 was accepted or used.
37499 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
37500 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
37501 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
37502 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
37503 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
37504 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
37505 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
37506 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
37508 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
37509 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
37510 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
37511 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
37512 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
37513 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
37514 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
37515 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
37516 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
37518 .cindex "log" "subject"
37519 .cindex "subject, logging"
37520 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
37521 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
37522 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
37523 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
37524 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
37526 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
37528 .cindex DANE logging
37529 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
37530 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
37532 using a CA trust anchor,
37533 &`CA=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
37534 and &`CV=no`& if not.
37536 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
37537 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
37538 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37539 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
37541 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
37542 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
37543 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
37544 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
37545 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
37547 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
37548 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
37549 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
37550 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
37551 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
37553 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
37554 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
37555 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
37559 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
37560 .cindex "message" "log file for"
37561 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
37562 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
37563 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
37564 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
37565 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
37566 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
37567 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
37568 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
37569 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
37570 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
37571 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
37573 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
37574 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
37575 &%message_logs%& option false.
37581 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37584 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
37585 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
37586 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
37587 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
37588 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
37590 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
37591 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
37592 "list what Exim processes are doing"
37593 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
37594 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
37595 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
37596 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
37598 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
37599 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
37600 "extract statistics from the log"
37601 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
37602 "check address acceptance from given IP"
37603 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
37604 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
37605 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
37606 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
37607 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
37608 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
37611 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
37612 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
37613 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
37618 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
37619 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
37620 .cindex "process, querying"
37622 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
37623 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
37624 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
37625 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
37626 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
37627 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
37628 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
37629 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
37631 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
37632 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
37633 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
37636 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
37637 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
37638 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
37639 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
37640 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
37643 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
37644 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
37645 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
37646 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
37648 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
37650 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
37651 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
37652 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
37653 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
37654 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
37655 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
37657 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
37658 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
37662 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
37663 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
37664 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
37665 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
37669 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
37673 The &*-C*& option is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
37674 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
37676 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
37677 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
37680 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
37681 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37682 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
37686 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
37687 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
37688 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
37690 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
37691 Match against the size field.
37693 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37694 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
37696 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
37697 Match messages that are older than the given time.
37700 Match only frozen messages.
37703 Match only non-frozen messages.
37706 The following options control the format of the output:
37710 Display only the count of matching messages.
37713 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
37717 Display message ids only.
37720 Brief format &-- one line per message.
37723 Display messages in reverse order.
37726 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
37729 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
37733 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
37734 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
37735 .cindex "queue" "summary"
37736 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
37737 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
37738 running a command such as
37740 exim -bp | exiqsumm
37742 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
37743 it, as in the following example:
37745 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
37747 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
37748 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
37749 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
37750 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
37752 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
37753 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
37754 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
37755 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
37756 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
37757 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
37760 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
37761 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
37762 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
37763 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
37764 level"& addresses).
37769 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
37771 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
37772 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
37773 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
37774 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
37775 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
37776 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
37777 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
37778 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
37779 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
37780 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
37782 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
37784 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
37786 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
37787 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
37788 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
37790 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
37791 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
37792 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
37793 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
37794 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
37796 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
37797 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
37798 regular expression.
37800 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
37801 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
37803 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
37804 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
37808 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
37809 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
37810 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
37811 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
37812 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
37813 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
37816 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
37817 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
37818 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
37819 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
37820 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
37823 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
37824 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
37825 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
37826 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
37827 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
37828 the &%--help%& option.
37831 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
37832 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
37833 .cindex "cycling logs"
37834 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
37835 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
37836 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
37837 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
37838 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
37839 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
37840 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
37842 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
37843 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
37845 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
37846 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
37847 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
37851 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
37852 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
37853 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
37854 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
37855 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
37856 logs are handled similarly.
37858 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
37859 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
37860 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
37861 any existing log files.
37863 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
37864 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
37865 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
37866 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
37867 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
37869 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
37871 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
37872 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
37876 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
37877 .cindex "statistics"
37878 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
37879 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
37880 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
37881 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
37882 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
37884 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
37885 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
37886 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
37887 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
37888 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
37890 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
37892 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
37893 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
37894 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
37895 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
37896 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
37897 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
37898 also produced per user.
37900 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
37901 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
37902 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
37903 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
37904 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
37906 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
37907 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
37908 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
37909 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
37910 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
37911 an entirely separate message.
37913 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
37914 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
37915 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
37916 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
37917 least one address that failed.
37919 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
37920 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
37921 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
37922 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
37923 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
37924 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
37925 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
37927 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
37928 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
37929 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
37931 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
37932 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
37933 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
37935 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
37938 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
37939 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
37940 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
37941 .cindex "checking access"
37942 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
37943 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
37944 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
37945 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
37946 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
37947 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
37949 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
37950 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
37952 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
37954 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
37955 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
37956 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
37957 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
37960 550 Relay not permitted
37962 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
37963 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
37964 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
37965 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
37968 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
37969 -f himself@there.example
37971 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
37972 mandatory arguments.
37974 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
37975 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
37976 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
37980 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
37981 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
37982 .cindex "building DBM files"
37983 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
37984 .cindex "lower casing"
37985 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
37986 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
37987 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
37988 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
37989 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
37990 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
37992 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
37993 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
37994 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
37995 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
37998 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
37999 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
38000 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
38004 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
38005 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
38006 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
38007 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
38009 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
38011 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
38012 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
38014 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
38015 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
38016 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
38017 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
38018 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
38019 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
38021 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
38022 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
38023 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
38024 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
38025 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
38026 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
38027 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
38033 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
38034 .cindex "retry" "times"
38035 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
38036 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
38037 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
38038 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
38039 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
38040 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
38041 output. For example:
38043 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
38044 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
38045 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38046 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
38047 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
38048 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
38049 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
38050 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
38051 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
38052 past final cutoff time
38054 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
38055 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
38056 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
38057 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
38058 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
38059 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
38062 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
38063 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
38064 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
38065 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
38066 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
38067 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
38071 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
38072 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
38073 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
38074 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
38075 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
38076 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
38077 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
38080 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
38082 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
38085 &'callout'&: the callout cache
38087 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
38089 &'misc'&: other hints data
38092 The &'misc'& database is used for
38095 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
38097 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
38098 &(smtp)& transport)
38100 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
38106 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
38107 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
38108 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
38109 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
38110 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
38112 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
38114 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
38116 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
38117 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
38119 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
38120 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
38121 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
38122 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
38123 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
38124 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
38125 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
38126 and a textual description of the error.
38128 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
38129 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
38130 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
38133 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
38134 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
38135 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
38136 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
38137 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
38138 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
38143 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
38144 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
38145 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
38146 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
38147 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
38148 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
38149 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
38150 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
38151 updated sufficiently often.
38153 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
38154 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
38155 the retry database:
38157 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
38159 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
38160 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
38161 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
38162 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
38163 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
38164 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
38165 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
38166 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
38167 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
38168 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
38169 whenever it removes information from the database.
38171 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
38172 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
38173 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
38174 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
38175 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
38177 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
38178 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
38179 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
38180 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
38181 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
38182 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
38183 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
38186 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
38187 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
38192 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
38193 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
38194 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
38195 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
38196 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
38197 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
38198 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
38201 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
38202 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
38203 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
38204 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
38205 by new data, for example:
38209 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
38210 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
38211 used as optional separators.
38216 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
38217 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
38218 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
38219 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
38220 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
38221 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
38222 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
38223 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
38224 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
38225 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
38226 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
38227 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
38228 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
38232 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
38235 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
38238 .vitem &%-interval%&
38239 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
38240 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
38242 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
38243 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
38246 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
38249 Suppress verification output.
38251 .vitem &%-retries%&
38252 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
38253 the lock (default 10).
38255 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
38256 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
38257 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
38258 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
38261 .vitem &%-timeout%&
38262 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
38263 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
38264 default), a non-blocking call is used.
38267 Generate verbose output.
38270 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
38271 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
38272 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
38273 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
38274 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
38275 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
38276 more than 30 minutes old.
38278 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
38279 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
38280 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
38281 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
38282 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
38283 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
38285 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
38286 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
38287 suppresses all output except error messages.
38291 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
38293 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
38295 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
38296 <&'some commands'&>
38299 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
38300 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
38303 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
38304 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
38306 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
38307 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
38311 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38312 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38314 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
38315 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
38316 .cindex "X-windows"
38317 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
38318 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
38319 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
38320 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
38321 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
38322 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
38323 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
38324 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
38328 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
38329 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
38330 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
38331 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
38332 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
38333 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
38334 parameters are for.
38336 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
38337 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
38338 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
38340 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
38342 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
38343 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
38344 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
38345 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
38346 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
38348 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
38349 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
38351 Eximon*background: gray94
38353 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
38354 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
38355 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
38356 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
38357 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
38358 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
38359 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
38362 Eximon*highlight: gray
38365 .cindex "admin user"
38366 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
38367 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
38369 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
38370 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
38371 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
38372 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
38373 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
38375 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
38376 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
38377 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
38378 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
38379 different parts of the display.
38384 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
38385 .cindex "stripchart"
38386 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
38387 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38388 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
38389 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
38390 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
38391 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
38392 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
38393 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
38394 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38396 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
38397 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
38398 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
38399 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
38401 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
38402 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
38403 to a single partition.
38405 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
38406 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
38407 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
38408 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
38409 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
38410 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
38411 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
38416 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
38417 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
38418 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
38419 .cindex "window size"
38420 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
38421 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
38422 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
38423 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
38424 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
38425 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
38427 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
38428 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
38429 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
38430 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
38432 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
38433 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
38434 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
38435 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
38436 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
38437 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38439 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
38440 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
38441 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38445 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
38446 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
38447 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
38448 the main log is maintained.
38449 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
38450 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
38451 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
38452 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
38453 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
38455 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
38456 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
38457 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
38458 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
38459 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
38460 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
38461 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
38462 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
38463 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
38464 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
38465 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
38467 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
38468 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
38469 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
38470 It cannot go further back up the log.
38472 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
38473 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
38474 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
38475 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
38476 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
38477 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
38479 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
38480 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
38481 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
38482 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
38483 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
38484 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
38486 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
38487 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
38488 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
38489 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
38490 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
38491 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
38492 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
38493 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
38494 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
38499 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
38500 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
38501 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
38502 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
38503 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
38504 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
38505 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
38506 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
38507 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
38508 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
38510 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
38511 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
38512 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
38513 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
38514 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
38515 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
38516 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
38518 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
38519 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
38520 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
38521 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
38522 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
38523 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
38524 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
38526 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
38527 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
38528 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
38529 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
38531 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
38532 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
38533 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
38534 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
38535 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
38536 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
38537 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
38540 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
38541 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
38543 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
38544 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
38545 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
38546 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
38547 display is updated.
38551 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
38552 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
38553 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
38554 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
38555 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
38558 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
38559 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
38560 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
38561 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
38562 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
38564 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
38566 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
38570 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
38571 in a new text window.
38573 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
38574 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
38575 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
38577 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
38578 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
38579 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
38580 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
38582 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
38583 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
38584 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
38585 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
38586 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
38588 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
38589 that the message be frozen.
38591 .cindex "thawing messages"
38592 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
38593 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
38594 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
38595 that the message be thawed.
38597 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
38598 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
38599 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
38600 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
38602 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
38603 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
38606 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
38607 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38608 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38609 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38610 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
38611 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
38612 which case no action is taken.
38614 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
38615 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
38616 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
38617 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
38618 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
38619 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
38620 case no action is taken.
38622 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
38623 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
38625 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
38626 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
38627 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
38628 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
38629 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
38630 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
38631 the address is qualified with that domain.
38634 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
38635 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
38636 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
38637 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
38638 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
38639 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
38640 if no output is generated.
38642 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
38643 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
38644 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
38645 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
38647 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
38648 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
38649 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
38656 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38659 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
38660 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
38661 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
38662 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
38664 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
38665 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
38666 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
38667 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
38668 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
38669 its security as compared with other MTAs.
38671 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
38672 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
38673 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
38674 as soon as possible.
38677 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
38678 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
38679 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
38680 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
38681 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
38682 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
38685 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
38686 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
38687 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
38688 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
38689 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
38690 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
38692 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
38693 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
38694 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
38695 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
38698 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
38699 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
38700 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
38701 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
38702 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
38703 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
38704 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
38705 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
38706 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
38710 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
38711 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
38712 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
38713 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
38714 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
38715 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
38716 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
38718 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
38721 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
38722 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
38723 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
38724 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
38725 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
38730 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
38732 .cindex "root privilege"
38733 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
38734 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
38735 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
38736 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
38737 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
38738 is required for two things:
38741 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
38742 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
38745 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
38746 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
38750 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
38751 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
38752 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
38753 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
38754 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
38755 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
38756 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
38757 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
38759 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
38760 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
38761 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
38763 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
38764 uid and gid in the following cases:
38769 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
38770 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
38771 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
38772 the calling process.
38773 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
38774 option may not be used at all.
38775 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
38776 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
38777 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
38782 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
38783 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
38786 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
38787 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
38788 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
38789 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
38790 testing address verification
38793 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
38796 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
38797 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
38800 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
38803 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
38804 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
38805 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
38806 will be used during message reception.
38808 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
38809 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
38811 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
38812 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
38813 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
38814 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
38815 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
38816 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
38817 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
38818 generating bounce and warning messages.
38820 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
38821 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
38822 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
38823 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
38825 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
38826 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
38832 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
38833 .cindex "privilege, running without"
38834 .cindex "unprivileged running"
38835 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
38836 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
38837 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
38838 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
38839 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
38840 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
38841 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
38845 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
38846 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
38847 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
38848 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
38850 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
38851 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
38852 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
38853 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
38854 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
38856 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
38857 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
38858 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
38861 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
38862 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
38863 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
38865 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
38866 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
38867 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
38868 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
38869 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
38870 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
38871 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
38872 address this problem at this time.
38874 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
38875 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
38876 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
38877 be used in the most straightforward way.
38879 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
38880 number of restrictions on what you can do:
38883 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
38884 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
38885 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
38886 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
38887 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
38889 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
38890 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
38892 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
38893 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
38894 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
38895 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
38897 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
38898 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
38901 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
38902 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
38903 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
38905 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
38906 owned by the Exim user.
38908 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
38909 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
38910 mailboxes need to be created manually.
38915 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
38916 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
38917 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
38918 gives more security at essentially no cost.
38920 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
38921 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
38926 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
38927 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
38928 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
38932 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
38933 .cindex "security" "local commands"
38934 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
38935 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
38936 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
38937 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
38938 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
38941 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
38942 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
38943 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
38944 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
38945 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
38947 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
38948 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
38949 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
38950 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
38951 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
38952 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
38953 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
38955 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
38956 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
38957 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
38959 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
38960 taint checking might apply to their usage.
38962 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
38963 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
38964 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
38966 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
38967 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
38968 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
38970 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
38971 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
38972 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
38973 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
38979 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
38980 .cindex "security" "data sources"
38981 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
38982 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
38983 .cindex "PCRE" "security"
38984 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
38985 are some issues to be aware of:
38988 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
38990 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
38992 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
38993 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE. Be aware of what
38994 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
38995 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
38996 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
38997 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
39000 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
39001 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
39002 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
39004 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
39005 expected to yield one result.
39011 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
39012 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
39013 .cindex "IP source routing"
39014 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
39015 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
39016 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
39017 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
39021 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
39022 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
39023 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
39028 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
39029 .cindex "trusted users"
39030 .cindex "admin user"
39031 .cindex "privileged user"
39032 .cindex "user" "trusted"
39033 .cindex "user" "admin"
39034 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
39035 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
39036 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
39037 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
39038 permit a remote host to be specified.
39041 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
39042 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
39043 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
39044 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
39045 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
39046 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
39048 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
39049 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
39050 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
39051 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
39052 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
39054 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
39055 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
39056 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
39057 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
39058 includes the contents of files on the spool.
39062 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
39063 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
39064 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
39065 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
39066 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
39067 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
39069 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
39070 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
39071 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
39072 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
39073 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
39074 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
39077 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
39078 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
39079 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
39080 This affects most of the checking options,
39081 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
39084 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
39085 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
39086 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
39087 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
39088 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
39089 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
39093 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
39094 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
39095 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
39096 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
39097 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
39102 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
39103 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
39104 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
39105 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
39110 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
39111 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
39112 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
39113 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
39114 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
39118 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
39119 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
39120 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
39124 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
39125 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
39126 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
39127 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
39128 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
39129 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
39130 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
39132 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
39133 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
39138 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
39139 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
39140 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
39141 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
39145 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
39146 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
39147 enough to hold the result.
39148 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
39153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39156 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
39157 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
39158 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
39159 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
39160 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
39161 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
39162 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
39163 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
39164 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
39165 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
39166 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
39167 themselves are recoverable.
39169 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
39170 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
39171 and should not be used as such.
39173 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
39174 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
39175 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
39178 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
39179 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
39180 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
39181 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
39182 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
39184 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
39185 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
39186 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
39187 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
39189 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
39191 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
39194 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
39196 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
39197 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
39198 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
39199 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
39200 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
39201 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
39202 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
39203 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
39206 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
39207 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
39208 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
39209 relics of crashes and can be removed.
39211 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
39212 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
39213 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
39214 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
39215 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
39216 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
39217 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
39218 normally the Exim user.
39220 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
39221 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
39222 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
39223 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
39224 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
39225 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
39226 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
39227 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
39229 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
39230 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
39231 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
39232 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
39234 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
39235 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
39238 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39239 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
39240 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
39241 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
39242 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
39243 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
39244 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
39245 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
39246 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
39249 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39250 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
39251 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
39252 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39253 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39254 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39256 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
39257 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
39258 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
39259 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
39260 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
39261 character. It may contain internal newlines.
39263 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
39264 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
39265 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
39267 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
39268 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
39269 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
39270 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
39271 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39273 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
39274 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
39275 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
39276 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
39277 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
39279 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
39280 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
39281 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
39283 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
39284 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
39285 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
39287 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39288 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
39289 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
39291 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
39292 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
39293 present if the number is greater than zero.
39295 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
39296 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
39297 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
39299 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
39300 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
39301 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
39303 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39304 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
39307 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39308 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
39309 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
39312 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
39313 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
39314 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
39315 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
39317 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
39318 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
39319 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
39321 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
39322 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
39323 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
39324 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
39325 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
39326 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
39328 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
39329 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
39330 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
39331 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
39332 supplied by the remote host, if any.
39334 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
39335 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
39336 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
39337 generated messages.
39340 The message is from a local sender.
39342 .vitem &%-localerror%&
39343 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
39345 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
39346 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
39347 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
39348 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
39350 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
39351 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
39352 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
39355 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
39356 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
39359 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
39360 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
39361 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
39363 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
39364 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
39365 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
39367 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
39368 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
39369 of &$spam_score_int$&.
39371 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
39372 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
39373 rather than Unix-format.
39374 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
39375 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
39377 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
39378 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
39379 certificate was verified by the server.
39381 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
39382 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
39383 name of the cipher suite that was used.
39385 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
39386 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
39387 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
39391 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
39392 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
39393 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
39394 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
39395 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
39396 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
39397 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
39398 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
39399 addresses are complete.
39401 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
39402 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
39403 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
39404 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
39405 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
39406 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
39408 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
39409 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
39410 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39412 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
39413 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
39414 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
39415 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
39419 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39420 darcy@austen.fict.example
39422 alice@wonderland.fict.example
39424 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
39425 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
39426 line is of the following form:
39428 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
39429 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
39431 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
39432 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
39433 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
39434 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
39435 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
39436 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
39437 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
39438 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
39441 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
39442 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
39443 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
39444 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
39445 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
39449 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
39450 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
39451 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
39452 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
39453 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
39454 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
39455 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
39456 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
39457 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
39458 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
39461 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
39462 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
39463 typical set of headers:
39465 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
39466 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39467 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
39468 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
39469 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
39470 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
39471 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
39472 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39473 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
39474 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
39475 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
39477 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
39478 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
39479 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
39480 .ecindex IIDforspo1
39481 .ecindex IIDforspo2
39482 .ecindex IIDforspo3
39484 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
39485 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
39486 an ASCII newline character.
39487 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
39488 can have an alternate format.
39489 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
39490 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
39491 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
39492 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
39493 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
39494 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
39496 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39497 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39499 .chapter "DKIM and SPF" "CHAPdkim" &&&
39500 "DKIM and SPF Support"
39503 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
39505 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
39506 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
39507 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
39508 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
39510 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
39511 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
39512 any original DKIM signature.
39514 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
39515 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
39517 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
39519 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
39520 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
39521 (including transport filters)
39522 except cutthrough delivery.
39524 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
39525 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
39526 different signature contexts.
39529 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
39530 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
39531 Exim's standard controls.
39533 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
39534 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
39536 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
39537 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
39538 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
39539 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
39541 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
39542 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
39543 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
39544 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
39547 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
39548 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
39549 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
39550 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
39554 .section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECDKIMSIGN"
39555 .cindex "DKIM" "signing"
39557 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
39558 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
39560 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39562 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39563 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39566 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
39567 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
39568 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
39569 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
39570 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
39572 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
39573 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
39575 .option dkim_domain smtp string list&!! unset
39576 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
39577 After expansion, this can be a list.
39578 Each element in turn,
39582 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
39583 while expanding the remaining signing options.
39584 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
39585 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39587 .option dkim_selector smtp string list&!! unset
39588 This sets the key selector string.
39589 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
39590 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
39591 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
39592 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
39593 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
39594 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
39596 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
39597 This sets the private key to use.
39598 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
39599 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
39600 The result can either
39602 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
39604 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39605 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
39607 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
39610 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
39611 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
39615 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
39617 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
39618 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
39620 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
39621 for the DNS TXT record.
39622 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
39626 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
39627 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
39630 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39632 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
39633 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
39637 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
39639 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
39640 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
39641 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
39642 for some transition period.
39643 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39646 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
39648 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
39649 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
39652 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
39654 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
39655 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
39659 Exim also supports an alternate format
39660 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
39661 of the standard, but not adopted.
39662 A future release will probably drop that support.
39665 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
39666 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
39668 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
39670 &`sha256`& &-- the default
39672 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
39675 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39677 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39680 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
39681 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
39682 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
39683 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
39684 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
39685 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
39687 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
39688 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
39689 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
39690 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
39691 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
39693 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
39694 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
39695 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
39696 either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
39697 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
39700 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
39701 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
39702 list of header names.
39703 Headers with these names, or the absence or such a header, will be included
39704 in the message signature.
39705 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
39706 whether or not each header is present in the message.
39707 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
39708 "_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS".
39710 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
39711 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
39712 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
39714 A name can be prefixed with either an '=' or a '+' character.
39715 If an '=' prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
39717 If a '+' prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
39718 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
39719 name will be appended.
39721 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
39722 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
39723 If not set, no such information will be included.
39724 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the current time
39726 (eg. 1209600 for two weeks);
39727 both creation (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included.
39729 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
39732 .section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECDKIMVFY"
39733 .cindex "DKIM" "verification"
39735 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
39736 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
39737 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
39738 Performing verification sets up information used by the
39739 &$authresults$& expansion item.
39741 The results of that verification are then made available to the
39742 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which can examine and modify them.
39743 By default, this ACL is called once for each
39744 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
39745 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
39746 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
39747 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
39748 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
39750 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
39751 a large number of expansion variables
39752 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
39753 runtime of the ACL.
39755 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
39756 more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
39757 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
39758 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
39760 The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
39761 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
39762 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
39763 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
39764 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
39765 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
39768 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
39770 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
39771 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
39772 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
39774 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
39776 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
39777 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
39778 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
39780 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
39783 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
39784 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
39787 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
39788 (such as the From: header)
39789 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
39790 and for the domain part if identities.
39791 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
39794 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
39795 for each matching signature.
39798 Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
39799 available (from most to least important):
39803 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
39804 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
39805 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
39806 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
39808 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
39809 Within the DKIM ACL,
39810 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
39812 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
39813 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39815 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
39816 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39818 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
39819 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
39821 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
39824 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39825 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
39826 hash-method or key-size:
39828 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
39829 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
39830 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
39831 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
39832 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
39833 set dkim_verify_status = fail
39834 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
39837 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined (it need do no more than accept),
39838 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
39839 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
39840 This is maintained for the mime, prdr and data ACLs.
39842 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
39843 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
39844 "fail" or "invalid". One of
39846 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
39847 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
39849 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
39850 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
39852 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
39853 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
39854 means that the message body was modified in transit.
39856 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
39857 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
39858 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
39859 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
39862 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
39864 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
39865 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
39866 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
39867 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39869 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
39870 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
39871 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
39872 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
39874 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
39875 The key record selector string.
39877 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
39878 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
39879 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
39880 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
39881 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
39884 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39886 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
39888 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
39889 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
39892 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39893 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39895 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
39896 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39898 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
39899 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
39901 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
39902 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
39903 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
39904 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
39905 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
39906 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
39908 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
39909 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
39910 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
39911 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
39912 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
39913 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
39914 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
39915 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
39917 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
39918 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
39919 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
39921 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
39922 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
39923 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
39924 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
39925 integer size comparisons against this value.
39926 Note that Exim does not check this value.
39928 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
39929 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
39931 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
39932 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
39934 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
39935 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
39937 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
39938 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39941 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
39942 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
39945 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
39946 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
39948 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
39949 Number of bits in the key.
39951 Note that RFC 8301 says:
39953 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
39954 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
39957 To enforce this you must have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
39958 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above.
39959 As EC keys are much smaller, the check should only do this for RSA keys.
39963 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
39966 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
39967 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
39968 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
39969 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
39970 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
39973 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
39974 warn log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
39975 sender_domains = gmail.com
39976 dkim_signers = gmail.com
39980 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
39981 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
39983 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
39984 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
39985 results against the actual result of verification. This is typically used
39986 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
39989 deny message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
39990 sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
39991 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
39992 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
39995 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
39996 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
39997 for more information of what they mean.
40003 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
40004 .cindex SPF verification
40006 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
40007 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
40008 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.openspf.org).
40009 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https
40011 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
40012 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
40014 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
40015 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
40016 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
40017 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
40018 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
40020 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
40021 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
40022 Performing verification sets up information used by the
40023 &$authresults$& expansion item.
40026 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40027 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
40028 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
40029 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
40030 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
40034 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
40037 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
40038 domain in the envelope-from address.
40040 .vitem &%softfail%&
40041 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
40045 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
40048 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
40049 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
40050 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
40052 .vitem &%permerror%&
40053 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
40054 You may deny messages when this occurs.
40056 .vitem &%temperror%&
40057 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
40058 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
40061 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
40062 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
40063 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
40064 short-circuit fashion.
40069 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
40070 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
40071 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
40072 Please see http://www.openspf.org/Why?scope=\
40073 ${if def:sender_address_domain {mfrom}{helo}};\
40074 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
40075 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
40076 ip=$sender_host_address
40079 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
40082 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
40084 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
40085 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
40086 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
40087 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
40088 it for logging purposes.
40090 .vitem &$spf_received$&
40091 .vindex &$spf_received$&
40092 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header that can be
40093 added to the message. Please note that according to the SPF
40094 draft, this header must be added at the top of the header
40095 list. Please see section 10 on how you can do this.
40097 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
40098 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
40100 .vitem &$spf_result$&
40101 .vindex &$spf_result$&
40102 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
40103 one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror or
40106 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
40107 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
40108 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
40109 and required in order to obtain a result.
40111 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40112 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
40113 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
40114 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
40118 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
40119 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
40120 .cindex SPF "best guess"
40121 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
40122 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
40123 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
40125 Refer to &url(http://www.openspf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
40126 for a description of what it means.
40127 . --- 2018-09-07: still not https:
40129 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
40130 of the spf one. For example:
40133 deny spf_guess = fail
40134 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
40137 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
40138 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
40139 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
40142 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
40143 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
40145 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
40146 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
40147 &%spf_guess%& option.
40148 For example, the following:
40151 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
40154 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
40157 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
40159 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
40160 address as the key and an IP address as the database:
40163 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
40166 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
40167 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
40168 Currently, only IPv4 addresses are supported.
40173 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40174 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40176 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
40178 .cindex "proxy support"
40179 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
40181 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
40182 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
40185 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
40186 .cindex proxy inbound
40187 .cindex proxy "server side"
40188 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
40189 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
40191 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
40192 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
40193 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
40196 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
40197 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
40199 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
40200 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
40201 to distribute load.
40202 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
40203 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
40204 There is no logging if a host passes or
40205 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
40206 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
40208 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
40209 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
40210 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
40211 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
40212 automatically determines which version is in use.
40214 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
40215 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
40216 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
40217 Exim and the proxy server.
40219 The following expansion variables are usable
40220 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
40223 &'proxy_external_address '& IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy
40224 &'proxy_external_port '& Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy
40225 &'proxy_local_address '& IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy
40226 &'proxy_local_port '& Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy
40227 &'proxy_session '& boolean: SMTP connection via proxy
40229 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
40230 there was a protocol error.
40231 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
40232 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
40234 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
40235 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
40236 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
40237 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
40238 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
40239 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
40240 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
40241 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
40242 A possible solution is:
40244 # Set max number of connections per host
40246 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
40247 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
40249 defer message = Too many connections from this IP right now
40250 ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
40255 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
40256 .cindex proxy outbound
40257 .cindex proxy "client side"
40258 .cindex proxy SOCKS
40259 .cindex SOCKS proxy
40260 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
40261 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
40262 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
40265 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
40266 on an smtp transport.
40267 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
40268 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
40269 Each proxy specifier is a list
40270 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
40271 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
40273 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
40274 The list of options is in the following table:
40276 &'auth '& authentication method
40277 &'name '& authentication username
40278 &'pass '& authentication password
40280 &'tmo '& connection timeout
40282 &'weight '& selection bias
40285 More details on each of these options follows:
40288 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
40289 .cindex proxy authentication
40290 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
40291 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
40292 for access to the proxy.
40293 Default is &"none"&.
40295 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
40298 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
40301 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
40304 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
40307 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
40308 higher values being tried first.
40309 The default priority is 1.
40311 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
40312 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
40313 weighted by this value.
40314 The default value for selection bias is 1.
40317 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
40318 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
40319 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
40321 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
40322 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
40323 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
40324 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
40326 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40327 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40329 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
40330 "Internationalisation""
40331 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
40334 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
40336 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
40337 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
40338 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
40340 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
40341 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
40342 requirement, upon libidn2.
40344 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
40345 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
40346 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
40347 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
40348 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
40349 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
40351 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
40352 international handling for the message is enabled and
40353 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
40355 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
40356 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
40357 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
40358 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
40360 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
40361 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
40362 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
40363 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
40365 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
40366 components expanded to a-label form,
40367 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
40370 .cindex log protocol
40371 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
40372 .cindex i18n logging
40373 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
40374 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
40376 The following expansion operators can be used:
40378 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
40379 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
40380 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
40381 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
40384 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
40385 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
40387 may use the following modifier:
40389 control = utf8_downconvert
40390 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
40392 This sets a flag requiring that addresses are converted to
40393 a-label form before smtp delivery, for use in a
40394 Message Submission Agent context.
40395 If a value is appended it may be:
40397 &`1 `& (default) mandatory downconversion
40398 &`0 `& no downconversion
40399 &`-1 `& if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host
40402 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
40403 is initially set to -1.
40405 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
40406 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
40407 and it overrides any previously set value.
40410 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
40411 Configurations supporting these should inspect
40412 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
40414 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
40415 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
40416 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
40418 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
40419 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
40423 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
40424 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
40425 the following expansion operator can be used:
40427 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
40430 The string is converted from the charset specified by
40431 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
40432 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
40434 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
40435 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
40436 (which has to be a single character)
40437 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
40438 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
40440 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
40441 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
40443 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
40444 by many other IMAP servers.
40448 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
40449 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
40450 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
40453 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
40454 must be representable in UTF-16.
40457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40458 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40460 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
40464 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
40465 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
40466 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
40467 processing actions.
40469 Most installations will never need to use Events.
40470 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
40471 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
40473 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
40474 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
40475 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
40477 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
40478 An example might look like:
40479 .cindex logging custom
40481 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
40482 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
40483 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
40484 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
40485 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
40486 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
40487 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
40488 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
40489 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
40493 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
40494 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
40495 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
40497 The current list of events is:
40499 &`dane:fail after transport `& per connection
40500 &`msg:complete after main `& per message
40501 &`msg:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40502 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport `& per recipient per host
40503 &`msg:rcpt:defer after transport `& per recipient
40504 &`msg:host:defer after transport `& per attempt
40505 &`msg:fail:delivery after transport `& per recipient
40506 &`msg:fail:internal after main `& per recipient
40507 &`tcp:connect before transport `& per connection
40508 &`tcp:close after transport `& per connection
40509 &`tls:cert before both `& per certificate in verification chain
40510 &`smtp:connect after transport `& per connection
40512 New event types may be added in future.
40514 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
40515 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
40516 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
40518 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
40519 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
40520 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
40522 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
40523 should define the event action.
40525 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
40526 with the event type:
40528 &`dane:fail `& failure reason
40529 &`msg:delivery `& smtp confirmation message
40530 &`msg:fail:internal `& failure reason
40531 &`msg:fail:delivery `& smtp error message
40532 &`msg:rcpt:host:defer `& error string
40533 &`msg:rcpt:defer `& error string
40534 &`msg:host:defer `& error string
40535 &`tls:cert `& verification chain depth
40536 &`smtp:connect `& smtp banner
40539 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
40541 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&
40542 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
40543 the course of its processing:
40545 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
40548 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
40549 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
40551 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
40552 a useful way of writing to the main log.
40554 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
40555 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
40556 following will be forced:
40558 &`tcp:connect `& do not connect
40559 &`tls:cert `& refuse verification
40560 &`smtp:connect `& close connection
40562 All other message types ignore the result string, and
40563 no other use is made of it.
40565 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
40566 then the address and port variables will be that of the proxy and not
40569 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
40570 chain element received on the connection.
40571 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
40574 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40577 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
40578 "Adding drivers or lookups"
40579 .cindex "adding drivers"
40580 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
40581 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
40582 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
40583 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
40586 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
40587 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
40589 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
40591 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
40593 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
40594 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
40595 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
40597 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
40599 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
40602 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
40603 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
40605 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
40606 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
40607 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
40608 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
40609 simple form that most lookups have.
40611 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
40612 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
40613 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
40615 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
40616 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
40618 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
40621 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
40622 as for other drivers and lookups.
40625 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
40626 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
40627 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
40628 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
40629 searched using a binary chop procedure.
40631 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
40632 the interface that is expected.
40637 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40638 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40640 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40641 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
40642 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
40643 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
40645 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40650 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
40651 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
40655 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
40656 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
40657 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
40660 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40661 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////